semihosting: User defined operation, Tcl command exec on host
[openocd.git] / doc / openocd.texi
1 \input texinfo @c -*-texinfo-*-
2 @c %**start of header
3 @setfilename openocd.info
4 @settitle OpenOCD User's Guide
5 @dircategory Development
6 @direntry
7 * OpenOCD: (openocd). OpenOCD User's Guide
8 @end direntry
9 @paragraphindent 0
10 @c %**end of header
11
12 @include version.texi
13
14 @copying
15
16 This User's Guide documents
17 release @value{VERSION},
18 dated @value{UPDATED},
19 of the Open On-Chip Debugger (OpenOCD).
20
21 @itemize @bullet
22 @item Copyright @copyright{} 2008 The OpenOCD Project
23 @item Copyright @copyright{} 2007-2008 Spencer Oliver @email{spen@@spen-soft.co.uk}
24 @item Copyright @copyright{} 2008-2010 Oyvind Harboe @email{oyvind.harboe@@zylin.com}
25 @item Copyright @copyright{} 2008 Duane Ellis @email{openocd@@duaneellis.com}
26 @item Copyright @copyright{} 2009-2010 David Brownell
27 @end itemize
28
29 @quotation
30 Permission is granted to copy, distribute and/or modify this document
31 under the terms of the GNU Free Documentation License, Version 1.2 or
32 any later version published by the Free Software Foundation; with no
33 Invariant Sections, no Front-Cover Texts, and no Back-Cover Texts. A
34 copy of the license is included in the section entitled ``GNU Free
35 Documentation License''.
36 @end quotation
37 @end copying
38
39 @titlepage
40 @titlefont{@emph{Open On-Chip Debugger:}}
41 @sp 1
42 @title OpenOCD User's Guide
43 @subtitle for release @value{VERSION}
44 @subtitle @value{UPDATED}
45
46 @page
47 @vskip 0pt plus 1filll
48 @insertcopying
49 @end titlepage
50
51 @summarycontents
52 @contents
53
54 @ifnottex
55 @node Top
56 @top OpenOCD User's Guide
57
58 @insertcopying
59 @end ifnottex
60
61 @menu
62 * About:: About OpenOCD
63 * Developers:: OpenOCD Developer Resources
64 * Debug Adapter Hardware:: Debug Adapter Hardware
65 * About Jim-Tcl:: About Jim-Tcl
66 * Running:: Running OpenOCD
67 * OpenOCD Project Setup:: OpenOCD Project Setup
68 * Config File Guidelines:: Config File Guidelines
69 * Server Configuration:: Server Configuration
70 * Debug Adapter Configuration:: Debug Adapter Configuration
71 * Reset Configuration:: Reset Configuration
72 * TAP Declaration:: TAP Declaration
73 * CPU Configuration:: CPU Configuration
74 * Flash Commands:: Flash Commands
75 * Flash Programming:: Flash Programming
76 * PLD/FPGA Commands:: PLD/FPGA Commands
77 * General Commands:: General Commands
78 * Architecture and Core Commands:: Architecture and Core Commands
79 * JTAG Commands:: JTAG Commands
80 * Boundary Scan Commands:: Boundary Scan Commands
81 * Utility Commands:: Utility Commands
82 * GDB and OpenOCD:: Using GDB and OpenOCD
83 * Tcl Scripting API:: Tcl Scripting API
84 * FAQ:: Frequently Asked Questions
85 * Tcl Crash Course:: Tcl Crash Course
86 * License:: GNU Free Documentation License
87
88 @comment DO NOT use the plain word ``Index'', reason: CYGWIN filename
89 @comment case issue with ``Index.html'' and ``index.html''
90 @comment Occurs when creating ``--html --no-split'' output
91 @comment This fix is based on: http://sourceware.org/ml/binutils/2006-05/msg00215.html
92 * OpenOCD Concept Index:: Concept Index
93 * Command and Driver Index:: Command and Driver Index
94 @end menu
95
96 @node About
97 @unnumbered About
98 @cindex about
99
100 OpenOCD was created by Dominic Rath as part of a 2005 diploma thesis written
101 at the University of Applied Sciences Augsburg (@uref{http://www.hs-augsburg.de}).
102 Since that time, the project has grown into an active open-source project,
103 supported by a diverse community of software and hardware developers from
104 around the world.
105
106 @section What is OpenOCD?
107 @cindex TAP
108 @cindex JTAG
109
110 The Open On-Chip Debugger (OpenOCD) aims to provide debugging,
111 in-system programming and boundary-scan testing for embedded target
112 devices.
113
114 It does so with the assistance of a @dfn{debug adapter}, which is
115 a small hardware module which helps provide the right kind of
116 electrical signaling to the target being debugged. These are
117 required since the debug host (on which OpenOCD runs) won't
118 usually have native support for such signaling, or the connector
119 needed to hook up to the target.
120
121 Such debug adapters support one or more @dfn{transport} protocols,
122 each of which involves different electrical signaling (and uses
123 different messaging protocols on top of that signaling). There
124 are many types of debug adapter, and little uniformity in what
125 they are called. (There are also product naming differences.)
126
127 These adapters are sometimes packaged as discrete dongles, which
128 may generically be called @dfn{hardware interface dongles}.
129 Some development boards also integrate them directly, which may
130 let the development board connect directly to the debug
131 host over USB (and sometimes also to power it over USB).
132
133 For example, a @dfn{JTAG Adapter} supports JTAG
134 signaling, and is used to communicate
135 with JTAG (IEEE 1149.1) compliant TAPs on your target board.
136 A @dfn{TAP} is a ``Test Access Port'', a module which processes
137 special instructions and data. TAPs are daisy-chained within and
138 between chips and boards. JTAG supports debugging and boundary
139 scan operations.
140
141 There are also @dfn{SWD Adapters} that support Serial Wire Debug (SWD)
142 signaling to communicate with some newer ARM cores, as well as debug
143 adapters which support both JTAG and SWD transports. SWD supports only
144 debugging, whereas JTAG also supports boundary scan operations.
145
146 For some chips, there are also @dfn{Programming Adapters} supporting
147 special transports used only to write code to flash memory, without
148 support for on-chip debugging or boundary scan.
149 (At this writing, OpenOCD does not support such non-debug adapters.)
150
151
152 @b{Dongles:} OpenOCD currently supports many types of hardware dongles:
153 USB-based, parallel port-based, and other standalone boxes that run
154 OpenOCD internally. @xref{Debug Adapter Hardware}.
155
156 @b{GDB Debug:} It allows ARM7 (ARM7TDMI and ARM720t), ARM9 (ARM920T,
157 ARM922T, ARM926EJ--S, ARM966E--S), XScale (PXA25x, IXP42x), Cortex-M3
158 (Stellaris LM3, STMicroelectronics STM32 and Energy Micro EFM32) and
159 Intel Quark (x10xx) based cores to be debugged via the GDB protocol.
160
161 @b{Flash Programming:} Flash writing is supported for external
162 CFI-compatible NOR flashes (Intel and AMD/Spansion command set) and several
163 internal flashes (LPC1700, LPC1800, LPC2000, LPC4300, AT91SAM7, AT91SAM3U,
164 STR7x, STR9x, LM3, STM32x and EFM32). Preliminary support for various NAND flash
165 controllers (LPC3180, Orion, S3C24xx, more) is included.
166
167 @section OpenOCD Web Site
168
169 The OpenOCD web site provides the latest public news from the community:
170
171 @uref{http://openocd.org/}
172
173 @section Latest User's Guide:
174
175 The user's guide you are now reading may not be the latest one
176 available. A version for more recent code may be available.
177 Its HTML form is published regularly at:
178
179 @uref{http://openocd.org/doc/html/index.html}
180
181 PDF form is likewise published at:
182
183 @uref{http://openocd.org/doc/pdf/openocd.pdf}
184
185 @section OpenOCD User's Forum
186
187 There is an OpenOCD forum (phpBB) hosted by SparkFun,
188 which might be helpful to you. Note that if you want
189 anything to come to the attention of developers, you
190 should post it to the OpenOCD Developer Mailing List
191 instead of this forum.
192
193 @uref{http://forum.sparkfun.com/viewforum.php?f=18}
194
195 @section OpenOCD User's Mailing List
196
197 The OpenOCD User Mailing List provides the primary means of
198 communication between users:
199
200 @uref{https://lists.sourceforge.net/mailman/listinfo/openocd-user}
201
202 @section OpenOCD IRC
203
204 Support can also be found on irc:
205 @uref{irc://irc.libera.chat/openocd}
206
207 @node Developers
208 @chapter OpenOCD Developer Resources
209 @cindex developers
210
211 If you are interested in improving the state of OpenOCD's debugging and
212 testing support, new contributions will be welcome. Motivated developers
213 can produce new target, flash or interface drivers, improve the
214 documentation, as well as more conventional bug fixes and enhancements.
215
216 The resources in this chapter are available for developers wishing to explore
217 or expand the OpenOCD source code.
218
219 @section OpenOCD Git Repository
220
221 During the 0.3.x release cycle, OpenOCD switched from Subversion to
222 a Git repository hosted at SourceForge. The repository URL is:
223
224 @uref{git://git.code.sf.net/p/openocd/code}
225
226 or via http
227
228 @uref{http://git.code.sf.net/p/openocd/code}
229
230 You may prefer to use a mirror and the HTTP protocol:
231
232 @uref{http://repo.or.cz/r/openocd.git}
233
234 With standard Git tools, use @command{git clone} to initialize
235 a local repository, and @command{git pull} to update it.
236 There are also gitweb pages letting you browse the repository
237 with a web browser, or download arbitrary snapshots without
238 needing a Git client:
239
240 @uref{http://repo.or.cz/w/openocd.git}
241
242 The @file{README} file contains the instructions for building the project
243 from the repository or a snapshot.
244
245 Developers that want to contribute patches to the OpenOCD system are
246 @b{strongly} encouraged to work against mainline.
247 Patches created against older versions may require additional
248 work from their submitter in order to be updated for newer releases.
249
250 @section Doxygen Developer Manual
251
252 During the 0.2.x release cycle, the OpenOCD project began
253 providing a Doxygen reference manual. This document contains more
254 technical information about the software internals, development
255 processes, and similar documentation:
256
257 @uref{http://openocd.org/doc/doxygen/html/index.html}
258
259 This document is a work-in-progress, but contributions would be welcome
260 to fill in the gaps. All of the source files are provided in-tree,
261 listed in the Doxyfile configuration at the top of the source tree.
262
263 @section Gerrit Review System
264
265 All changes in the OpenOCD Git repository go through the web-based Gerrit
266 Code Review System:
267
268 @uref{https://review.openocd.org/}
269
270 After a one-time registration and repository setup, anyone can push commits
271 from their local Git repository directly into Gerrit.
272 All users and developers are encouraged to review, test, discuss and vote
273 for changes in Gerrit. The feedback provides the basis for a maintainer to
274 eventually submit the change to the main Git repository.
275
276 The @file{HACKING} file, also available as the Patch Guide in the Doxygen
277 Developer Manual, contains basic information about how to connect a
278 repository to Gerrit, prepare and push patches. Patch authors are expected to
279 maintain their changes while they're in Gerrit, respond to feedback and if
280 necessary rework and push improved versions of the change.
281
282 @section OpenOCD Developer Mailing List
283
284 The OpenOCD Developer Mailing List provides the primary means of
285 communication between developers:
286
287 @uref{https://lists.sourceforge.net/mailman/listinfo/openocd-devel}
288
289 @section OpenOCD Bug Tracker
290
291 The OpenOCD Bug Tracker is hosted on SourceForge:
292
293 @uref{http://bugs.openocd.org/}
294
295
296 @node Debug Adapter Hardware
297 @chapter Debug Adapter Hardware
298 @cindex dongles
299 @cindex FTDI
300 @cindex wiggler
301 @cindex printer port
302 @cindex USB Adapter
303 @cindex RTCK
304
305 Defined: @b{dongle}: A small device that plugs into a computer and serves as
306 an adapter .... [snip]
307
308 In the OpenOCD case, this generally refers to @b{a small adapter} that
309 attaches to your computer via USB or the parallel port.
310
311
312 @section Choosing a Dongle
313
314 There are several things you should keep in mind when choosing a dongle.
315
316 @enumerate
317 @item @b{Transport} Does it support the kind of communication that you need?
318 OpenOCD focuses mostly on JTAG. Your version may also support
319 other ways to communicate with target devices.
320 @item @b{Voltage} What voltage is your target - 1.8, 2.8, 3.3, or 5V?
321 Does your dongle support it? You might need a level converter.
322 @item @b{Pinout} What pinout does your target board use?
323 Does your dongle support it? You may be able to use jumper
324 wires, or an "octopus" connector, to convert pinouts.
325 @item @b{Connection} Does your computer have the USB, parallel, or
326 Ethernet port needed?
327 @item @b{RTCK} Do you expect to use it with ARM chips and boards with
328 RTCK support (also known as ``adaptive clocking'')?
329 @end enumerate
330
331 @section USB FT2232 Based
332
333 There are many USB JTAG dongles on the market, many of them based
334 on a chip from ``Future Technology Devices International'' (FTDI)
335 known as the FTDI FT2232; this is a USB full speed (12 Mbps) chip.
336 See: @url{http://www.ftdichip.com} for more information.
337 In summer 2009, USB high speed (480 Mbps) versions of these FTDI
338 chips started to become available in JTAG adapters. Around 2012, a new
339 variant appeared - FT232H - this is a single-channel version of FT2232H.
340 (Adapters using those high speed FT2232H or FT232H chips may support adaptive
341 clocking.)
342
343 The FT2232 chips are flexible enough to support some other
344 transport options, such as SWD or the SPI variants used to
345 program some chips. They have two communications channels,
346 and one can be used for a UART adapter at the same time the
347 other one is used to provide a debug adapter.
348
349 Also, some development boards integrate an FT2232 chip to serve as
350 a built-in low-cost debug adapter and USB-to-serial solution.
351
352 @itemize @bullet
353 @item @b{usbjtag}
354 @* Link @url{http://elk.informatik.fh-augsburg.de/hhweb/doc/openocd/usbjtag/usbjtag.html}
355 @item @b{jtagkey}
356 @* See: @url{http://www.amontec.com/jtagkey.shtml}
357 @item @b{jtagkey2}
358 @* See: @url{http://www.amontec.com/jtagkey2.shtml}
359 @item @b{oocdlink}
360 @* See: @url{http://www.oocdlink.com} By Joern Kaipf
361 @item @b{signalyzer}
362 @* See: @url{http://www.signalyzer.com}
363 @item @b{Stellaris Eval Boards}
364 @* See: @url{http://www.ti.com} - The Stellaris eval boards
365 bundle FT2232-based JTAG and SWD support, which can be used to debug
366 the Stellaris chips. Using separate JTAG adapters is optional.
367 These boards can also be used in a "pass through" mode as JTAG adapters
368 to other target boards, disabling the Stellaris chip.
369 @item @b{TI/Luminary ICDI}
370 @* See: @url{http://www.ti.com} - TI/Luminary In-Circuit Debug
371 Interface (ICDI) Boards are included in Stellaris LM3S9B9x
372 Evaluation Kits. Like the non-detachable FT2232 support on the other
373 Stellaris eval boards, they can be used to debug other target boards.
374 @item @b{olimex-jtag}
375 @* See: @url{http://www.olimex.com}
376 @item @b{Flyswatter/Flyswatter2}
377 @* See: @url{http://www.tincantools.com}
378 @item @b{turtelizer2}
379 @* See:
380 @uref{http://www.ethernut.de/en/hardware/turtelizer/index.html, Turtelizer 2}, or
381 @url{http://www.ethernut.de}
382 @item @b{comstick}
383 @* Link: @url{http://www.hitex.com/index.php?id=383}
384 @item @b{stm32stick}
385 @* Link @url{http://www.hitex.com/stm32-stick}
386 @item @b{axm0432_jtag}
387 @* Axiom AXM-0432 Link @url{http://www.axman.com} - NOTE: This JTAG does not appear
388 to be available anymore as of April 2012.
389 @item @b{cortino}
390 @* Link @url{http://www.hitex.com/index.php?id=cortino}
391 @item @b{dlp-usb1232h}
392 @* Link @url{http://www.dlpdesign.com/usb/usb1232h.shtml}
393 @item @b{digilent-hs1}
394 @* Link @url{http://www.digilentinc.com/Products/Detail.cfm?Prod=JTAG-HS1}
395 @item @b{opendous}
396 @* Link @url{http://code.google.com/p/opendous/wiki/JTAG} FT2232H-based
397 (OpenHardware).
398 @item @b{JTAG-lock-pick Tiny 2}
399 @* Link @url{http://www.distortec.com/jtag-lock-pick-tiny-2} FT232H-based
400
401 @item @b{GW16042}
402 @* Link: @url{http://shop.gateworks.com/index.php?route=product/product&path=70_80&product_id=64}
403 FT2232H-based
404
405 @end itemize
406 @section USB-JTAG / Altera USB-Blaster compatibles
407
408 These devices also show up as FTDI devices, but are not
409 protocol-compatible with the FT2232 devices. They are, however,
410 protocol-compatible among themselves. USB-JTAG devices typically consist
411 of a FT245 followed by a CPLD that understands a particular protocol,
412 or emulates this protocol using some other hardware.
413
414 They may appear under different USB VID/PID depending on the particular
415 product. The driver can be configured to search for any VID/PID pair
416 (see the section on driver commands).
417
418 @itemize
419 @item @b{USB-JTAG} Kolja Waschk's USB Blaster-compatible adapter
420 @* Link: @url{http://ixo-jtag.sourceforge.net/}
421 @item @b{Altera USB-Blaster}
422 @* Link: @url{http://www.altera.com/literature/ug/ug_usb_blstr.pdf}
423 @end itemize
424
425 @section USB J-Link based
426 There are several OEM versions of the SEGGER @b{J-Link} adapter. It is
427 an example of a microcontroller based JTAG adapter, it uses an
428 AT91SAM764 internally.
429
430 @itemize @bullet
431 @item @b{SEGGER J-Link}
432 @* Link: @url{http://www.segger.com/jlink.html}
433 @item @b{Atmel SAM-ICE} (Only works with Atmel chips!)
434 @* Link: @url{http://www.atmel.com/tools/atmelsam-ice.aspx}
435 @item @b{IAR J-Link}
436 @end itemize
437
438 @section USB RLINK based
439 Raisonance has an adapter called @b{RLink}. It exists in a stripped-down form on the STM32 Primer,
440 permanently attached to the JTAG lines. It also exists on the STM32 Primer2, but that is wired for
441 SWD and not JTAG, thus not supported.
442
443 @itemize @bullet
444 @item @b{Raisonance RLink}
445 @* Link: @url{http://www.mcu-raisonance.com/~rlink-debugger-programmer__@/microcontrollers__tool~tool__T018:4cn9ziz4bnx6.html}
446 @item @b{STM32 Primer}
447 @* Link: @url{http://www.stm32circle.com/resources/stm32primer.php}
448 @item @b{STM32 Primer2}
449 @* Link: @url{http://www.stm32circle.com/resources/stm32primer2.php}
450 @end itemize
451
452 @section USB ST-LINK based
453 STMicroelectronics has an adapter called @b{ST-LINK}.
454 They only work with STMicroelectronics chips, notably STM32 and STM8.
455
456 @itemize @bullet
457 @item @b{ST-LINK}
458 @* This is available standalone and as part of some kits, eg. STM32VLDISCOVERY.
459 @* Link: @url{http://www.st.com/internet/evalboard/product/219866.jsp}
460 @item @b{ST-LINK/V2}
461 @* This is available standalone and as part of some kits, eg. STM32F4DISCOVERY.
462 @* Link: @url{http://www.st.com/internet/evalboard/product/251168.jsp}
463 @item @b{STLINK-V3}
464 @* This is available standalone and as part of some kits.
465 @* Link: @url{http://www.st.com/stlink-v3}
466 @end itemize
467
468 For info the original ST-LINK enumerates using the mass storage usb class; however,
469 its implementation is completely broken. The result is this causes issues under Linux.
470 The simplest solution is to get Linux to ignore the ST-LINK using one of the following methods:
471 @itemize @bullet
472 @item modprobe -r usb-storage && modprobe usb-storage quirks=483:3744:i
473 @item add "options usb-storage quirks=483:3744:i" to /etc/modprobe.conf
474 @end itemize
475
476 @section USB TI/Stellaris ICDI based
477 Texas Instruments has an adapter called @b{ICDI}.
478 It is not to be confused with the FTDI based adapters that were originally fitted to their
479 evaluation boards. This is the adapter fitted to the Stellaris LaunchPad.
480
481 @section USB Nuvoton Nu-Link
482 Nuvoton has an adapter called @b{Nu-Link}.
483 It is available either as stand-alone dongle and embedded on development boards.
484 It supports SWD, serial port bridge and mass storage for firmware update.
485 Both Nu-Link v1 and v2 are supported.
486
487 @section USB CMSIS-DAP based
488 ARM has released a interface standard called CMSIS-DAP that simplifies connecting
489 debuggers to ARM Cortex based targets @url{http://www.keil.com/support/man/docs/dapdebug/dapdebug_introduction.htm}.
490
491 @section USB Other
492 @itemize @bullet
493 @item @b{USBprog}
494 @* Link: @url{http://shop.embedded-projects.net/} - which uses an Atmel MEGA32 and a UBN9604
495
496 @item @b{USB - Presto}
497 @* Link: @url{http://tools.asix.net/prg_presto.htm}
498
499 @item @b{Versaloon-Link}
500 @* Link: @url{http://www.versaloon.com}
501
502 @item @b{ARM-JTAG-EW}
503 @* Link: @url{http://www.olimex.com/dev/arm-jtag-ew.html}
504
505 @item @b{Buspirate}
506 @* Link: @url{http://dangerousprototypes.com/bus-pirate-manual/}
507
508 @item @b{opendous}
509 @* Link: @url{http://code.google.com/p/opendous-jtag/} - which uses an AT90USB162
510
511 @item @b{estick}
512 @* Link: @url{http://code.google.com/p/estick-jtag/}
513
514 @item @b{Keil ULINK v1}
515 @* Link: @url{http://www.keil.com/ulink1/}
516
517 @item @b{TI XDS110 Debug Probe}
518 @* Link: @url{https://software-dl.ti.com/ccs/esd/documents/xdsdebugprobes/emu_xds110.html}
519 @* Link: @url{https://software-dl.ti.com/ccs/esd/documents/xdsdebugprobes/emu_xds_software_package_download.html#xds110-support-utilities}
520 @end itemize
521
522 @section IBM PC Parallel Printer Port Based
523
524 The two well-known ``JTAG Parallel Ports'' cables are the Xilinx DLC5
525 and the Macraigor Wiggler. There are many clones and variations of
526 these on the market.
527
528 Note that parallel ports are becoming much less common, so if you
529 have the choice you should probably avoid these adapters in favor
530 of USB-based ones.
531
532 @itemize @bullet
533
534 @item @b{Wiggler} - There are many clones of this.
535 @* Link: @url{http://www.macraigor.com/wiggler.htm}
536
537 @item @b{DLC5} - From XILINX - There are many clones of this
538 @* Link: Search the web for: ``XILINX DLC5'' - it is no longer
539 produced, PDF schematics are easily found and it is easy to make.
540
541 @item @b{Amontec - JTAG Accelerator}
542 @* Link: @url{http://www.amontec.com/jtag_accelerator.shtml}
543
544 @item @b{Wiggler2}
545 @* Link: @url{http://www.ccac.rwth-aachen.de/~michaels/index.php/hardware/armjtag}
546
547 @item @b{Wiggler_ntrst_inverted}
548 @* Yet another variation - See the source code, src/jtag/parport.c
549
550 @item @b{old_amt_wiggler}
551 @* Unknown - probably not on the market today
552
553 @item @b{arm-jtag}
554 @* Link: Most likely @url{http://www.olimex.com/dev/arm-jtag.html} [another wiggler clone]
555
556 @item @b{chameleon}
557 @* Link: @url{http://www.amontec.com/chameleon.shtml}
558
559 @item @b{Triton}
560 @* Unknown.
561
562 @item @b{Lattice}
563 @* ispDownload from Lattice Semiconductor
564 @url{http://www.latticesemi.com/lit/docs/@/devtools/dlcable.pdf}
565
566 @item @b{flashlink}
567 @* From STMicroelectronics;
568 @* Link: @url{http://www.st.com/internet/com/TECHNICAL_RESOURCES/TECHNICAL_LITERATURE/DATA_BRIEF/DM00039500.pdf}
569
570 @end itemize
571
572 @section Other...
573 @itemize @bullet
574
575 @item @b{ep93xx}
576 @* An EP93xx based Linux machine using the GPIO pins directly.
577
578 @item @b{at91rm9200}
579 @* Like the EP93xx - but an ATMEL AT91RM9200 based solution using the GPIO pins on the chip.
580
581 @item @b{bcm2835gpio}
582 @* A BCM2835-based board (e.g. Raspberry Pi) using the GPIO pins of the expansion header.
583
584 @item @b{imx_gpio}
585 @* A NXP i.MX-based board (e.g. Wandboard) using the GPIO pins (should work on any i.MX processor).
586
587 @item @b{jtag_vpi}
588 @* A JTAG driver acting as a client for the JTAG VPI server interface.
589 @* Link: @url{http://github.com/fjullien/jtag_vpi}
590
591 @item @b{jtag_dpi}
592 @* A JTAG driver acting as a client for the SystemVerilog Direct Programming
593 Interface (DPI) for JTAG devices. DPI allows OpenOCD to connect to the JTAG
594 interface of a hardware model written in SystemVerilog, for example, on an
595 emulation model of target hardware.
596
597 @item @b{xlnx_pcie_xvc}
598 @* A JTAG driver exposing Xilinx Virtual Cable over PCI Express to OpenOCD as JTAG/SWD interface.
599
600 @item @b{linuxgpiod}
601 @* A bitbang JTAG driver using Linux GPIO through library libgpiod.
602
603 @item @b{sysfsgpio}
604 @* A bitbang JTAG driver using Linux legacy sysfs GPIO.
605 This is deprecated from Linux v5.3; prefer using @b{linuxgpiod}.
606
607 @end itemize
608
609 @node About Jim-Tcl
610 @chapter About Jim-Tcl
611 @cindex Jim-Tcl
612 @cindex tcl
613
614 OpenOCD uses a small ``Tcl Interpreter'' known as Jim-Tcl.
615 This programming language provides a simple and extensible
616 command interpreter.
617
618 All commands presented in this Guide are extensions to Jim-Tcl.
619 You can use them as simple commands, without needing to learn
620 much of anything about Tcl.
621 Alternatively, you can write Tcl programs with them.
622
623 You can learn more about Jim at its website, @url{http://jim.tcl.tk}.
624 There is an active and responsive community, get on the mailing list
625 if you have any questions. Jim-Tcl maintainers also lurk on the
626 OpenOCD mailing list.
627
628 @itemize @bullet
629 @item @b{Jim vs. Tcl}
630 @* Jim-Tcl is a stripped down version of the well known Tcl language,
631 which can be found here: @url{http://www.tcl.tk}. Jim-Tcl has far
632 fewer features. Jim-Tcl is several dozens of .C files and .H files and
633 implements the basic Tcl command set. In contrast: Tcl 8.6 is a
634 4.2 MB .zip file containing 1540 files.
635
636 @item @b{Missing Features}
637 @* Our practice has been: Add/clone the real Tcl feature if/when
638 needed. We welcome Jim-Tcl improvements, not bloat. Also there
639 are a large number of optional Jim-Tcl features that are not
640 enabled in OpenOCD.
641
642 @item @b{Scripts}
643 @* OpenOCD configuration scripts are Jim-Tcl Scripts. OpenOCD's
644 command interpreter today is a mixture of (newer)
645 Jim-Tcl commands, and the (older) original command interpreter.
646
647 @item @b{Commands}
648 @* At the OpenOCD telnet command line (or via the GDB monitor command) one
649 can type a Tcl for() loop, set variables, etc.
650 Some of the commands documented in this guide are implemented
651 as Tcl scripts, from a @file{startup.tcl} file internal to the server.
652
653 @item @b{Historical Note}
654 @* Jim-Tcl was introduced to OpenOCD in spring 2008. Fall 2010,
655 before OpenOCD 0.5 release, OpenOCD switched to using Jim-Tcl
656 as a Git submodule, which greatly simplified upgrading Jim-Tcl
657 to benefit from new features and bugfixes in Jim-Tcl.
658
659 @item @b{Need a crash course in Tcl?}
660 @*@xref{Tcl Crash Course}.
661 @end itemize
662
663 @node Running
664 @chapter Running
665 @cindex command line options
666 @cindex logfile
667 @cindex directory search
668
669 Properly installing OpenOCD sets up your operating system to grant it access
670 to the debug adapters. On Linux, this usually involves installing a file
671 in @file{/etc/udev/rules.d,} so OpenOCD has permissions. An example rules file
672 that works for many common adapters is shipped with OpenOCD in the
673 @file{contrib} directory. MS-Windows needs
674 complex and confusing driver configuration for every peripheral. Such issues
675 are unique to each operating system, and are not detailed in this User's Guide.
676
677 Then later you will invoke the OpenOCD server, with various options to
678 tell it how each debug session should work.
679 The @option{--help} option shows:
680 @verbatim
681 bash$ openocd --help
682
683 --help | -h display this help
684 --version | -v display OpenOCD version
685 --file | -f use configuration file <name>
686 --search | -s dir to search for config files and scripts
687 --debug | -d set debug level to 3
688 | -d<n> set debug level to <level>
689 --log_output | -l redirect log output to file <name>
690 --command | -c run <command>
691 @end verbatim
692
693 If you don't give any @option{-f} or @option{-c} options,
694 OpenOCD tries to read the configuration file @file{openocd.cfg}.
695 To specify one or more different
696 configuration files, use @option{-f} options. For example:
697
698 @example
699 openocd -f config1.cfg -f config2.cfg -f config3.cfg
700 @end example
701
702 Configuration files and scripts are searched for in
703 @enumerate
704 @item the current directory,
705 @item any search dir specified on the command line using the @option{-s} option,
706 @item any search dir specified using the @command{add_script_search_dir} command,
707 @item a directory in the @env{OPENOCD_SCRIPTS} environment variable (if set),
708 @item @file{%APPDATA%/OpenOCD} (only on Windows),
709 @item @file{$HOME/Library/Preferences/org.openocd} (only on Darwin),
710 @item @file{$XDG_CONFIG_HOME/openocd} (@env{$XDG_CONFIG_HOME} defaults to @file{$HOME/.config}),
711 @item @file{$HOME/.openocd},
712 @item the site wide script library @file{$pkgdatadir/site} and
713 @item the OpenOCD-supplied script library @file{$pkgdatadir/scripts}.
714 @end enumerate
715 The first found file with a matching file name will be used.
716
717 @quotation Note
718 Don't try to use configuration script names or paths which
719 include the "#" character. That character begins Tcl comments.
720 @end quotation
721
722 @section Simple setup, no customization
723
724 In the best case, you can use two scripts from one of the script
725 libraries, hook up your JTAG adapter, and start the server ... and
726 your JTAG setup will just work "out of the box". Always try to
727 start by reusing those scripts, but assume you'll need more
728 customization even if this works. @xref{OpenOCD Project Setup}.
729
730 If you find a script for your JTAG adapter, and for your board or
731 target, you may be able to hook up your JTAG adapter then start
732 the server with some variation of one of the following:
733
734 @example
735 openocd -f interface/ADAPTER.cfg -f board/MYBOARD.cfg
736 openocd -f interface/ftdi/ADAPTER.cfg -f board/MYBOARD.cfg
737 @end example
738
739 You might also need to configure which reset signals are present,
740 using @option{-c 'reset_config trst_and_srst'} or something similar.
741 If all goes well you'll see output something like
742
743 @example
744 Open On-Chip Debugger 0.4.0 (2010-01-14-15:06)
745 For bug reports, read
746 http://openocd.org/doc/doxygen/bugs.html
747 Info : JTAG tap: lm3s.cpu tap/device found: 0x3ba00477
748 (mfg: 0x23b, part: 0xba00, ver: 0x3)
749 @end example
750
751 Seeing that "tap/device found" message, and no warnings, means
752 the JTAG communication is working. That's a key milestone, but
753 you'll probably need more project-specific setup.
754
755 @section What OpenOCD does as it starts
756
757 OpenOCD starts by processing the configuration commands provided
758 on the command line or, if there were no @option{-c command} or
759 @option{-f file.cfg} options given, in @file{openocd.cfg}.
760 @xref{configurationstage,,Configuration Stage}.
761 At the end of the configuration stage it verifies the JTAG scan
762 chain defined using those commands; your configuration should
763 ensure that this always succeeds.
764 Normally, OpenOCD then starts running as a server.
765 Alternatively, commands may be used to terminate the configuration
766 stage early, perform work (such as updating some flash memory),
767 and then shut down without acting as a server.
768
769 Once OpenOCD starts running as a server, it waits for connections from
770 clients (Telnet, GDB, RPC) and processes the commands issued through
771 those channels.
772
773 If you are having problems, you can enable internal debug messages via
774 the @option{-d} option.
775
776 Also it is possible to interleave Jim-Tcl commands w/config scripts using the
777 @option{-c} command line switch.
778
779 To enable debug output (when reporting problems or working on OpenOCD
780 itself), use the @option{-d} command line switch. This sets the
781 @option{debug_level} to "3", outputting the most information,
782 including debug messages. The default setting is "2", outputting only
783 informational messages, warnings and errors. You can also change this
784 setting from within a telnet or gdb session using @command{debug_level<n>}
785 (@pxref{debuglevel,,debug_level}).
786
787 You can redirect all output from the server to a file using the
788 @option{-l <logfile>} switch.
789
790 Note! OpenOCD will launch the GDB & telnet server even if it can not
791 establish a connection with the target. In general, it is possible for
792 the JTAG controller to be unresponsive until the target is set up
793 correctly via e.g. GDB monitor commands in a GDB init script.
794
795 @node OpenOCD Project Setup
796 @chapter OpenOCD Project Setup
797
798 To use OpenOCD with your development projects, you need to do more than
799 just connect the JTAG adapter hardware (dongle) to your development board
800 and start the OpenOCD server.
801 You also need to configure your OpenOCD server so that it knows
802 about your adapter and board, and helps your work.
803 You may also want to connect OpenOCD to GDB, possibly
804 using Eclipse or some other GUI.
805
806 @section Hooking up the JTAG Adapter
807
808 Today's most common case is a dongle with a JTAG cable on one side
809 (such as a ribbon cable with a 10-pin or 20-pin IDC connector)
810 and a USB cable on the other.
811 Instead of USB, some dongles use Ethernet;
812 older ones may use a PC parallel port, or even a serial port.
813
814 @enumerate
815 @item @emph{Start with power to your target board turned off},
816 and nothing connected to your JTAG adapter.
817 If you're particularly paranoid, unplug power to the board.
818 It's important to have the ground signal properly set up,
819 unless you are using a JTAG adapter which provides
820 galvanic isolation between the target board and the
821 debugging host.
822
823 @item @emph{Be sure it's the right kind of JTAG connector.}
824 If your dongle has a 20-pin ARM connector, you need some kind
825 of adapter (or octopus, see below) to hook it up to
826 boards using 14-pin or 10-pin connectors ... or to 20-pin
827 connectors which don't use ARM's pinout.
828
829 In the same vein, make sure the voltage levels are compatible.
830 Not all JTAG adapters have the level shifters needed to work
831 with 1.2 Volt boards.
832
833 @item @emph{Be certain the cable is properly oriented} or you might
834 damage your board. In most cases there are only two possible
835 ways to connect the cable.
836 Connect the JTAG cable from your adapter to the board.
837 Be sure it's firmly connected.
838
839 In the best case, the connector is keyed to physically
840 prevent you from inserting it wrong.
841 This is most often done using a slot on the board's male connector
842 housing, which must match a key on the JTAG cable's female connector.
843 If there's no housing, then you must look carefully and
844 make sure pin 1 on the cable hooks up to pin 1 on the board.
845 Ribbon cables are frequently all grey except for a wire on one
846 edge, which is red. The red wire is pin 1.
847
848 Sometimes dongles provide cables where one end is an ``octopus'' of
849 color coded single-wire connectors, instead of a connector block.
850 These are great when converting from one JTAG pinout to another,
851 but are tedious to set up.
852 Use these with connector pinout diagrams to help you match up the
853 adapter signals to the right board pins.
854
855 @item @emph{Connect the adapter's other end} once the JTAG cable is connected.
856 A USB, parallel, or serial port connector will go to the host which
857 you are using to run OpenOCD.
858 For Ethernet, consult the documentation and your network administrator.
859
860 For USB-based JTAG adapters you have an easy sanity check at this point:
861 does the host operating system see the JTAG adapter? If you're running
862 Linux, try the @command{lsusb} command. If that host is an
863 MS-Windows host, you'll need to install a driver before OpenOCD works.
864
865 @item @emph{Connect the adapter's power supply, if needed.}
866 This step is primarily for non-USB adapters,
867 but sometimes USB adapters need extra power.
868
869 @item @emph{Power up the target board.}
870 Unless you just let the magic smoke escape,
871 you're now ready to set up the OpenOCD server
872 so you can use JTAG to work with that board.
873
874 @end enumerate
875
876 Talk with the OpenOCD server using
877 telnet (@code{telnet localhost 4444} on many systems) or GDB.
878 @xref{GDB and OpenOCD}.
879
880 @section Project Directory
881
882 There are many ways you can configure OpenOCD and start it up.
883
884 A simple way to organize them all involves keeping a
885 single directory for your work with a given board.
886 When you start OpenOCD from that directory,
887 it searches there first for configuration files, scripts,
888 files accessed through semihosting,
889 and for code you upload to the target board.
890 It is also the natural place to write files,
891 such as log files and data you download from the board.
892
893 @section Configuration Basics
894
895 There are two basic ways of configuring OpenOCD, and
896 a variety of ways you can mix them.
897 Think of the difference as just being how you start the server:
898
899 @itemize
900 @item Many @option{-f file} or @option{-c command} options on the command line
901 @item No options, but a @dfn{user config file}
902 in the current directory named @file{openocd.cfg}
903 @end itemize
904
905 Here is an example @file{openocd.cfg} file for a setup
906 using a Signalyzer FT2232-based JTAG adapter to talk to
907 a board with an Atmel AT91SAM7X256 microcontroller:
908
909 @example
910 source [find interface/ftdi/signalyzer.cfg]
911
912 # GDB can also flash my flash!
913 gdb_memory_map enable
914 gdb_flash_program enable
915
916 source [find target/sam7x256.cfg]
917 @end example
918
919 Here is the command line equivalent of that configuration:
920
921 @example
922 openocd -f interface/ftdi/signalyzer.cfg \
923 -c "gdb_memory_map enable" \
924 -c "gdb_flash_program enable" \
925 -f target/sam7x256.cfg
926 @end example
927
928 You could wrap such long command lines in shell scripts,
929 each supporting a different development task.
930 One might re-flash the board with a specific firmware version.
931 Another might set up a particular debugging or run-time environment.
932
933 @quotation Important
934 At this writing (October 2009) the command line method has
935 problems with how it treats variables.
936 For example, after @option{-c "set VAR value"}, or doing the
937 same in a script, the variable @var{VAR} will have no value
938 that can be tested in a later script.
939 @end quotation
940
941 Here we will focus on the simpler solution: one user config
942 file, including basic configuration plus any TCL procedures
943 to simplify your work.
944
945 @section User Config Files
946 @cindex config file, user
947 @cindex user config file
948 @cindex config file, overview
949
950 A user configuration file ties together all the parts of a project
951 in one place.
952 One of the following will match your situation best:
953
954 @itemize
955 @item Ideally almost everything comes from configuration files
956 provided by someone else.
957 For example, OpenOCD distributes a @file{scripts} directory
958 (probably in @file{/usr/share/openocd/scripts} on Linux).
959 Board and tool vendors can provide these too, as can individual
960 user sites; the @option{-s} command line option lets you say
961 where to find these files. (@xref{Running}.)
962 The AT91SAM7X256 example above works this way.
963
964 Three main types of non-user configuration file each have their
965 own subdirectory in the @file{scripts} directory:
966
967 @enumerate
968 @item @b{interface} -- one for each different debug adapter;
969 @item @b{board} -- one for each different board
970 @item @b{target} -- the chips which integrate CPUs and other JTAG TAPs
971 @end enumerate
972
973 Best case: include just two files, and they handle everything else.
974 The first is an interface config file.
975 The second is board-specific, and it sets up the JTAG TAPs and
976 their GDB targets (by deferring to some @file{target.cfg} file),
977 declares all flash memory, and leaves you nothing to do except
978 meet your deadline:
979
980 @example
981 source [find interface/olimex-jtag-tiny.cfg]
982 source [find board/csb337.cfg]
983 @end example
984
985 Boards with a single microcontroller often won't need more
986 than the target config file, as in the AT91SAM7X256 example.
987 That's because there is no external memory (flash, DDR RAM), and
988 the board differences are encapsulated by application code.
989
990 @item Maybe you don't know yet what your board looks like to JTAG.
991 Once you know the @file{interface.cfg} file to use, you may
992 need help from OpenOCD to discover what's on the board.
993 Once you find the JTAG TAPs, you can just search for appropriate
994 target and board
995 configuration files ... or write your own, from the bottom up.
996 @xref{autoprobing,,Autoprobing}.
997
998 @item You can often reuse some standard config files but
999 need to write a few new ones, probably a @file{board.cfg} file.
1000 You will be using commands described later in this User's Guide,
1001 and working with the guidelines in the next chapter.
1002
1003 For example, there may be configuration files for your JTAG adapter
1004 and target chip, but you need a new board-specific config file
1005 giving access to your particular flash chips.
1006 Or you might need to write another target chip configuration file
1007 for a new chip built around the Cortex-M3 core.
1008
1009 @quotation Note
1010 When you write new configuration files, please submit
1011 them for inclusion in the next OpenOCD release.
1012 For example, a @file{board/newboard.cfg} file will help the
1013 next users of that board, and a @file{target/newcpu.cfg}
1014 will help support users of any board using that chip.
1015 @end quotation
1016
1017 @item
1018 You may need to write some C code.
1019 It may be as simple as supporting a new FT2232 or parport
1020 based adapter; a bit more involved, like a NAND or NOR flash
1021 controller driver; or a big piece of work like supporting
1022 a new chip architecture.
1023 @end itemize
1024
1025 Reuse the existing config files when you can.
1026 Look first in the @file{scripts/boards} area, then @file{scripts/targets}.
1027 You may find a board configuration that's a good example to follow.
1028
1029 When you write config files, separate the reusable parts
1030 (things every user of that interface, chip, or board needs)
1031 from ones specific to your environment and debugging approach.
1032 @itemize
1033
1034 @item
1035 For example, a @code{gdb-attach} event handler that invokes
1036 the @command{reset init} command will interfere with debugging
1037 early boot code, which performs some of the same actions
1038 that the @code{reset-init} event handler does.
1039
1040 @item
1041 Likewise, the @command{arm9 vector_catch} command (or
1042 @cindex vector_catch
1043 its siblings @command{xscale vector_catch}
1044 and @command{cortex_m vector_catch}) can be a time-saver
1045 during some debug sessions, but don't make everyone use that either.
1046 Keep those kinds of debugging aids in your user config file,
1047 along with messaging and tracing setup.
1048 (@xref{softwaredebugmessagesandtracing,,Software Debug Messages and Tracing}.)
1049
1050 @item
1051 You might need to override some defaults.
1052 For example, you might need to move, shrink, or back up the target's
1053 work area if your application needs much SRAM.
1054
1055 @item
1056 TCP/IP port configuration is another example of something which
1057 is environment-specific, and should only appear in
1058 a user config file. @xref{tcpipports,,TCP/IP Ports}.
1059 @end itemize
1060
1061 @section Project-Specific Utilities
1062
1063 A few project-specific utility
1064 routines may well speed up your work.
1065 Write them, and keep them in your project's user config file.
1066
1067 For example, if you are making a boot loader work on a
1068 board, it's nice to be able to debug the ``after it's
1069 loaded to RAM'' parts separately from the finicky early
1070 code which sets up the DDR RAM controller and clocks.
1071 A script like this one, or a more GDB-aware sibling,
1072 may help:
1073
1074 @example
1075 proc ramboot @{ @} @{
1076 # Reset, running the target's "reset-init" scripts
1077 # to initialize clocks and the DDR RAM controller.
1078 # Leave the CPU halted.
1079 reset init
1080
1081 # Load CONFIG_SKIP_LOWLEVEL_INIT version into DDR RAM.
1082 load_image u-boot.bin 0x20000000
1083
1084 # Start running.
1085 resume 0x20000000
1086 @}
1087 @end example
1088
1089 Then once that code is working you will need to make it
1090 boot from NOR flash; a different utility would help.
1091 Alternatively, some developers write to flash using GDB.
1092 (You might use a similar script if you're working with a flash
1093 based microcontroller application instead of a boot loader.)
1094
1095 @example
1096 proc newboot @{ @} @{
1097 # Reset, leaving the CPU halted. The "reset-init" event
1098 # proc gives faster access to the CPU and to NOR flash;
1099 # "reset halt" would be slower.
1100 reset init
1101
1102 # Write standard version of U-Boot into the first two
1103 # sectors of NOR flash ... the standard version should
1104 # do the same lowlevel init as "reset-init".
1105 flash protect 0 0 1 off
1106 flash erase_sector 0 0 1
1107 flash write_bank 0 u-boot.bin 0x0
1108 flash protect 0 0 1 on
1109
1110 # Reboot from scratch using that new boot loader.
1111 reset run
1112 @}
1113 @end example
1114
1115 You may need more complicated utility procedures when booting
1116 from NAND.
1117 That often involves an extra bootloader stage,
1118 running from on-chip SRAM to perform DDR RAM setup so it can load
1119 the main bootloader code (which won't fit into that SRAM).
1120
1121 Other helper scripts might be used to write production system images,
1122 involving considerably more than just a three stage bootloader.
1123
1124 @section Target Software Changes
1125
1126 Sometimes you may want to make some small changes to the software
1127 you're developing, to help make JTAG debugging work better.
1128 For example, in C or assembly language code you might
1129 use @code{#ifdef JTAG_DEBUG} (or its converse) around code
1130 handling issues like:
1131
1132 @itemize @bullet
1133
1134 @item @b{Watchdog Timers}...
1135 Watchdog timers are typically used to automatically reset systems if
1136 some application task doesn't periodically reset the timer. (The
1137 assumption is that the system has locked up if the task can't run.)
1138 When a JTAG debugger halts the system, that task won't be able to run
1139 and reset the timer ... potentially causing resets in the middle of
1140 your debug sessions.
1141
1142 It's rarely a good idea to disable such watchdogs, since their usage
1143 needs to be debugged just like all other parts of your firmware.
1144 That might however be your only option.
1145
1146 Look instead for chip-specific ways to stop the watchdog from counting
1147 while the system is in a debug halt state. It may be simplest to set
1148 that non-counting mode in your debugger startup scripts. You may however
1149 need a different approach when, for example, a motor could be physically
1150 damaged by firmware remaining inactive in a debug halt state. That might
1151 involve a type of firmware mode where that "non-counting" mode is disabled
1152 at the beginning then re-enabled at the end; a watchdog reset might fire
1153 and complicate the debug session, but hardware (or people) would be
1154 protected.@footnote{Note that many systems support a "monitor mode" debug
1155 that is a somewhat cleaner way to address such issues. You can think of
1156 it as only halting part of the system, maybe just one task,
1157 instead of the whole thing.
1158 At this writing, January 2010, OpenOCD based debugging does not support
1159 monitor mode debug, only "halt mode" debug.}
1160
1161 @item @b{ARM Semihosting}...
1162 @cindex ARM semihosting
1163 When linked with a special runtime library provided with many
1164 toolchains@footnote{See chapter 8 "Semihosting" in
1165 @uref{http://infocenter.arm.com/help/topic/com.arm.doc.dui0203i/DUI0203I_rvct_developer_guide.pdf,
1166 ARM DUI 0203I}, the "RealView Compilation Tools Developer Guide".
1167 The CodeSourcery EABI toolchain also includes a semihosting library.},
1168 your target code can use I/O facilities on the debug host. That library
1169 provides a small set of system calls which are handled by OpenOCD.
1170 It can let the debugger provide your system console and a file system,
1171 helping with early debugging or providing a more capable environment
1172 for sometimes-complex tasks like installing system firmware onto
1173 NAND or SPI flash.
1174
1175 @item @b{ARM Wait-For-Interrupt}...
1176 Many ARM chips synchronize the JTAG clock using the core clock.
1177 Low power states which stop that core clock thus prevent JTAG access.
1178 Idle loops in tasking environments often enter those low power states
1179 via the @code{WFI} instruction (or its coprocessor equivalent, before ARMv7).
1180
1181 You may want to @emph{disable that instruction} in source code,
1182 or otherwise prevent using that state,
1183 to ensure you can get JTAG access at any time.@footnote{As a more
1184 polite alternative, some processors have special debug-oriented
1185 registers which can be used to change various features including
1186 how the low power states are clocked while debugging.
1187 The STM32 DBGMCU_CR register is an example; at the cost of extra
1188 power consumption, JTAG can be used during low power states.}
1189 For example, the OpenOCD @command{halt} command may not
1190 work for an idle processor otherwise.
1191
1192 @item @b{Delay after reset}...
1193 Not all chips have good support for debugger access
1194 right after reset; many LPC2xxx chips have issues here.
1195 Similarly, applications that reconfigure pins used for
1196 JTAG access as they start will also block debugger access.
1197
1198 To work with boards like this, @emph{enable a short delay loop}
1199 the first thing after reset, before "real" startup activities.
1200 For example, one second's delay is usually more than enough
1201 time for a JTAG debugger to attach, so that
1202 early code execution can be debugged
1203 or firmware can be replaced.
1204
1205 @item @b{Debug Communications Channel (DCC)}...
1206 Some processors include mechanisms to send messages over JTAG.
1207 Many ARM cores support these, as do some cores from other vendors.
1208 (OpenOCD may be able to use this DCC internally, speeding up some
1209 operations like writing to memory.)
1210
1211 Your application may want to deliver various debugging messages
1212 over JTAG, by @emph{linking with a small library of code}
1213 provided with OpenOCD and using the utilities there to send
1214 various kinds of message.
1215 @xref{softwaredebugmessagesandtracing,,Software Debug Messages and Tracing}.
1216
1217 @end itemize
1218
1219 @section Target Hardware Setup
1220
1221 Chip vendors often provide software development boards which
1222 are highly configurable, so that they can support all options
1223 that product boards may require. @emph{Make sure that any
1224 jumpers or switches match the system configuration you are
1225 working with.}
1226
1227 Common issues include:
1228
1229 @itemize @bullet
1230
1231 @item @b{JTAG setup} ...
1232 Boards may support more than one JTAG configuration.
1233 Examples include jumpers controlling pullups versus pulldowns
1234 on the nTRST and/or nSRST signals, and choice of connectors
1235 (e.g. which of two headers on the base board,
1236 or one from a daughtercard).
1237 For some Texas Instruments boards, you may need to jumper the
1238 EMU0 and EMU1 signals (which OpenOCD won't currently control).
1239
1240 @item @b{Boot Modes} ...
1241 Complex chips often support multiple boot modes, controlled
1242 by external jumpers. Make sure this is set up correctly.
1243 For example many i.MX boards from NXP need to be jumpered
1244 to "ATX mode" to start booting using the on-chip ROM, when
1245 using second stage bootloader code stored in a NAND flash chip.
1246
1247 Such explicit configuration is common, and not limited to
1248 booting from NAND. You might also need to set jumpers to
1249 start booting using code loaded from an MMC/SD card; external
1250 SPI flash; Ethernet, UART, or USB links; NOR flash; OneNAND
1251 flash; some external host; or various other sources.
1252
1253
1254 @item @b{Memory Addressing} ...
1255 Boards which support multiple boot modes may also have jumpers
1256 to configure memory addressing. One board, for example, jumpers
1257 external chipselect 0 (used for booting) to address either
1258 a large SRAM (which must be pre-loaded via JTAG), NOR flash,
1259 or NAND flash. When it's jumpered to address NAND flash, that
1260 board must also be told to start booting from on-chip ROM.
1261
1262 Your @file{board.cfg} file may also need to be told this jumper
1263 configuration, so that it can know whether to declare NOR flash
1264 using @command{flash bank} or instead declare NAND flash with
1265 @command{nand device}; and likewise which probe to perform in
1266 its @code{reset-init} handler.
1267
1268 A closely related issue is bus width. Jumpers might need to
1269 distinguish between 8 bit or 16 bit bus access for the flash
1270 used to start booting.
1271
1272 @item @b{Peripheral Access} ...
1273 Development boards generally provide access to every peripheral
1274 on the chip, sometimes in multiple modes (such as by providing
1275 multiple audio codec chips).
1276 This interacts with software
1277 configuration of pin multiplexing, where for example a
1278 given pin may be routed either to the MMC/SD controller
1279 or the GPIO controller. It also often interacts with
1280 configuration jumpers. One jumper may be used to route
1281 signals to an MMC/SD card slot or an expansion bus (which
1282 might in turn affect booting); others might control which
1283 audio or video codecs are used.
1284
1285 @end itemize
1286
1287 Plus you should of course have @code{reset-init} event handlers
1288 which set up the hardware to match that jumper configuration.
1289 That includes in particular any oscillator or PLL used to clock
1290 the CPU, and any memory controllers needed to access external
1291 memory and peripherals. Without such handlers, you won't be
1292 able to access those resources without working target firmware
1293 which can do that setup ... this can be awkward when you're
1294 trying to debug that target firmware. Even if there's a ROM
1295 bootloader which handles a few issues, it rarely provides full
1296 access to all board-specific capabilities.
1297
1298
1299 @node Config File Guidelines
1300 @chapter Config File Guidelines
1301
1302 This chapter is aimed at any user who needs to write a config file,
1303 including developers and integrators of OpenOCD and any user who
1304 needs to get a new board working smoothly.
1305 It provides guidelines for creating those files.
1306
1307 You should find the following directories under
1308 @t{$(INSTALLDIR)/scripts}, with config files maintained upstream. Use
1309 them as-is where you can; or as models for new files.
1310 @itemize @bullet
1311 @item @file{interface} ...
1312 These are for debug adapters. Files that specify configuration to use
1313 specific JTAG, SWD and other adapters go here.
1314 @item @file{board} ...
1315 Think Circuit Board, PWA, PCB, they go by many names. Board files
1316 contain initialization items that are specific to a board.
1317
1318 They reuse target configuration files, since the same
1319 microprocessor chips are used on many boards,
1320 but support for external parts varies widely. For
1321 example, the SDRAM initialization sequence for the board, or the type
1322 of external flash and what address it uses. Any initialization
1323 sequence to enable that external flash or SDRAM should be found in the
1324 board file. Boards may also contain multiple targets: two CPUs; or
1325 a CPU and an FPGA.
1326 @item @file{target} ...
1327 Think chip. The ``target'' directory represents the JTAG TAPs
1328 on a chip
1329 which OpenOCD should control, not a board. Two common types of targets
1330 are ARM chips and FPGA or CPLD chips.
1331 When a chip has multiple TAPs (maybe it has both ARM and DSP cores),
1332 the target config file defines all of them.
1333 @item @emph{more} ... browse for other library files which may be useful.
1334 For example, there are various generic and CPU-specific utilities.
1335 @end itemize
1336
1337 The @file{openocd.cfg} user config
1338 file may override features in any of the above files by
1339 setting variables before sourcing the target file, or by adding
1340 commands specific to their situation.
1341
1342 @section Interface Config Files
1343
1344 The user config file
1345 should be able to source one of these files with a command like this:
1346
1347 @example
1348 source [find interface/FOOBAR.cfg]
1349 @end example
1350
1351 A preconfigured interface file should exist for every debug adapter
1352 in use today with OpenOCD.
1353 That said, perhaps some of these config files
1354 have only been used by the developer who created it.
1355
1356 A separate chapter gives information about how to set these up.
1357 @xref{Debug Adapter Configuration}.
1358 Read the OpenOCD source code (and Developer's Guide)
1359 if you have a new kind of hardware interface
1360 and need to provide a driver for it.
1361
1362 @deffn {Command} {find} 'filename'
1363 Prints full path to @var{filename} according to OpenOCD search rules.
1364 @end deffn
1365
1366 @deffn {Command} {ocd_find} 'filename'
1367 Prints full path to @var{filename} according to OpenOCD search rules. This
1368 is a low level function used by the @command{find}. Usually you want
1369 to use @command{find}, instead.
1370 @end deffn
1371
1372 @section Board Config Files
1373 @cindex config file, board
1374 @cindex board config file
1375
1376 The user config file
1377 should be able to source one of these files with a command like this:
1378
1379 @example
1380 source [find board/FOOBAR.cfg]
1381 @end example
1382
1383 The point of a board config file is to package everything
1384 about a given board that user config files need to know.
1385 In summary the board files should contain (if present)
1386
1387 @enumerate
1388 @item One or more @command{source [find target/...cfg]} statements
1389 @item NOR flash configuration (@pxref{norconfiguration,,NOR Configuration})
1390 @item NAND flash configuration (@pxref{nandconfiguration,,NAND Configuration})
1391 @item Target @code{reset} handlers for SDRAM and I/O configuration
1392 @item JTAG adapter reset configuration (@pxref{Reset Configuration})
1393 @item All things that are not ``inside a chip''
1394 @end enumerate
1395
1396 Generic things inside target chips belong in target config files,
1397 not board config files. So for example a @code{reset-init} event
1398 handler should know board-specific oscillator and PLL parameters,
1399 which it passes to target-specific utility code.
1400
1401 The most complex task of a board config file is creating such a
1402 @code{reset-init} event handler.
1403 Define those handlers last, after you verify the rest of the board
1404 configuration works.
1405
1406 @subsection Communication Between Config files
1407
1408 In addition to target-specific utility code, another way that
1409 board and target config files communicate is by following a
1410 convention on how to use certain variables.
1411
1412 The full Tcl/Tk language supports ``namespaces'', but Jim-Tcl does not.
1413 Thus the rule we follow in OpenOCD is this: Variables that begin with
1414 a leading underscore are temporary in nature, and can be modified and
1415 used at will within a target configuration file.
1416
1417 Complex board config files can do the things like this,
1418 for a board with three chips:
1419
1420 @example
1421 # Chip #1: PXA270 for network side, big endian
1422 set CHIPNAME network
1423 set ENDIAN big
1424 source [find target/pxa270.cfg]
1425 # on return: _TARGETNAME = network.cpu
1426 # other commands can refer to the "network.cpu" target.
1427 $_TARGETNAME configure .... events for this CPU..
1428
1429 # Chip #2: PXA270 for video side, little endian
1430 set CHIPNAME video
1431 set ENDIAN little
1432 source [find target/pxa270.cfg]
1433 # on return: _TARGETNAME = video.cpu
1434 # other commands can refer to the "video.cpu" target.
1435 $_TARGETNAME configure .... events for this CPU..
1436
1437 # Chip #3: Xilinx FPGA for glue logic
1438 set CHIPNAME xilinx
1439 unset ENDIAN
1440 source [find target/spartan3.cfg]
1441 @end example
1442
1443 That example is oversimplified because it doesn't show any flash memory,
1444 or the @code{reset-init} event handlers to initialize external DRAM
1445 or (assuming it needs it) load a configuration into the FPGA.
1446 Such features are usually needed for low-level work with many boards,
1447 where ``low level'' implies that the board initialization software may
1448 not be working. (That's a common reason to need JTAG tools. Another
1449 is to enable working with microcontroller-based systems, which often
1450 have no debugging support except a JTAG connector.)
1451
1452 Target config files may also export utility functions to board and user
1453 config files. Such functions should use name prefixes, to help avoid
1454 naming collisions.
1455
1456 Board files could also accept input variables from user config files.
1457 For example, there might be a @code{J4_JUMPER} setting used to identify
1458 what kind of flash memory a development board is using, or how to set
1459 up other clocks and peripherals.
1460
1461 @subsection Variable Naming Convention
1462 @cindex variable names
1463
1464 Most boards have only one instance of a chip.
1465 However, it should be easy to create a board with more than
1466 one such chip (as shown above).
1467 Accordingly, we encourage these conventions for naming
1468 variables associated with different @file{target.cfg} files,
1469 to promote consistency and
1470 so that board files can override target defaults.
1471
1472 Inputs to target config files include:
1473
1474 @itemize @bullet
1475 @item @code{CHIPNAME} ...
1476 This gives a name to the overall chip, and is used as part of
1477 tap identifier dotted names.
1478 While the default is normally provided by the chip manufacturer,
1479 board files may need to distinguish between instances of a chip.
1480 @item @code{ENDIAN} ...
1481 By default @option{little} - although chips may hard-wire @option{big}.
1482 Chips that can't change endianness don't need to use this variable.
1483 @item @code{CPUTAPID} ...
1484 When OpenOCD examines the JTAG chain, it can be told verify the
1485 chips against the JTAG IDCODE register.
1486 The target file will hold one or more defaults, but sometimes the
1487 chip in a board will use a different ID (perhaps a newer revision).
1488 @end itemize
1489
1490 Outputs from target config files include:
1491
1492 @itemize @bullet
1493 @item @code{_TARGETNAME} ...
1494 By convention, this variable is created by the target configuration
1495 script. The board configuration file may make use of this variable to
1496 configure things like a ``reset init'' script, or other things
1497 specific to that board and that target.
1498 If the chip has 2 targets, the names are @code{_TARGETNAME0},
1499 @code{_TARGETNAME1}, ... etc.
1500 @end itemize
1501
1502 @subsection The reset-init Event Handler
1503 @cindex event, reset-init
1504 @cindex reset-init handler
1505
1506 Board config files run in the OpenOCD configuration stage;
1507 they can't use TAPs or targets, since they haven't been
1508 fully set up yet.
1509 This means you can't write memory or access chip registers;
1510 you can't even verify that a flash chip is present.
1511 That's done later in event handlers, of which the target @code{reset-init}
1512 handler is one of the most important.
1513
1514 Except on microcontrollers, the basic job of @code{reset-init} event
1515 handlers is setting up flash and DRAM, as normally handled by boot loaders.
1516 Microcontrollers rarely use boot loaders; they run right out of their
1517 on-chip flash and SRAM memory. But they may want to use one of these
1518 handlers too, if just for developer convenience.
1519
1520 @quotation Note
1521 Because this is so very board-specific, and chip-specific, no examples
1522 are included here.
1523 Instead, look at the board config files distributed with OpenOCD.
1524 If you have a boot loader, its source code will help; so will
1525 configuration files for other JTAG tools
1526 (@pxref{translatingconfigurationfiles,,Translating Configuration Files}).
1527 @end quotation
1528
1529 Some of this code could probably be shared between different boards.
1530 For example, setting up a DRAM controller often doesn't differ by
1531 much except the bus width (16 bits or 32?) and memory timings, so a
1532 reusable TCL procedure loaded by the @file{target.cfg} file might take
1533 those as parameters.
1534 Similarly with oscillator, PLL, and clock setup;
1535 and disabling the watchdog.
1536 Structure the code cleanly, and provide comments to help
1537 the next developer doing such work.
1538 (@emph{You might be that next person} trying to reuse init code!)
1539
1540 The last thing normally done in a @code{reset-init} handler is probing
1541 whatever flash memory was configured. For most chips that needs to be
1542 done while the associated target is halted, either because JTAG memory
1543 access uses the CPU or to prevent conflicting CPU access.
1544
1545 @subsection JTAG Clock Rate
1546
1547 Before your @code{reset-init} handler has set up
1548 the PLLs and clocking, you may need to run with
1549 a low JTAG clock rate.
1550 @xref{jtagspeed,,JTAG Speed}.
1551 Then you'd increase that rate after your handler has
1552 made it possible to use the faster JTAG clock.
1553 When the initial low speed is board-specific, for example
1554 because it depends on a board-specific oscillator speed, then
1555 you should probably set it up in the board config file;
1556 if it's target-specific, it belongs in the target config file.
1557
1558 For most ARM-based processors the fastest JTAG clock@footnote{A FAQ
1559 @uref{http://www.arm.com/support/faqdev/4170.html} gives details.}
1560 is one sixth of the CPU clock; or one eighth for ARM11 cores.
1561 Consult chip documentation to determine the peak JTAG clock rate,
1562 which might be less than that.
1563
1564 @quotation Warning
1565 On most ARMs, JTAG clock detection is coupled to the core clock, so
1566 software using a @option{wait for interrupt} operation blocks JTAG access.
1567 Adaptive clocking provides a partial workaround, but a more complete
1568 solution just avoids using that instruction with JTAG debuggers.
1569 @end quotation
1570
1571 If both the chip and the board support adaptive clocking,
1572 use the @command{jtag_rclk}
1573 command, in case your board is used with JTAG adapter which
1574 also supports it. Otherwise use @command{adapter speed}.
1575 Set the slow rate at the beginning of the reset sequence,
1576 and the faster rate as soon as the clocks are at full speed.
1577
1578 @anchor{theinitboardprocedure}
1579 @subsection The init_board procedure
1580 @cindex init_board procedure
1581
1582 The concept of @code{init_board} procedure is very similar to @code{init_targets}
1583 (@xref{theinittargetsprocedure,,The init_targets procedure}.) - it's a replacement of ``linear''
1584 configuration scripts. This procedure is meant to be executed when OpenOCD enters run stage
1585 (@xref{enteringtherunstage,,Entering the Run Stage},) after @code{init_targets}. The idea to have
1586 separate @code{init_targets} and @code{init_board} procedures is to allow the first one to configure
1587 everything target specific (internal flash, internal RAM, etc.) and the second one to configure
1588 everything board specific (reset signals, chip frequency, reset-init event handler, external memory, etc.).
1589 Additionally ``linear'' board config file will most likely fail when target config file uses
1590 @code{init_targets} scheme (``linear'' script is executed before @code{init} and @code{init_targets} - after),
1591 so separating these two configuration stages is very convenient, as the easiest way to overcome this
1592 problem is to convert board config file to use @code{init_board} procedure. Board config scripts don't
1593 need to override @code{init_targets} defined in target config files when they only need to add some specifics.
1594
1595 Just as @code{init_targets}, the @code{init_board} procedure can be overridden by ``next level'' script (which sources
1596 the original), allowing greater code reuse.
1597
1598 @example
1599 ### board_file.cfg ###
1600
1601 # source target file that does most of the config in init_targets
1602 source [find target/target.cfg]
1603
1604 proc enable_fast_clock @{@} @{
1605 # enables fast on-board clock source
1606 # configures the chip to use it
1607 @}
1608
1609 # initialize only board specifics - reset, clock, adapter frequency
1610 proc init_board @{@} @{
1611 reset_config trst_and_srst trst_pulls_srst
1612
1613 $_TARGETNAME configure -event reset-start @{
1614 adapter speed 100
1615 @}
1616
1617 $_TARGETNAME configure -event reset-init @{
1618 enable_fast_clock
1619 adapter speed 10000
1620 @}
1621 @}
1622 @end example
1623
1624 @section Target Config Files
1625 @cindex config file, target
1626 @cindex target config file
1627
1628 Board config files communicate with target config files using
1629 naming conventions as described above, and may source one or
1630 more target config files like this:
1631
1632 @example
1633 source [find target/FOOBAR.cfg]
1634 @end example
1635
1636 The point of a target config file is to package everything
1637 about a given chip that board config files need to know.
1638 In summary the target files should contain
1639
1640 @enumerate
1641 @item Set defaults
1642 @item Add TAPs to the scan chain
1643 @item Add CPU targets (includes GDB support)
1644 @item CPU/Chip/CPU-Core specific features
1645 @item On-Chip flash
1646 @end enumerate
1647
1648 As a rule of thumb, a target file sets up only one chip.
1649 For a microcontroller, that will often include a single TAP,
1650 which is a CPU needing a GDB target, and its on-chip flash.
1651
1652 More complex chips may include multiple TAPs, and the target
1653 config file may need to define them all before OpenOCD
1654 can talk to the chip.
1655 For example, some phone chips have JTAG scan chains that include
1656 an ARM core for operating system use, a DSP,
1657 another ARM core embedded in an image processing engine,
1658 and other processing engines.
1659
1660 @subsection Default Value Boiler Plate Code
1661
1662 All target configuration files should start with code like this,
1663 letting board config files express environment-specific
1664 differences in how things should be set up.
1665
1666 @example
1667 # Boards may override chip names, perhaps based on role,
1668 # but the default should match what the vendor uses
1669 if @{ [info exists CHIPNAME] @} @{
1670 set _CHIPNAME $CHIPNAME
1671 @} else @{
1672 set _CHIPNAME sam7x256
1673 @}
1674
1675 # ONLY use ENDIAN with targets that can change it.
1676 if @{ [info exists ENDIAN] @} @{
1677 set _ENDIAN $ENDIAN
1678 @} else @{
1679 set _ENDIAN little
1680 @}
1681
1682 # TAP identifiers may change as chips mature, for example with
1683 # new revision fields (the "3" here). Pick a good default; you
1684 # can pass several such identifiers to the "jtag newtap" command.
1685 if @{ [info exists CPUTAPID ] @} @{
1686 set _CPUTAPID $CPUTAPID
1687 @} else @{
1688 set _CPUTAPID 0x3f0f0f0f
1689 @}
1690 @end example
1691 @c but 0x3f0f0f0f is for an str73x part ...
1692
1693 @emph{Remember:} Board config files may include multiple target
1694 config files, or the same target file multiple times
1695 (changing at least @code{CHIPNAME}).
1696
1697 Likewise, the target configuration file should define
1698 @code{_TARGETNAME} (or @code{_TARGETNAME0} etc) and
1699 use it later on when defining debug targets:
1700
1701 @example
1702 set _TARGETNAME $_CHIPNAME.cpu
1703 target create $_TARGETNAME arm7tdmi -chain-position $_TARGETNAME
1704 @end example
1705
1706 @subsection Adding TAPs to the Scan Chain
1707 After the ``defaults'' are set up,
1708 add the TAPs on each chip to the JTAG scan chain.
1709 @xref{TAP Declaration}, and the naming convention
1710 for taps.
1711
1712 In the simplest case the chip has only one TAP,
1713 probably for a CPU or FPGA.
1714 The config file for the Atmel AT91SAM7X256
1715 looks (in part) like this:
1716
1717 @example
1718 jtag newtap $_CHIPNAME cpu -irlen 4 -expected-id $_CPUTAPID
1719 @end example
1720
1721 A board with two such at91sam7 chips would be able
1722 to source such a config file twice, with different
1723 values for @code{CHIPNAME}, so
1724 it adds a different TAP each time.
1725
1726 If there are nonzero @option{-expected-id} values,
1727 OpenOCD attempts to verify the actual tap id against those values.
1728 It will issue error messages if there is mismatch, which
1729 can help to pinpoint problems in OpenOCD configurations.
1730
1731 @example
1732 JTAG tap: sam7x256.cpu tap/device found: 0x3f0f0f0f
1733 (Manufacturer: 0x787, Part: 0xf0f0, Version: 0x3)
1734 ERROR: Tap: sam7x256.cpu - Expected id: 0x12345678, Got: 0x3f0f0f0f
1735 ERROR: expected: mfg: 0x33c, part: 0x2345, ver: 0x1
1736 ERROR: got: mfg: 0x787, part: 0xf0f0, ver: 0x3
1737 @end example
1738
1739 There are more complex examples too, with chips that have
1740 multiple TAPs. Ones worth looking at include:
1741
1742 @itemize
1743 @item @file{target/omap3530.cfg} -- with disabled ARM and DSP,
1744 plus a JRC to enable them
1745 @item @file{target/str912.cfg} -- with flash, CPU, and boundary scan
1746 @item @file{target/ti_dm355.cfg} -- with ETM, ARM, and JRC (this JRC
1747 is not currently used)
1748 @end itemize
1749
1750 @subsection Add CPU targets
1751
1752 After adding a TAP for a CPU, you should set it up so that
1753 GDB and other commands can use it.
1754 @xref{CPU Configuration}.
1755 For the at91sam7 example above, the command can look like this;
1756 note that @code{$_ENDIAN} is not needed, since OpenOCD defaults
1757 to little endian, and this chip doesn't support changing that.
1758
1759 @example
1760 set _TARGETNAME $_CHIPNAME.cpu
1761 target create $_TARGETNAME arm7tdmi -chain-position $_TARGETNAME
1762 @end example
1763
1764 Work areas are small RAM areas associated with CPU targets.
1765 They are used by OpenOCD to speed up downloads,
1766 and to download small snippets of code to program flash chips.
1767 If the chip includes a form of ``on-chip-ram'' - and many do - define
1768 a work area if you can.
1769 Again using the at91sam7 as an example, this can look like:
1770
1771 @example
1772 $_TARGETNAME configure -work-area-phys 0x00200000 \
1773 -work-area-size 0x4000 -work-area-backup 0
1774 @end example
1775
1776 @anchor{definecputargetsworkinginsmp}
1777 @subsection Define CPU targets working in SMP
1778 @cindex SMP
1779 After setting targets, you can define a list of targets working in SMP.
1780
1781 @example
1782 set _TARGETNAME_1 $_CHIPNAME.cpu1
1783 set _TARGETNAME_2 $_CHIPNAME.cpu2
1784 target create $_TARGETNAME_1 cortex_a -chain-position $_CHIPNAME.dap \
1785 -coreid 0 -dbgbase $_DAP_DBG1
1786 target create $_TARGETNAME_2 cortex_a -chain-position $_CHIPNAME.dap \
1787 -coreid 1 -dbgbase $_DAP_DBG2
1788 #define 2 targets working in smp.
1789 target smp $_CHIPNAME.cpu2 $_CHIPNAME.cpu1
1790 @end example
1791 In the above example on cortex_a, 2 cpus are working in SMP.
1792 In SMP only one GDB instance is created and :
1793 @itemize @bullet
1794 @item a set of hardware breakpoint sets the same breakpoint on all targets in the list.
1795 @item halt command triggers the halt of all targets in the list.
1796 @item resume command triggers the write context and the restart of all targets in the list.
1797 @item following a breakpoint: the target stopped by the breakpoint is displayed to the GDB session.
1798 @item dedicated GDB serial protocol packets are implemented for switching/retrieving the target
1799 displayed by the GDB session @pxref{usingopenocdsmpwithgdb,,Using OpenOCD SMP with GDB}.
1800 @end itemize
1801
1802 The SMP behaviour can be disabled/enabled dynamically. On cortex_a following
1803 command have been implemented.
1804 @itemize @bullet
1805 @item cortex_a smp on : enable SMP mode, behaviour is as described above.
1806 @item cortex_a smp off : disable SMP mode, the current target is the one
1807 displayed in the GDB session, only this target is now controlled by GDB
1808 session. This behaviour is useful during system boot up.
1809 @item cortex_a smp : display current SMP mode.
1810 @item cortex_a smp_gdb : display/fix the core id displayed in GDB session see
1811 following example.
1812 @end itemize
1813
1814 @example
1815 >cortex_a smp_gdb
1816 gdb coreid 0 -> -1
1817 #0 : coreid 0 is displayed to GDB ,
1818 #-> -1 : next resume triggers a real resume
1819 > cortex_a smp_gdb 1
1820 gdb coreid 0 -> 1
1821 #0 :coreid 0 is displayed to GDB ,
1822 #->1 : next resume displays coreid 1 to GDB
1823 > resume
1824 > cortex_a smp_gdb
1825 gdb coreid 1 -> 1
1826 #1 :coreid 1 is displayed to GDB ,
1827 #->1 : next resume displays coreid 1 to GDB
1828 > cortex_a smp_gdb -1
1829 gdb coreid 1 -> -1
1830 #1 :coreid 1 is displayed to GDB,
1831 #->-1 : next resume triggers a real resume
1832 @end example
1833
1834
1835 @subsection Chip Reset Setup
1836
1837 As a rule, you should put the @command{reset_config} command
1838 into the board file. Most things you think you know about a
1839 chip can be tweaked by the board.
1840
1841 Some chips have specific ways the TRST and SRST signals are
1842 managed. In the unusual case that these are @emph{chip specific}
1843 and can never be changed by board wiring, they could go here.
1844 For example, some chips can't support JTAG debugging without
1845 both signals.
1846
1847 Provide a @code{reset-assert} event handler if you can.
1848 Such a handler uses JTAG operations to reset the target,
1849 letting this target config be used in systems which don't
1850 provide the optional SRST signal, or on systems where you
1851 don't want to reset all targets at once.
1852 Such a handler might write to chip registers to force a reset,
1853 use a JRC to do that (preferable -- the target may be wedged!),
1854 or force a watchdog timer to trigger.
1855 (For Cortex-M targets, this is not necessary. The target
1856 driver knows how to use trigger an NVIC reset when SRST is
1857 not available.)
1858
1859 Some chips need special attention during reset handling if
1860 they're going to be used with JTAG.
1861 An example might be needing to send some commands right
1862 after the target's TAP has been reset, providing a
1863 @code{reset-deassert-post} event handler that writes a chip
1864 register to report that JTAG debugging is being done.
1865 Another would be reconfiguring the watchdog so that it stops
1866 counting while the core is halted in the debugger.
1867
1868 JTAG clocking constraints often change during reset, and in
1869 some cases target config files (rather than board config files)
1870 are the right places to handle some of those issues.
1871 For example, immediately after reset most chips run using a
1872 slower clock than they will use later.
1873 That means that after reset (and potentially, as OpenOCD
1874 first starts up) they must use a slower JTAG clock rate
1875 than they will use later.
1876 @xref{jtagspeed,,JTAG Speed}.
1877
1878 @quotation Important
1879 When you are debugging code that runs right after chip
1880 reset, getting these issues right is critical.
1881 In particular, if you see intermittent failures when
1882 OpenOCD verifies the scan chain after reset,
1883 look at how you are setting up JTAG clocking.
1884 @end quotation
1885
1886 @anchor{theinittargetsprocedure}
1887 @subsection The init_targets procedure
1888 @cindex init_targets procedure
1889
1890 Target config files can either be ``linear'' (script executed line-by-line when parsed in
1891 configuration stage, @xref{configurationstage,,Configuration Stage},) or they can contain a special
1892 procedure called @code{init_targets}, which will be executed when entering run stage
1893 (after parsing all config files or after @code{init} command, @xref{enteringtherunstage,,Entering the Run Stage}.)
1894 Such procedure can be overridden by ``next level'' script (which sources the original).
1895 This concept facilitates code reuse when basic target config files provide generic configuration
1896 procedures and @code{init_targets} procedure, which can then be sourced and enhanced or changed in
1897 a ``more specific'' target config file. This is not possible with ``linear'' config scripts,
1898 because sourcing them executes every initialization commands they provide.
1899
1900 @example
1901 ### generic_file.cfg ###
1902
1903 proc setup_my_chip @{chip_name flash_size ram_size@} @{
1904 # basic initialization procedure ...
1905 @}
1906
1907 proc init_targets @{@} @{
1908 # initializes generic chip with 4kB of flash and 1kB of RAM
1909 setup_my_chip MY_GENERIC_CHIP 4096 1024
1910 @}
1911
1912 ### specific_file.cfg ###
1913
1914 source [find target/generic_file.cfg]
1915
1916 proc init_targets @{@} @{
1917 # initializes specific chip with 128kB of flash and 64kB of RAM
1918 setup_my_chip MY_CHIP_WITH_128K_FLASH_64KB_RAM 131072 65536
1919 @}
1920 @end example
1921
1922 The easiest way to convert ``linear'' config files to @code{init_targets} version is to
1923 enclose every line of ``code'' (i.e. not @code{source} commands, procedures, etc.) in this procedure.
1924
1925 For an example of this scheme see LPC2000 target config files.
1926
1927 The @code{init_boards} procedure is a similar concept concerning board config files
1928 (@xref{theinitboardprocedure,,The init_board procedure}.)
1929
1930 @anchor{theinittargeteventsprocedure}
1931 @subsection The init_target_events procedure
1932 @cindex init_target_events procedure
1933
1934 A special procedure called @code{init_target_events} is run just after
1935 @code{init_targets} (@xref{theinittargetsprocedure,,The init_targets
1936 procedure}.) and before @code{init_board}
1937 (@xref{theinitboardprocedure,,The init_board procedure}.) It is used
1938 to set up default target events for the targets that do not have those
1939 events already assigned.
1940
1941 @subsection ARM Core Specific Hacks
1942
1943 If the chip has a DCC, enable it. If the chip is an ARM9 with some
1944 special high speed download features - enable it.
1945
1946 If present, the MMU, the MPU and the CACHE should be disabled.
1947
1948 Some ARM cores are equipped with trace support, which permits
1949 examination of the instruction and data bus activity. Trace
1950 activity is controlled through an ``Embedded Trace Module'' (ETM)
1951 on one of the core's scan chains. The ETM emits voluminous data
1952 through a ``trace port''. (@xref{armhardwaretracing,,ARM Hardware Tracing}.)
1953 If you are using an external trace port,
1954 configure it in your board config file.
1955 If you are using an on-chip ``Embedded Trace Buffer'' (ETB),
1956 configure it in your target config file.
1957
1958 @example
1959 etm config $_TARGETNAME 16 normal full etb
1960 etb config $_TARGETNAME $_CHIPNAME.etb
1961 @end example
1962
1963 @subsection Internal Flash Configuration
1964
1965 This applies @b{ONLY TO MICROCONTROLLERS} that have flash built in.
1966
1967 @b{Never ever} in the ``target configuration file'' define any type of
1968 flash that is external to the chip. (For example a BOOT flash on
1969 Chip Select 0.) Such flash information goes in a board file - not
1970 the TARGET (chip) file.
1971
1972 Examples:
1973 @itemize @bullet
1974 @item at91sam7x256 - has 256K flash YES enable it.
1975 @item str912 - has flash internal YES enable it.
1976 @item imx27 - uses boot flash on CS0 - it goes in the board file.
1977 @item pxa270 - again - CS0 flash - it goes in the board file.
1978 @end itemize
1979
1980 @anchor{translatingconfigurationfiles}
1981 @section Translating Configuration Files
1982 @cindex translation
1983 If you have a configuration file for another hardware debugger
1984 or toolset (Abatron, BDI2000, BDI3000, CCS,
1985 Lauterbach, SEGGER, Macraigor, etc.), translating
1986 it into OpenOCD syntax is often quite straightforward. The most tricky
1987 part of creating a configuration script is oftentimes the reset init
1988 sequence where e.g. PLLs, DRAM and the like is set up.
1989
1990 One trick that you can use when translating is to write small
1991 Tcl procedures to translate the syntax into OpenOCD syntax. This
1992 can avoid manual translation errors and make it easier to
1993 convert other scripts later on.
1994
1995 Example of transforming quirky arguments to a simple search and
1996 replace job:
1997
1998 @example
1999 # Lauterbach syntax(?)
2000 #
2001 # Data.Set c15:0x042f %long 0x40000015
2002 #
2003 # OpenOCD syntax when using procedure below.
2004 #
2005 # setc15 0x01 0x00050078
2006
2007 proc setc15 @{regs value@} @{
2008 global TARGETNAME
2009
2010 echo [format "set p15 0x%04x, 0x%08x" $regs $value]
2011
2012 arm mcr 15 [expr @{($regs >> 12) & 0x7@}] \
2013 [expr @{($regs >> 0) & 0xf@}] [expr @{($regs >> 4) & 0xf@}] \
2014 [expr @{($regs >> 8) & 0x7@}] $value
2015 @}
2016 @end example
2017
2018
2019
2020 @node Server Configuration
2021 @chapter Server Configuration
2022 @cindex initialization
2023 The commands here are commonly found in the openocd.cfg file and are
2024 used to specify what TCP/IP ports are used, and how GDB should be
2025 supported.
2026
2027 @anchor{configurationstage}
2028 @section Configuration Stage
2029 @cindex configuration stage
2030 @cindex config command
2031
2032 When the OpenOCD server process starts up, it enters a
2033 @emph{configuration stage} which is the only time that
2034 certain commands, @emph{configuration commands}, may be issued.
2035 Normally, configuration commands are only available
2036 inside startup scripts.
2037
2038 In this manual, the definition of a configuration command is
2039 presented as a @emph{Config Command}, not as a @emph{Command}
2040 which may be issued interactively.
2041 The runtime @command{help} command also highlights configuration
2042 commands, and those which may be issued at any time.
2043
2044 Those configuration commands include declaration of TAPs,
2045 flash banks,
2046 the interface used for JTAG communication,
2047 and other basic setup.
2048 The server must leave the configuration stage before it
2049 may access or activate TAPs.
2050 After it leaves this stage, configuration commands may no
2051 longer be issued.
2052
2053 @deffn {Command} {command mode} [command_name]
2054 Returns the command modes allowed by a command: 'any', 'config', or
2055 'exec'. If no command is specified, returns the current command
2056 mode. Returns 'unknown' if an unknown command is given. Command can be
2057 multiple tokens. (command valid any time)
2058
2059 In this document, the modes are described as stages, 'config' and
2060 'exec' mode correspond configuration stage and run stage. 'any' means
2061 the command can be executed in either
2062 stages. @xref{configurationstage,,Configuration Stage}, and
2063 @xref{enteringtherunstage,,Entering the Run Stage}.
2064 @end deffn
2065
2066 @anchor{enteringtherunstage}
2067 @section Entering the Run Stage
2068
2069 The first thing OpenOCD does after leaving the configuration
2070 stage is to verify that it can talk to the scan chain
2071 (list of TAPs) which has been configured.
2072 It will warn if it doesn't find TAPs it expects to find,
2073 or finds TAPs that aren't supposed to be there.
2074 You should see no errors at this point.
2075 If you see errors, resolve them by correcting the
2076 commands you used to configure the server.
2077 Common errors include using an initial JTAG speed that's too
2078 fast, and not providing the right IDCODE values for the TAPs
2079 on the scan chain.
2080
2081 Once OpenOCD has entered the run stage, a number of commands
2082 become available.
2083 A number of these relate to the debug targets you may have declared.
2084 For example, the @command{mww} command will not be available until
2085 a target has been successfully instantiated.
2086 If you want to use those commands, you may need to force
2087 entry to the run stage.
2088
2089 @deffn {Config Command} {init}
2090 This command terminates the configuration stage and
2091 enters the run stage. This helps when you need to have
2092 the startup scripts manage tasks such as resetting the target,
2093 programming flash, etc. To reset the CPU upon startup, add "init" and
2094 "reset" at the end of the config script or at the end of the OpenOCD
2095 command line using the @option{-c} command line switch.
2096
2097 If this command does not appear in any startup/configuration file
2098 OpenOCD executes the command for you after processing all
2099 configuration files and/or command line options.
2100
2101 @b{NOTE:} This command normally occurs near the end of your
2102 openocd.cfg file to force OpenOCD to ``initialize'' and make the
2103 targets ready. For example: If your openocd.cfg file needs to
2104 read/write memory on your target, @command{init} must occur before
2105 the memory read/write commands. This includes @command{nand probe}.
2106
2107 @command{init} calls the following internal OpenOCD commands to initialize
2108 corresponding subsystems:
2109 @deffn {Config Command} {target init}
2110 @deffnx {Command} {transport init}
2111 @deffnx {Command} {dap init}
2112 @deffnx {Config Command} {flash init}
2113 @deffnx {Config Command} {nand init}
2114 @deffnx {Config Command} {pld init}
2115 @deffnx {Command} {tpiu init}
2116 @end deffn
2117 @end deffn
2118
2119 @deffn {Config Command} {noinit}
2120 Prevent OpenOCD from implicit @command{init} call at the end of startup.
2121 Allows issuing configuration commands over telnet or Tcl connection.
2122 When you are done with configuration use @command{init} to enter
2123 the run stage.
2124 @end deffn
2125
2126 @deffn {Overridable Procedure} {jtag_init}
2127 This is invoked at server startup to verify that it can talk
2128 to the scan chain (list of TAPs) which has been configured.
2129
2130 The default implementation first tries @command{jtag arp_init},
2131 which uses only a lightweight JTAG reset before examining the
2132 scan chain.
2133 If that fails, it tries again, using a harder reset
2134 from the overridable procedure @command{init_reset}.
2135
2136 Implementations must have verified the JTAG scan chain before
2137 they return.
2138 This is done by calling @command{jtag arp_init}
2139 (or @command{jtag arp_init-reset}).
2140 @end deffn
2141
2142 @anchor{tcpipports}
2143 @section TCP/IP Ports
2144 @cindex TCP port
2145 @cindex server
2146 @cindex port
2147 @cindex security
2148 The OpenOCD server accepts remote commands in several syntaxes.
2149 Each syntax uses a different TCP/IP port, which you may specify
2150 only during configuration (before those ports are opened).
2151
2152 For reasons including security, you may wish to prevent remote
2153 access using one or more of these ports.
2154 In such cases, just specify the relevant port number as "disabled".
2155 If you disable all access through TCP/IP, you will need to
2156 use the command line @option{-pipe} option.
2157
2158 @anchor{gdb_port}
2159 @deffn {Config Command} {gdb_port} [number]
2160 @cindex GDB server
2161 Normally gdb listens to a TCP/IP port, but GDB can also
2162 communicate via pipes(stdin/out or named pipes). The name
2163 "gdb_port" stuck because it covers probably more than 90% of
2164 the normal use cases.
2165
2166 No arguments reports GDB port. "pipe" means listen to stdin
2167 output to stdout, an integer is base port number, "disabled"
2168 disables the gdb server.
2169
2170 When using "pipe", also use log_output to redirect the log
2171 output to a file so as not to flood the stdin/out pipes.
2172
2173 Any other string is interpreted as named pipe to listen to.
2174 Output pipe is the same name as input pipe, but with 'o' appended,
2175 e.g. /var/gdb, /var/gdbo.
2176
2177 The GDB port for the first target will be the base port, the
2178 second target will listen on gdb_port + 1, and so on.
2179 When not specified during the configuration stage,
2180 the port @var{number} defaults to 3333.
2181 When @var{number} is not a numeric value, incrementing it to compute
2182 the next port number does not work. In this case, specify the proper
2183 @var{number} for each target by using the option @code{-gdb-port} of the
2184 commands @command{target create} or @command{$target_name configure}.
2185 @xref{gdbportoverride,,option -gdb-port}.
2186
2187 Note: when using "gdb_port pipe", increasing the default remote timeout in
2188 gdb (with 'set remotetimeout') is recommended. An insufficient timeout may
2189 cause initialization to fail with "Unknown remote qXfer reply: OK".
2190 @end deffn
2191
2192 @deffn {Config Command} {tcl_port} [number]
2193 Specify or query the port used for a simplified RPC
2194 connection that can be used by clients to issue TCL commands and get the
2195 output from the Tcl engine.
2196 Intended as a machine interface.
2197 When not specified during the configuration stage,
2198 the port @var{number} defaults to 6666.
2199 When specified as "disabled", this service is not activated.
2200 @end deffn
2201
2202 @deffn {Config Command} {telnet_port} [number]
2203 Specify or query the
2204 port on which to listen for incoming telnet connections.
2205 This port is intended for interaction with one human through TCL commands.
2206 When not specified during the configuration stage,
2207 the port @var{number} defaults to 4444.
2208 When specified as "disabled", this service is not activated.
2209 @end deffn
2210
2211 @anchor{gdbconfiguration}
2212 @section GDB Configuration
2213 @cindex GDB
2214 @cindex GDB configuration
2215 You can reconfigure some GDB behaviors if needed.
2216 The ones listed here are static and global.
2217 @xref{targetconfiguration,,Target Configuration}, about configuring individual targets.
2218 @xref{targetevents,,Target Events}, about configuring target-specific event handling.
2219
2220 @anchor{gdbbreakpointoverride}
2221 @deffn {Command} {gdb_breakpoint_override} [@option{hard}|@option{soft}|@option{disable}]
2222 Force breakpoint type for gdb @command{break} commands.
2223 This option supports GDB GUIs which don't
2224 distinguish hard versus soft breakpoints, if the default OpenOCD and
2225 GDB behaviour is not sufficient. GDB normally uses hardware
2226 breakpoints if the memory map has been set up for flash regions.
2227 @end deffn
2228
2229 @anchor{gdbflashprogram}
2230 @deffn {Config Command} {gdb_flash_program} (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
2231 Set to @option{enable} to cause OpenOCD to program the flash memory when a
2232 vFlash packet is received.
2233 The default behaviour is @option{enable}.
2234 @end deffn
2235
2236 @deffn {Config Command} {gdb_memory_map} (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
2237 Set to @option{enable} to cause OpenOCD to send the memory configuration to GDB when
2238 requested. GDB will then know when to set hardware breakpoints, and program flash
2239 using the GDB load command. @command{gdb_flash_program enable} must also be enabled
2240 for flash programming to work.
2241 Default behaviour is @option{enable}.
2242 @xref{gdbflashprogram,,gdb_flash_program}.
2243 @end deffn
2244
2245 @deffn {Config Command} {gdb_report_data_abort} (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
2246 Specifies whether data aborts cause an error to be reported
2247 by GDB memory read packets.
2248 The default behaviour is @option{disable};
2249 use @option{enable} see these errors reported.
2250 @end deffn
2251
2252 @deffn {Config Command} {gdb_report_register_access_error} (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
2253 Specifies whether register accesses requested by GDB register read/write
2254 packets report errors or not.
2255 The default behaviour is @option{disable};
2256 use @option{enable} see these errors reported.
2257 @end deffn
2258
2259 @deffn {Config Command} {gdb_target_description} (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
2260 Set to @option{enable} to cause OpenOCD to send the target descriptions to gdb via qXfer:features:read packet.
2261 The default behaviour is @option{enable}.
2262 @end deffn
2263
2264 @deffn {Command} {gdb_save_tdesc}
2265 Saves the target description file to the local file system.
2266
2267 The file name is @i{target_name}.xml.
2268 @end deffn
2269
2270 @anchor{eventpolling}
2271 @section Event Polling
2272
2273 Hardware debuggers are parts of asynchronous systems,
2274 where significant events can happen at any time.
2275 The OpenOCD server needs to detect some of these events,
2276 so it can report them to through TCL command line
2277 or to GDB.
2278
2279 Examples of such events include:
2280
2281 @itemize
2282 @item One of the targets can stop running ... maybe it triggers
2283 a code breakpoint or data watchpoint, or halts itself.
2284 @item Messages may be sent over ``debug message'' channels ... many
2285 targets support such messages sent over JTAG,
2286 for receipt by the person debugging or tools.
2287 @item Loss of power ... some adapters can detect these events.
2288 @item Resets not issued through JTAG ... such reset sources
2289 can include button presses or other system hardware, sometimes
2290 including the target itself (perhaps through a watchdog).
2291 @item Debug instrumentation sometimes supports event triggering
2292 such as ``trace buffer full'' (so it can quickly be emptied)
2293 or other signals (to correlate with code behavior).
2294 @end itemize
2295
2296 None of those events are signaled through standard JTAG signals.
2297 However, most conventions for JTAG connectors include voltage
2298 level and system reset (SRST) signal detection.
2299 Some connectors also include instrumentation signals, which
2300 can imply events when those signals are inputs.
2301
2302 In general, OpenOCD needs to periodically check for those events,
2303 either by looking at the status of signals on the JTAG connector
2304 or by sending synchronous ``tell me your status'' JTAG requests
2305 to the various active targets.
2306 There is a command to manage and monitor that polling,
2307 which is normally done in the background.
2308
2309 @deffn {Command} {poll} [@option{on}|@option{off}]
2310 Poll the current target for its current state.
2311 (Also, @pxref{targetcurstate,,target curstate}.)
2312 If that target is in debug mode, architecture
2313 specific information about the current state is printed.
2314 An optional parameter
2315 allows background polling to be enabled and disabled.
2316
2317 You could use this from the TCL command shell, or
2318 from GDB using @command{monitor poll} command.
2319 Leave background polling enabled while you're using GDB.
2320 @example
2321 > poll
2322 background polling: on
2323 target state: halted
2324 target halted in ARM state due to debug-request, \
2325 current mode: Supervisor
2326 cpsr: 0x800000d3 pc: 0x11081bfc
2327 MMU: disabled, D-Cache: disabled, I-Cache: enabled
2328 >
2329 @end example
2330 @end deffn
2331
2332 @node Debug Adapter Configuration
2333 @chapter Debug Adapter Configuration
2334 @cindex config file, interface
2335 @cindex interface config file
2336
2337 Correctly installing OpenOCD includes making your operating system give
2338 OpenOCD access to debug adapters. Once that has been done, Tcl commands
2339 are used to select which one is used, and to configure how it is used.
2340
2341 @quotation Note
2342 Because OpenOCD started out with a focus purely on JTAG, you may find
2343 places where it wrongly presumes JTAG is the only transport protocol
2344 in use. Be aware that recent versions of OpenOCD are removing that
2345 limitation. JTAG remains more functional than most other transports.
2346 Other transports do not support boundary scan operations, or may be
2347 specific to a given chip vendor. Some might be usable only for
2348 programming flash memory, instead of also for debugging.
2349 @end quotation
2350
2351 Debug Adapters/Interfaces/Dongles are normally configured
2352 through commands in an interface configuration
2353 file which is sourced by your @file{openocd.cfg} file, or
2354 through a command line @option{-f interface/....cfg} option.
2355
2356 @example
2357 source [find interface/olimex-jtag-tiny.cfg]
2358 @end example
2359
2360 These commands tell
2361 OpenOCD what type of JTAG adapter you have, and how to talk to it.
2362 A few cases are so simple that you only need to say what driver to use:
2363
2364 @example
2365 # jlink interface
2366 adapter driver jlink
2367 @end example
2368
2369 Most adapters need a bit more configuration than that.
2370
2371
2372 @section Adapter Configuration
2373
2374 The @command{adapter driver} command tells OpenOCD what type of debug adapter you are
2375 using. Depending on the type of adapter, you may need to use one or
2376 more additional commands to further identify or configure the adapter.
2377
2378 @deffn {Config Command} {adapter driver} name
2379 Use the adapter driver @var{name} to connect to the
2380 target.
2381 @end deffn
2382
2383 @deffn {Command} {adapter list}
2384 List the debug adapter drivers that have been built into
2385 the running copy of OpenOCD.
2386 @end deffn
2387 @deffn {Config Command} {adapter transports} transport_name+
2388 Specifies the transports supported by this debug adapter.
2389 The adapter driver builds-in similar knowledge; use this only
2390 when external configuration (such as jumpering) changes what
2391 the hardware can support.
2392 @end deffn
2393
2394
2395
2396 @deffn {Command} {adapter name}
2397 Returns the name of the debug adapter driver being used.
2398 @end deffn
2399
2400 @anchor{adapter_usb_location}
2401 @deffn {Config Command} {adapter usb location} [<bus>-<port>[.<port>]...]
2402 Displays or specifies the physical USB port of the adapter to use. The path
2403 roots at @var{bus} and walks down the physical ports, with each
2404 @var{port} option specifying a deeper level in the bus topology, the last
2405 @var{port} denoting where the target adapter is actually plugged.
2406 The USB bus topology can be queried with the command @emph{lsusb -t} or @emph{dmesg}.
2407
2408 This command is only available if your libusb1 is at least version 1.0.16.
2409 @end deffn
2410
2411 @deffn {Config Command} {adapter serial} serial_string
2412 Specifies the @var{serial_string} of the adapter to use.
2413 If this command is not specified, serial strings are not checked.
2414 Only the following adapter drivers use the serial string from this command:
2415 aice (aice_usb), arm-jtag-ew, cmsis_dap, ft232r, ftdi, hla (stlink, ti-icdi), jlink, kitprog, opendus,
2416 openjtag, osbdm, presto, rlink, st-link, usb_blaster (ublast2), usbprog, vsllink, xds110.
2417 @end deffn
2418
2419 @section Interface Drivers
2420
2421 Each of the interface drivers listed here must be explicitly
2422 enabled when OpenOCD is configured, in order to be made
2423 available at run time.
2424
2425 @deffn {Interface Driver} {amt_jtagaccel}
2426 Amontec Chameleon in its JTAG Accelerator configuration,
2427 connected to a PC's EPP mode parallel port.
2428 This defines some driver-specific commands:
2429
2430 @deffn {Config Command} {parport port} number
2431 Specifies either the address of the I/O port (default: 0x378 for LPT1) or
2432 the number of the @file{/dev/parport} device.
2433 @end deffn
2434
2435 @deffn {Config Command} {rtck} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
2436 Displays status of RTCK option.
2437 Optionally sets that option first.
2438 @end deffn
2439 @end deffn
2440
2441 @deffn {Interface Driver} {arm-jtag-ew}
2442 Olimex ARM-JTAG-EW USB adapter
2443 This has one driver-specific command:
2444
2445 @deffn {Command} {armjtagew_info}
2446 Logs some status
2447 @end deffn
2448 @end deffn
2449
2450 @deffn {Interface Driver} {at91rm9200}
2451 Supports bitbanged JTAG from the local system,
2452 presuming that system is an Atmel AT91rm9200
2453 and a specific set of GPIOs is used.
2454 @c command: at91rm9200_device NAME
2455 @c chooses among list of bit configs ... only one option
2456 @end deffn
2457
2458 @deffn {Interface Driver} {cmsis-dap}
2459 ARM CMSIS-DAP compliant based adapter v1 (USB HID based)
2460 or v2 (USB bulk).
2461
2462 @deffn {Config Command} {cmsis_dap_vid_pid} [vid pid]+
2463 The vendor ID and product ID of the CMSIS-DAP device. If not specified
2464 the driver will attempt to auto detect the CMSIS-DAP device.
2465 Currently, up to eight [@var{vid}, @var{pid}] pairs may be given, e.g.
2466 @example
2467 cmsis_dap_vid_pid 0xc251 0xf001 0x0d28 0x0204
2468 @end example
2469 @end deffn
2470
2471 @deffn {Config Command} {cmsis_dap_backend} [@option{auto}|@option{usb_bulk}|@option{hid}]
2472 Specifies how to communicate with the adapter:
2473
2474 @itemize @minus
2475 @item @option{hid} Use HID generic reports - CMSIS-DAP v1
2476 @item @option{usb_bulk} Use USB bulk - CMSIS-DAP v2
2477 @item @option{auto} First try USB bulk CMSIS-DAP v2, if not found try HID CMSIS-DAP v1.
2478 This is the default if @command{cmsis_dap_backend} is not specified.
2479 @end itemize
2480 @end deffn
2481
2482 @deffn {Config Command} {cmsis_dap_usb interface} [number]
2483 Specifies the @var{number} of the USB interface to use in v2 mode (USB bulk).
2484 In most cases need not to be specified and interfaces are searched by
2485 interface string or for user class interface.
2486 @end deffn
2487
2488 @deffn {Command} {cmsis-dap info}
2489 Display various device information, like hardware version, firmware version, current bus status.
2490 @end deffn
2491
2492 @deffn {Command} {cmsis-dap cmd} number number ...
2493 Execute an arbitrary CMSIS-DAP command. Use for adapter testing or for handling
2494 of an adapter vendor specific command from a Tcl script.
2495
2496 Take given numbers as bytes, assemble a CMSIS-DAP protocol command packet
2497 from them and send it to the adapter. The first 4 bytes of the adapter response
2498 are logged.
2499 See @url{https://arm-software.github.io/CMSIS_5/DAP/html/group__DAP__Commands__gr.html}
2500 @end deffn
2501 @end deffn
2502
2503 @deffn {Interface Driver} {dummy}
2504 A dummy software-only driver for debugging.
2505 @end deffn
2506
2507 @deffn {Interface Driver} {ep93xx}
2508 Cirrus Logic EP93xx based single-board computer bit-banging (in development)
2509 @end deffn
2510
2511 @deffn {Interface Driver} {ftdi}
2512 This driver is for adapters using the MPSSE (Multi-Protocol Synchronous Serial
2513 Engine) mode built into many FTDI chips, such as the FT2232, FT4232 and FT232H.
2514
2515 The driver is using libusb-1.0 in asynchronous mode to talk to the FTDI device,
2516 bypassing intermediate libraries like libftdi.
2517
2518 Support for new FTDI based adapters can be added completely through
2519 configuration files, without the need to patch and rebuild OpenOCD.
2520
2521 The driver uses a signal abstraction to enable Tcl configuration files to
2522 define outputs for one or several FTDI GPIO. These outputs can then be
2523 controlled using the @command{ftdi set_signal} command. Special signal names
2524 are reserved for nTRST, nSRST and LED (for blink) so that they, if defined,
2525 will be used for their customary purpose. Inputs can be read using the
2526 @command{ftdi get_signal} command.
2527
2528 To support SWD, a signal named SWD_EN must be defined. It is set to 1 when the
2529 SWD protocol is selected. When set, the adapter should route the SWDIO pin to
2530 the data input. An SWDIO_OE signal, if defined, will be set to 1 or 0 as
2531 required by the protocol, to tell the adapter to drive the data output onto
2532 the SWDIO pin or keep the SWDIO pin Hi-Z, respectively.
2533
2534 Depending on the type of buffer attached to the FTDI GPIO, the outputs have to
2535 be controlled differently. In order to support tristateable signals such as
2536 nSRST, both a data GPIO and an output-enable GPIO can be specified for each
2537 signal. The following output buffer configurations are supported:
2538
2539 @itemize @minus
2540 @item Push-pull with one FTDI output as (non-)inverted data line
2541 @item Open drain with one FTDI output as (non-)inverted output-enable
2542 @item Tristate with one FTDI output as (non-)inverted data line and another
2543 FTDI output as (non-)inverted output-enable
2544 @item Unbuffered, using the FTDI GPIO as a tristate output directly by
2545 switching data and direction as necessary
2546 @end itemize
2547
2548 These interfaces have several commands, used to configure the driver
2549 before initializing the JTAG scan chain:
2550
2551 @deffn {Config Command} {ftdi vid_pid} [vid pid]+
2552 The vendor ID and product ID of the adapter. Up to eight
2553 [@var{vid}, @var{pid}] pairs may be given, e.g.
2554 @example
2555 ftdi vid_pid 0x0403 0xcff8 0x15ba 0x0003
2556 @end example
2557 @end deffn
2558
2559 @deffn {Config Command} {ftdi device_desc} description
2560 Provides the USB device description (the @emph{iProduct string})
2561 of the adapter. If not specified, the device description is ignored
2562 during device selection.
2563 @end deffn
2564
2565 @deffn {Config Command} {ftdi channel} channel
2566 Selects the channel of the FTDI device to use for MPSSE operations. Most
2567 adapters use the default, channel 0, but there are exceptions.
2568 @end deffn
2569
2570 @deffn {Config Command} {ftdi layout_init} data direction
2571 Specifies the initial values of the FTDI GPIO data and direction registers.
2572 Each value is a 16-bit number corresponding to the concatenation of the high
2573 and low FTDI GPIO registers. The values should be selected based on the
2574 schematics of the adapter, such that all signals are set to safe levels with
2575 minimal impact on the target system. Avoid floating inputs, conflicting outputs
2576 and initially asserted reset signals.
2577 @end deffn
2578
2579 @deffn {Command} {ftdi layout_signal} name [@option{-data}|@option{-ndata} data_mask] [@option{-input}|@option{-ninput} input_mask] [@option{-oe}|@option{-noe} oe_mask] [@option{-alias}|@option{-nalias} name]
2580 Creates a signal with the specified @var{name}, controlled by one or more FTDI
2581 GPIO pins via a range of possible buffer connections. The masks are FTDI GPIO
2582 register bitmasks to tell the driver the connection and type of the output
2583 buffer driving the respective signal. @var{data_mask} is the bitmask for the
2584 pin(s) connected to the data input of the output buffer. @option{-ndata} is
2585 used with inverting data inputs and @option{-data} with non-inverting inputs.
2586 The @option{-oe} (or @option{-noe}) option tells where the output-enable (or
2587 not-output-enable) input to the output buffer is connected. The options
2588 @option{-input} and @option{-ninput} specify the bitmask for pins to be read
2589 with the method @command{ftdi get_signal}.
2590
2591 Both @var{data_mask} and @var{oe_mask} need not be specified. For example, a
2592 simple open-collector transistor driver would be specified with @option{-oe}
2593 only. In that case the signal can only be set to drive low or to Hi-Z and the
2594 driver will complain if the signal is set to drive high. Which means that if
2595 it's a reset signal, @command{reset_config} must be specified as
2596 @option{srst_open_drain}, not @option{srst_push_pull}.
2597
2598 A special case is provided when @option{-data} and @option{-oe} is set to the
2599 same bitmask. Then the FTDI pin is considered being connected straight to the
2600 target without any buffer. The FTDI pin is then switched between output and
2601 input as necessary to provide the full set of low, high and Hi-Z
2602 characteristics. In all other cases, the pins specified in a signal definition
2603 are always driven by the FTDI.
2604
2605 If @option{-alias} or @option{-nalias} is used, the signal is created
2606 identical (or with data inverted) to an already specified signal
2607 @var{name}.
2608 @end deffn
2609
2610 @deffn {Command} {ftdi set_signal} name @option{0}|@option{1}|@option{z}
2611 Set a previously defined signal to the specified level.
2612 @itemize @minus
2613 @item @option{0}, drive low
2614 @item @option{1}, drive high
2615 @item @option{z}, set to high-impedance
2616 @end itemize
2617 @end deffn
2618
2619 @deffn {Command} {ftdi get_signal} name
2620 Get the value of a previously defined signal.
2621 @end deffn
2622
2623 @deffn {Command} {ftdi tdo_sample_edge} @option{rising}|@option{falling}
2624 Configure TCK edge at which the adapter samples the value of the TDO signal
2625
2626 Due to signal propagation delays, sampling TDO on rising TCK can become quite
2627 peculiar at high JTAG clock speeds. However, FTDI chips offer a possibility to sample
2628 TDO on falling edge of TCK. With some board/adapter configurations, this may increase
2629 stability at higher JTAG clocks.
2630 @itemize @minus
2631 @item @option{rising}, sample TDO on rising edge of TCK - this is the default
2632 @item @option{falling}, sample TDO on falling edge of TCK
2633 @end itemize
2634 @end deffn
2635
2636 For example adapter definitions, see the configuration files shipped in the
2637 @file{interface/ftdi} directory.
2638
2639 @end deffn
2640
2641 @deffn {Interface Driver} {ft232r}
2642 This driver is implementing synchronous bitbang mode of an FTDI FT232R,
2643 FT230X, FT231X and similar USB UART bridge ICs by reusing RS232 signals as GPIO.
2644 It currently doesn't support using CBUS pins as GPIO.
2645
2646 List of connections (default physical pin numbers for FT232R in 28-pin SSOP package):
2647 @itemize @minus
2648 @item RXD(5) - TDI
2649 @item TXD(1) - TCK
2650 @item RTS(3) - TDO
2651 @item CTS(11) - TMS
2652 @item DTR(2) - TRST
2653 @item DCD(10) - SRST
2654 @end itemize
2655
2656 User can change default pinout by supplying configuration
2657 commands with GPIO numbers or RS232 signal names.
2658 GPIO numbers correspond to bit numbers in FTDI GPIO register.
2659 They differ from physical pin numbers.
2660 For details see actual FTDI chip datasheets.
2661 Every JTAG line must be configured to unique GPIO number
2662 different than any other JTAG line, even those lines
2663 that are sometimes not used like TRST or SRST.
2664
2665 FT232R
2666 @itemize @minus
2667 @item bit 7 - RI
2668 @item bit 6 - DCD
2669 @item bit 5 - DSR
2670 @item bit 4 - DTR
2671 @item bit 3 - CTS
2672 @item bit 2 - RTS
2673 @item bit 1 - RXD
2674 @item bit 0 - TXD
2675 @end itemize
2676
2677 These interfaces have several commands, used to configure the driver
2678 before initializing the JTAG scan chain:
2679
2680 @deffn {Config Command} {ft232r vid_pid} @var{vid} @var{pid}
2681 The vendor ID and product ID of the adapter. If not specified, default
2682 0x0403:0x6001 is used.
2683 @end deffn
2684
2685 @deffn {Config Command} {ft232r jtag_nums} @var{tck} @var{tms} @var{tdi} @var{tdo}
2686 Set four JTAG GPIO numbers at once.
2687 If not specified, default 0 3 1 2 or TXD CTS RXD RTS is used.
2688 @end deffn
2689
2690 @deffn {Config Command} {ft232r tck_num} @var{tck}
2691 Set TCK GPIO number. If not specified, default 0 or TXD is used.
2692 @end deffn
2693
2694 @deffn {Config Command} {ft232r tms_num} @var{tms}
2695 Set TMS GPIO number. If not specified, default 3 or CTS is used.
2696 @end deffn
2697
2698 @deffn {Config Command} {ft232r tdi_num} @var{tdi}
2699 Set TDI GPIO number. If not specified, default 1 or RXD is used.
2700 @end deffn
2701
2702 @deffn {Config Command} {ft232r tdo_num} @var{tdo}
2703 Set TDO GPIO number. If not specified, default 2 or RTS is used.
2704 @end deffn
2705
2706 @deffn {Config Command} {ft232r trst_num} @var{trst}
2707 Set TRST GPIO number. If not specified, default 4 or DTR is used.
2708 @end deffn
2709
2710 @deffn {Config Command} {ft232r srst_num} @var{srst}
2711 Set SRST GPIO number. If not specified, default 6 or DCD is used.
2712 @end deffn
2713
2714 @deffn {Config Command} {ft232r restore_serial} @var{word}
2715 Restore serial port after JTAG. This USB bitmode control word
2716 (16-bit) will be sent before quit. Lower byte should
2717 set GPIO direction register to a "sane" state:
2718 0x15 for TXD RTS DTR as outputs (1), others as inputs (0). Higher
2719 byte is usually 0 to disable bitbang mode.
2720 When kernel driver reattaches, serial port should continue to work.
2721 Value 0xFFFF disables sending control word and serial port,
2722 then kernel driver will not reattach.
2723 If not specified, default 0xFFFF is used.
2724 @end deffn
2725
2726 @end deffn
2727
2728 @deffn {Interface Driver} {remote_bitbang}
2729 Drive JTAG from a remote process. This sets up a UNIX or TCP socket connection
2730 with a remote process and sends ASCII encoded bitbang requests to that process
2731 instead of directly driving JTAG.
2732
2733 The remote_bitbang driver is useful for debugging software running on
2734 processors which are being simulated.
2735
2736 @deffn {Config Command} {remote_bitbang port} number
2737 Specifies the TCP port of the remote process to connect to or 0 to use UNIX
2738 sockets instead of TCP.
2739 @end deffn
2740
2741 @deffn {Config Command} {remote_bitbang host} hostname
2742 Specifies the hostname of the remote process to connect to using TCP, or the
2743 name of the UNIX socket to use if remote_bitbang port is 0.
2744 @end deffn
2745
2746 For example, to connect remotely via TCP to the host foobar you might have
2747 something like:
2748
2749 @example
2750 adapter driver remote_bitbang
2751 remote_bitbang port 3335
2752 remote_bitbang host foobar
2753 @end example
2754
2755 To connect to another process running locally via UNIX sockets with socket
2756 named mysocket:
2757
2758 @example
2759 adapter driver remote_bitbang
2760 remote_bitbang port 0
2761 remote_bitbang host mysocket
2762 @end example
2763 @end deffn
2764
2765 @deffn {Interface Driver} {usb_blaster}
2766 USB JTAG/USB-Blaster compatibles over one of the userspace libraries
2767 for FTDI chips. These interfaces have several commands, used to
2768 configure the driver before initializing the JTAG scan chain:
2769
2770 @deffn {Config Command} {usb_blaster vid_pid} vid pid
2771 The vendor ID and product ID of the FTDI FT245 device. If not specified,
2772 default values are used.
2773 Currently, only one @var{vid}, @var{pid} pair may be given, e.g. for
2774 Altera USB-Blaster (default):
2775 @example
2776 usb_blaster vid_pid 0x09FB 0x6001
2777 @end example
2778 The following VID/PID is for Kolja Waschk's USB JTAG:
2779 @example
2780 usb_blaster vid_pid 0x16C0 0x06AD
2781 @end example
2782 @end deffn
2783
2784 @deffn {Command} {usb_blaster pin} (@option{pin6}|@option{pin8}) (@option{0}|@option{1}|@option{s}|@option{t})
2785 Sets the state or function of the unused GPIO pins on USB-Blasters
2786 (pins 6 and 8 on the female JTAG header). These pins can be used as
2787 SRST and/or TRST provided the appropriate connections are made on the
2788 target board.
2789
2790 For example, to use pin 6 as SRST:
2791 @example
2792 usb_blaster pin pin6 s
2793 reset_config srst_only
2794 @end example
2795 @end deffn
2796
2797 @deffn {Config Command} {usb_blaster lowlevel_driver} (@option{ftdi}|@option{ublast2})
2798 Chooses the low level access method for the adapter. If not specified,
2799 @option{ftdi} is selected unless it wasn't enabled during the
2800 configure stage. USB-Blaster II needs @option{ublast2}.
2801 @end deffn
2802
2803 @deffn {Config Command} {usb_blaster firmware} @var{path}
2804 This command specifies @var{path} to access USB-Blaster II firmware
2805 image. To be used with USB-Blaster II only.
2806 @end deffn
2807
2808 @end deffn
2809
2810 @deffn {Interface Driver} {gw16012}
2811 Gateworks GW16012 JTAG programmer.
2812 This has one driver-specific command:
2813
2814 @deffn {Config Command} {parport port} [port_number]
2815 Display either the address of the I/O port
2816 (default: 0x378 for LPT1) or the number of the @file{/dev/parport} device.
2817 If a parameter is provided, first switch to use that port.
2818 This is a write-once setting.
2819 @end deffn
2820 @end deffn
2821
2822 @deffn {Interface Driver} {jlink}
2823 SEGGER J-Link family of USB adapters. It currently supports JTAG and SWD
2824 transports.
2825
2826 @quotation Compatibility Note
2827 SEGGER released many firmware versions for the many hardware versions they
2828 produced. OpenOCD was extensively tested and intended to run on all of them,
2829 but some combinations were reported as incompatible. As a general
2830 recommendation, it is advisable to use the latest firmware version
2831 available for each hardware version. However the current V8 is a moving
2832 target, and SEGGER firmware versions released after the OpenOCD was
2833 released may not be compatible. In such cases it is recommended to
2834 revert to the last known functional version. For 0.5.0, this is from
2835 "Feb 8 2012 14:30:39", packed with 4.42c. For 0.6.0, the last known
2836 version is from "May 3 2012 18:36:22", packed with 4.46f.
2837 @end quotation
2838
2839 @deffn {Command} {jlink hwstatus}
2840 Display various hardware related information, for example target voltage and pin
2841 states.
2842 @end deffn
2843 @deffn {Command} {jlink freemem}
2844 Display free device internal memory.
2845 @end deffn
2846 @deffn {Command} {jlink jtag} [@option{2}|@option{3}]
2847 Set the JTAG command version to be used. Without argument, show the actual JTAG
2848 command version.
2849 @end deffn
2850 @deffn {Command} {jlink config}
2851 Display the device configuration.
2852 @end deffn
2853 @deffn {Command} {jlink config targetpower} [@option{on}|@option{off}]
2854 Set the target power state on JTAG-pin 19. Without argument, show the target
2855 power state.
2856 @end deffn
2857 @deffn {Command} {jlink config mac} [@option{ff:ff:ff:ff:ff:ff}]
2858 Set the MAC address of the device. Without argument, show the MAC address.
2859 @end deffn
2860 @deffn {Command} {jlink config ip} [@option{A.B.C.D}(@option{/E}|@option{F.G.H.I})]
2861 Set the IP configuration of the device, where A.B.C.D is the IP address, E the
2862 bit of the subnet mask and F.G.H.I the subnet mask. Without arguments, show the
2863 IP configuration.
2864 @end deffn
2865 @deffn {Command} {jlink config usb} [@option{0} to @option{3}]
2866 Set the USB address of the device. This will also change the USB Product ID
2867 (PID) of the device. Without argument, show the USB address.
2868 @end deffn
2869 @deffn {Command} {jlink config reset}
2870 Reset the current configuration.
2871 @end deffn
2872 @deffn {Command} {jlink config write}
2873 Write the current configuration to the internal persistent storage.
2874 @end deffn
2875 @deffn {Command} {jlink emucom write} <channel> <data>
2876 Write data to an EMUCOM channel. The data needs to be encoded as hexadecimal
2877 pairs.
2878
2879 The following example shows how to write the three bytes 0xaa, 0x0b and 0x23 to
2880 the EMUCOM channel 0x10:
2881 @example
2882 > jlink emucom write 0x10 aa0b23
2883 @end example
2884 @end deffn
2885 @deffn {Command} {jlink emucom read} <channel> <length>
2886 Read data from an EMUCOM channel. The read data is encoded as hexadecimal
2887 pairs.
2888
2889 The following example shows how to read 4 bytes from the EMUCOM channel 0x0:
2890 @example
2891 > jlink emucom read 0x0 4
2892 77a90000
2893 @end example
2894 @end deffn
2895 @deffn {Config Command} {jlink usb} <@option{0} to @option{3}>
2896 Set the USB address of the interface, in case more than one adapter is connected
2897 to the host. If not specified, USB addresses are not considered. Device
2898 selection via USB address is not always unambiguous. It is recommended to use
2899 the serial number instead, if possible.
2900
2901 As a configuration command, it can be used only before 'init'.
2902 @end deffn
2903 @end deffn
2904
2905 @deffn {Interface Driver} {kitprog}
2906 This driver is for Cypress Semiconductor's KitProg adapters. The KitProg is an
2907 SWD-only adapter that is designed to be used with Cypress's PSoC and PRoC device
2908 families, but it is possible to use it with some other devices. If you are using
2909 this adapter with a PSoC or a PRoC, you may need to add
2910 @command{kitprog_init_acquire_psoc} or @command{kitprog acquire_psoc} to your
2911 configuration script.
2912
2913 Note that this driver is for the proprietary KitProg protocol, not the CMSIS-DAP
2914 mode introduced in firmware 2.14. If the KitProg is in CMSIS-DAP mode, it cannot
2915 be used with this driver, and must either be used with the cmsis-dap driver or
2916 switched back to KitProg mode. See the Cypress KitProg User Guide for
2917 instructions on how to switch KitProg modes.
2918
2919 Known limitations:
2920 @itemize @bullet
2921 @item The frequency of SWCLK cannot be configured, and varies between 1.6 MHz
2922 and 2.7 MHz.
2923 @item For firmware versions below 2.14, "JTAG to SWD" sequences are replaced by
2924 "SWD line reset" in the driver. This is for two reasons. First, the KitProg does
2925 not support sending arbitrary SWD sequences, and only firmware 2.14 and later
2926 implement both "JTAG to SWD" and "SWD line reset" in firmware. Earlier firmware
2927 versions only implement "SWD line reset". Second, due to a firmware quirk, an
2928 SWD sequence must be sent after every target reset in order to re-establish
2929 communications with the target.
2930 @item Due in part to the limitation above, KitProg devices with firmware below
2931 version 2.14 will need to use @command{kitprog_init_acquire_psoc} in order to
2932 communicate with PSoC 5LP devices. This is because, assuming debug is not
2933 disabled on the PSoC, the PSoC 5LP needs its JTAG interface switched to SWD
2934 mode before communication can begin, but prior to firmware 2.14, "JTAG to SWD"
2935 could only be sent with an acquisition sequence.
2936 @end itemize
2937
2938 @deffn {Config Command} {kitprog_init_acquire_psoc}
2939 Indicate that a PSoC acquisition sequence needs to be run during adapter init.
2940 Please be aware that the acquisition sequence hard-resets the target.
2941 @end deffn
2942
2943 @deffn {Command} {kitprog acquire_psoc}
2944 Run a PSoC acquisition sequence immediately. Typically, this should not be used
2945 outside of the target-specific configuration scripts since it hard-resets the
2946 target as a side-effect.
2947 This is necessary for "reset halt" on some PSoC 4 series devices.
2948 @end deffn
2949
2950 @deffn {Command} {kitprog info}
2951 Display various adapter information, such as the hardware version, firmware
2952 version, and target voltage.
2953 @end deffn
2954 @end deffn
2955
2956 @deffn {Interface Driver} {parport}
2957 Supports PC parallel port bit-banging cables:
2958 Wigglers, PLD download cable, and more.
2959 These interfaces have several commands, used to configure the driver
2960 before initializing the JTAG scan chain:
2961
2962 @deffn {Config Command} {parport cable} name
2963 Set the layout of the parallel port cable used to connect to the target.
2964 This is a write-once setting.
2965 Currently valid cable @var{name} values include:
2966
2967 @itemize @minus
2968 @item @b{altium} Altium Universal JTAG cable.
2969 @item @b{arm-jtag} Same as original wiggler except SRST and
2970 TRST connections reversed and TRST is also inverted.
2971 @item @b{chameleon} The Amontec Chameleon's CPLD when operated
2972 in configuration mode. This is only used to
2973 program the Chameleon itself, not a connected target.
2974 @item @b{dlc5} The Xilinx Parallel cable III.
2975 @item @b{flashlink} The ST Parallel cable.
2976 @item @b{lattice} Lattice ispDOWNLOAD Cable
2977 @item @b{old_amt_wiggler} The Wiggler configuration that comes with
2978 some versions of
2979 Amontec's Chameleon Programmer. The new version available from
2980 the website uses the original Wiggler layout ('@var{wiggler}')
2981 @item @b{triton} The parallel port adapter found on the
2982 ``Karo Triton 1 Development Board''.
2983 This is also the layout used by the HollyGates design
2984 (see @uref{http://www.lartmaker.nl/projects/jtag/}).
2985 @item @b{wiggler} The original Wiggler layout, also supported by
2986 several clones, such as the Olimex ARM-JTAG
2987 @item @b{wiggler2} Same as original wiggler except an led is fitted on D5.
2988 @item @b{wiggler_ntrst_inverted} Same as original wiggler except TRST is inverted.
2989 @end itemize
2990 @end deffn
2991
2992 @deffn {Config Command} {parport port} [port_number]
2993 Display either the address of the I/O port
2994 (default: 0x378 for LPT1) or the number of the @file{/dev/parport} device.
2995 If a parameter is provided, first switch to use that port.
2996 This is a write-once setting.
2997
2998 When using PPDEV to access the parallel port, use the number of the parallel port:
2999 @option{parport port 0} (the default). If @option{parport port 0x378} is specified
3000 you may encounter a problem.
3001 @end deffn
3002
3003 @deffn {Config Command} {parport toggling_time} [nanoseconds]
3004 Displays how many nanoseconds the hardware needs to toggle TCK;
3005 the parport driver uses this value to obey the
3006 @command{adapter speed} configuration.
3007 When the optional @var{nanoseconds} parameter is given,
3008 that setting is changed before displaying the current value.
3009
3010 The default setting should work reasonably well on commodity PC hardware.
3011 However, you may want to calibrate for your specific hardware.
3012 @quotation Tip
3013 To measure the toggling time with a logic analyzer or a digital storage
3014 oscilloscope, follow the procedure below:
3015 @example
3016 > parport toggling_time 1000
3017 > adapter speed 500
3018 @end example
3019 This sets the maximum JTAG clock speed of the hardware, but
3020 the actual speed probably deviates from the requested 500 kHz.
3021 Now, measure the time between the two closest spaced TCK transitions.
3022 You can use @command{runtest 1000} or something similar to generate a
3023 large set of samples.
3024 Update the setting to match your measurement:
3025 @example
3026 > parport toggling_time <measured nanoseconds>
3027 @end example
3028 Now the clock speed will be a better match for @command{adapter speed}
3029 command given in OpenOCD scripts and event handlers.
3030
3031 You can do something similar with many digital multimeters, but note
3032 that you'll probably need to run the clock continuously for several
3033 seconds before it decides what clock rate to show. Adjust the
3034 toggling time up or down until the measured clock rate is a good
3035 match with the rate you specified in the @command{adapter speed} command;
3036 be conservative.
3037 @end quotation
3038 @end deffn
3039
3040 @deffn {Config Command} {parport write_on_exit} (@option{on}|@option{off})
3041 This will configure the parallel driver to write a known
3042 cable-specific value to the parallel interface on exiting OpenOCD.
3043 @end deffn
3044
3045 For example, the interface configuration file for a
3046 classic ``Wiggler'' cable on LPT2 might look something like this:
3047
3048 @example
3049 adapter driver parport
3050 parport port 0x278
3051 parport cable wiggler
3052 @end example
3053 @end deffn
3054
3055 @deffn {Interface Driver} {presto}
3056 ASIX PRESTO USB JTAG programmer.
3057 @end deffn
3058
3059 @deffn {Interface Driver} {rlink}
3060 Raisonance RLink USB adapter
3061 @end deffn
3062
3063 @deffn {Interface Driver} {usbprog}
3064 usbprog is a freely programmable USB adapter.
3065 @end deffn
3066
3067 @deffn {Interface Driver} {vsllink}
3068 vsllink is part of Versaloon which is a versatile USB programmer.
3069
3070 @quotation Note
3071 This defines quite a few driver-specific commands,
3072 which are not currently documented here.
3073 @end quotation
3074 @end deffn
3075
3076 @anchor{hla_interface}
3077 @deffn {Interface Driver} {hla}
3078 This is a driver that supports multiple High Level Adapters.
3079 This type of adapter does not expose some of the lower level api's
3080 that OpenOCD would normally use to access the target.
3081
3082 Currently supported adapters include the STMicroelectronics ST-LINK, TI ICDI
3083 and Nuvoton Nu-Link.
3084 ST-LINK firmware version >= V2.J21.S4 recommended due to issues with earlier
3085 versions of firmware where serial number is reset after first use. Suggest
3086 using ST firmware update utility to upgrade ST-LINK firmware even if current
3087 version reported is V2.J21.S4.
3088
3089 @deffn {Config Command} {hla_device_desc} description
3090 Currently Not Supported.
3091 @end deffn
3092
3093 @deffn {Config Command} {hla_layout} (@option{stlink}|@option{icdi}|@option{nulink})
3094 Specifies the adapter layout to use.
3095 @end deffn
3096
3097 @deffn {Config Command} {hla_vid_pid} [vid pid]+
3098 Pairs of vendor IDs and product IDs of the device.
3099 @end deffn
3100
3101 @deffn {Config Command} {hla_stlink_backend} (usb | tcp [port])
3102 @emph{ST-Link only:} Choose between 'exclusive' USB communication (the default backend) or
3103 'shared' mode using ST-Link TCP server (the default port is 7184).
3104
3105 @emph{Note:} ST-Link TCP server is a binary application provided by ST
3106 available from @url{https://www.st.com/en/development-tools/st-link-server.html,
3107 ST-LINK server software module}.
3108 @end deffn
3109
3110 @deffn {Command} {hla_command} command
3111 Execute a custom adapter-specific command. The @var{command} string is
3112 passed as is to the underlying adapter layout handler.
3113 @end deffn
3114 @end deffn
3115
3116 @anchor{st_link_dap_interface}
3117 @deffn {Interface Driver} {st-link}
3118 This is a driver that supports STMicroelectronics adapters ST-LINK/V2
3119 (from firmware V2J24) and STLINK-V3, thanks to a new API that provides
3120 directly access the arm ADIv5 DAP.
3121
3122 The new API provide access to multiple AP on the same DAP, but the
3123 maximum number of the AP port is limited by the specific firmware version
3124 (e.g. firmware V2J29 has 3 as maximum AP number, while V2J32 has 8).
3125 An error is returned for any AP number above the maximum allowed value.
3126
3127 @emph{Note:} Either these same adapters and their older versions are
3128 also supported by @ref{hla_interface, the hla interface driver}.
3129
3130 @deffn {Config Command} {st-link backend} (usb | tcp [port])
3131 Choose between 'exclusive' USB communication (the default backend) or
3132 'shared' mode using ST-Link TCP server (the default port is 7184).
3133
3134 @emph{Note:} ST-Link TCP server is a binary application provided by ST
3135 available from @url{https://www.st.com/en/development-tools/st-link-server.html,
3136 ST-LINK server software module}.
3137
3138 @emph{Note:} ST-Link TCP server does not support the SWIM transport.
3139 @end deffn
3140
3141 @deffn {Config Command} {st-link vid_pid} [vid pid]+
3142 Pairs of vendor IDs and product IDs of the device.
3143 @end deffn
3144
3145 @deffn {Command} {st-link cmd} rx_n (tx_byte)+
3146 Sends an arbitrary command composed by the sequence of bytes @var{tx_byte}
3147 and receives @var{rx_n} bytes.
3148
3149 For example, the command to read the target's supply voltage is one byte 0xf7 followed
3150 by 15 bytes zero. It returns 8 bytes, where the first 4 bytes represent the ADC sampling
3151 of the reference voltage 1.2V and the last 4 bytes represent the ADC sampling of half
3152 the target's supply voltage.
3153 @example
3154 > st-link cmd 8 0xf7 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0
3155 0xf1 0x05 0x00 0x00 0x0b 0x08 0x00 0x00
3156 @end example
3157 The result can be converted to Volts (ignoring the most significant bytes, always zero)
3158 @example
3159 > set a [st-link cmd 8 0xf7 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0]
3160 > set n [expr @{[lindex $a 4] + 256 * [lindex $a 5]@}]
3161 > set d [expr @{[lindex $a 0] + 256 * [lindex $a 1]@}]
3162 > echo [expr @{2 * 1.2 * $n / $d@}]
3163 3.24891518738
3164 @end example
3165 @end deffn
3166 @end deffn
3167
3168 @deffn {Interface Driver} {opendous}
3169 opendous-jtag is a freely programmable USB adapter.
3170 @end deffn
3171
3172 @deffn {Interface Driver} {ulink}
3173 This is the Keil ULINK v1 JTAG debugger.
3174 @end deffn
3175
3176 @deffn {Interface Driver} {xds110}
3177 The XDS110 is included as the embedded debug probe on many Texas Instruments
3178 LaunchPad evaluation boards. The XDS110 is also available as a stand-alone USB
3179 debug probe with the added capability to supply power to the target board. The
3180 following commands are supported by the XDS110 driver:
3181
3182 @deffn {Config Command} {xds110 supply} voltage_in_millivolts
3183 Available only on the XDS110 stand-alone probe. Sets the voltage level of the
3184 XDS110 power supply. A value of 0 leaves the supply off. Otherwise, the supply
3185 can be set to any value in the range 1800 to 3600 millivolts.
3186 @end deffn
3187
3188 @deffn {Command} {xds110 info}
3189 Displays information about the connected XDS110 debug probe (e.g. firmware
3190 version).
3191 @end deffn
3192 @end deffn
3193
3194 @deffn {Interface Driver} {xlnx_pcie_xvc}
3195 This driver supports the Xilinx Virtual Cable (XVC) over PCI Express.
3196 It is commonly found in Xilinx based PCI Express designs. It allows debugging
3197 fabric based JTAG/SWD devices such as Cortex-M1/M3 microcontrollers. Access to this is
3198 exposed via extended capability registers in the PCI Express configuration space.
3199
3200 For more information see Xilinx PG245 (Section on From_PCIE_to_JTAG mode).
3201
3202 @deffn {Config Command} {xlnx_pcie_xvc config} device
3203 Specifies the PCI Express device via parameter @var{device} to use.
3204
3205 The correct value for @var{device} can be obtained by looking at the output
3206 of lscpi -D (first column) for the corresponding device.
3207
3208 The string will be of the format "DDDD:BB:SS.F" such as "0000:65:00.1".
3209
3210 @end deffn
3211 @end deffn
3212
3213 @deffn {Interface Driver} {bcm2835gpio}
3214 This SoC is present in Raspberry Pi which is a cheap single-board computer
3215 exposing some GPIOs on its expansion header.
3216
3217 The driver accesses memory-mapped GPIO peripheral registers directly
3218 for maximum performance, but the only possible race condition is for
3219 the pins' modes/muxing (which is highly unlikely), so it should be
3220 able to coexist nicely with both sysfs bitbanging and various
3221 peripherals' kernel drivers. The driver restores the previous
3222 configuration on exit.
3223
3224 GPIO numbers >= 32 can't be used for performance reasons.
3225
3226 See @file{interface/raspberrypi-native.cfg} for a sample config and
3227 pinout.
3228
3229 @deffn {Config Command} {bcm2835gpio jtag_nums} @var{tck} @var{tms} @var{tdi} @var{tdo}
3230 Set JTAG transport GPIO numbers for TCK, TMS, TDI, and TDO (in that order).
3231 Must be specified to enable JTAG transport. These pins can also be specified
3232 individually.
3233 @end deffn
3234
3235 @deffn {Config Command} {bcm2835gpio tck_num} @var{tck}
3236 Set TCK GPIO number. Must be specified to enable JTAG transport. Can also be
3237 specified using the configuration command @command{bcm2835gpio jtag_nums}.
3238 @end deffn
3239
3240 @deffn {Config Command} {bcm2835gpio tms_num} @var{tms}
3241 Set TMS GPIO number. Must be specified to enable JTAG transport. Can also be
3242 specified using the configuration command @command{bcm2835gpio jtag_nums}.
3243 @end deffn
3244
3245 @deffn {Config Command} {bcm2835gpio tdo_num} @var{tdo}
3246 Set TDO GPIO number. Must be specified to enable JTAG transport. Can also be
3247 specified using the configuration command @command{bcm2835gpio jtag_nums}.
3248 @end deffn
3249
3250 @deffn {Config Command} {bcm2835gpio tdi_num} @var{tdi}
3251 Set TDI GPIO number. Must be specified to enable JTAG transport. Can also be
3252 specified using the configuration command @command{bcm2835gpio jtag_nums}.
3253 @end deffn
3254
3255 @deffn {Config Command} {bcm2835gpio swd_nums} @var{swclk} @var{swdio}
3256 Set SWD transport GPIO numbers for SWCLK and SWDIO (in that order). Must be
3257 specified to enable SWD transport. These pins can also be specified individually.
3258 @end deffn
3259
3260 @deffn {Config Command} {bcm2835gpio swclk_num} @var{swclk}
3261 Set SWCLK GPIO number. Must be specified to enable SWD transport. Can also be
3262 specified using the configuration command @command{bcm2835gpio swd_nums}.
3263 @end deffn
3264
3265 @deffn {Config Command} {bcm2835gpio swdio_num} @var{swdio}
3266 Set SWDIO GPIO number. Must be specified to enable SWD transport. Can also be
3267 specified using the configuration command @command{bcm2835gpio swd_nums}.
3268 @end deffn
3269
3270 @deffn {Config Command} {bcm2835gpio swdio_dir_num} @var{swdio} @var{dir}
3271 Set SWDIO direction control pin GPIO number. If specified, this pin can be used
3272 to control the direction of an external buffer on the SWDIO pin (set=output
3273 mode, clear=input mode). If not specified, this feature is disabled.
3274 @end deffn
3275
3276 @deffn {Config Command} {bcm2835gpio srst_num} @var{srst}
3277 Set SRST GPIO number. Must be specified to enable SRST.
3278 @end deffn
3279
3280 @deffn {Config Command} {bcm2835gpio trst_num} @var{trst}
3281 Set TRST GPIO number. Must be specified to enable TRST.
3282 @end deffn
3283
3284 @deffn {Config Command} {bcm2835gpio speed_coeffs} @var{speed_coeff} @var{speed_offset}
3285 Set SPEED_COEFF and SPEED_OFFSET for delay calculations. If unspecified,
3286 speed_coeff defaults to 113714, and speed_offset defaults to 28.
3287 @end deffn
3288
3289 @deffn {Config Command} {bcm2835gpio peripheral_base} @var{base}
3290 Set the peripheral base register address to access GPIOs. For the RPi1, use
3291 0x20000000. For RPi2 and RPi3, use 0x3F000000. For RPi4, use 0xFE000000. A full
3292 list can be found in the
3293 @uref{https://www.raspberrypi.org/documentation/hardware/raspberrypi/peripheral_addresses.md, official guide}.
3294 @end deffn
3295
3296 @end deffn
3297
3298 @deffn {Interface Driver} {imx_gpio}
3299 i.MX SoC is present in many community boards. Wandboard is an example
3300 of the one which is most popular.
3301
3302 This driver is mostly the same as bcm2835gpio.
3303
3304 See @file{interface/imx-native.cfg} for a sample config and
3305 pinout.
3306
3307 @end deffn
3308
3309
3310 @deffn {Interface Driver} {linuxgpiod}
3311 Linux provides userspace access to GPIO through libgpiod since Linux kernel version v4.6.
3312 The driver emulates either JTAG and SWD transport through bitbanging.
3313
3314 See @file{interface/dln-2-gpiod.cfg} for a sample config.
3315 @end deffn
3316
3317
3318 @deffn {Interface Driver} {sysfsgpio}
3319 Linux legacy userspace access to GPIO through sysfs is deprecated from Linux kernel version v5.3.
3320 Prefer using @b{linuxgpiod}, instead.
3321
3322 See @file{interface/sysfsgpio-raspberrypi.cfg} for a sample config.
3323 @end deffn
3324
3325
3326 @deffn {Interface Driver} {openjtag}
3327 OpenJTAG compatible USB adapter.
3328 This defines some driver-specific commands:
3329
3330 @deffn {Config Command} {openjtag variant} variant
3331 Specifies the variant of the OpenJTAG adapter (see @uref{http://www.openjtag.org/}).
3332 Currently valid @var{variant} values include:
3333
3334 @itemize @minus
3335 @item @b{standard} Standard variant (default).
3336 @item @b{cy7c65215} Cypress CY7C65215 Dual Channel USB-Serial Bridge Controller
3337 (see @uref{http://www.cypress.com/?rID=82870}).
3338 @end itemize
3339 @end deffn
3340
3341 @deffn {Config Command} {openjtag device_desc} string
3342 The USB device description string of the adapter.
3343 This value is only used with the standard variant.
3344 @end deffn
3345 @end deffn
3346
3347
3348 @deffn {Interface Driver} {jtag_dpi}
3349 SystemVerilog Direct Programming Interface (DPI) compatible driver for
3350 JTAG devices in emulation. The driver acts as a client for the SystemVerilog
3351 DPI server interface.
3352
3353 @deffn {Config Command} {jtag_dpi set_port} port
3354 Specifies the TCP/IP port number of the SystemVerilog DPI server interface.
3355 @end deffn
3356
3357 @deffn {Config Command} {jtag_dpi set_address} address
3358 Specifies the TCP/IP address of the SystemVerilog DPI server interface.
3359 @end deffn
3360 @end deffn
3361
3362
3363 @deffn {Interface Driver} {buspirate}
3364
3365 This driver is for the Bus Pirate (see @url{http://dangerousprototypes.com/docs/Bus_Pirate}) and compatible devices.
3366 It uses a simple data protocol over a serial port connection.
3367
3368 Most hardware development boards have a UART, a real serial port, or a virtual USB serial device, so this driver
3369 allows you to start building your own JTAG adapter without the complexity of a custom USB connection.
3370
3371 @deffn {Config Command} {buspirate port} serial_port
3372 Specify the serial port's filename. For example:
3373 @example
3374 buspirate port /dev/ttyUSB0
3375 @end example
3376 @end deffn
3377
3378 @deffn {Config Command} {buspirate speed} (normal|fast)
3379 Set the communication speed to 115k (normal) or 1M (fast). For example:
3380 @example
3381 buspirate speed normal
3382 @end example
3383 @end deffn
3384
3385 @deffn {Config Command} {buspirate mode} (normal|open-drain)
3386 Set the Bus Pirate output mode.
3387 @itemize @minus
3388 @item In normal mode (push/pull), do not enable the pull-ups, and do not connect I/O header pin VPU to JTAG VREF.
3389 @item In open drain mode, you will then need to enable the pull-ups.
3390 @end itemize
3391 For example:
3392 @example
3393 buspirate mode normal
3394 @end example
3395 @end deffn
3396
3397 @deffn {Config Command} {buspirate pullup} (0|1)
3398 Whether to connect (1) or not (0) the I/O header pin VPU (JTAG VREF)
3399 to the pull-up/pull-down resistors on MOSI (JTAG TDI), CLK (JTAG TCK), MISO (JTAG TDO) and CS (JTAG TMS).
3400 For example:
3401 @example
3402 buspirate pullup 0
3403 @end example
3404 @end deffn
3405
3406 @deffn {Config Command} {buspirate vreg} (0|1)
3407 Whether to enable (1) or disable (0) the built-in voltage regulator,
3408 which can be used to supply power to a test circuit through
3409 I/O header pins +3V3 and +5V. For example:
3410 @example
3411 buspirate vreg 0
3412 @end example
3413 @end deffn
3414
3415 @deffn {Command} {buspirate led} (0|1)
3416 Turns the Bus Pirate's LED on (1) or off (0). For example:
3417 @end deffn
3418 @example
3419 buspirate led 1
3420 @end example
3421
3422 @end deffn
3423
3424
3425 @section Transport Configuration
3426 @cindex Transport
3427 As noted earlier, depending on the version of OpenOCD you use,
3428 and the debug adapter you are using,
3429 several transports may be available to
3430 communicate with debug targets (or perhaps to program flash memory).
3431 @deffn {Command} {transport list}
3432 displays the names of the transports supported by this
3433 version of OpenOCD.
3434 @end deffn
3435
3436 @deffn {Command} {transport select} @option{transport_name}
3437 Select which of the supported transports to use in this OpenOCD session.
3438
3439 When invoked with @option{transport_name}, attempts to select the named
3440 transport. The transport must be supported by the debug adapter
3441 hardware and by the version of OpenOCD you are using (including the
3442 adapter's driver).
3443
3444 If no transport has been selected and no @option{transport_name} is
3445 provided, @command{transport select} auto-selects the first transport
3446 supported by the debug adapter.
3447
3448 @command{transport select} always returns the name of the session's selected
3449 transport, if any.
3450 @end deffn
3451
3452 @subsection JTAG Transport
3453 @cindex JTAG
3454 JTAG is the original transport supported by OpenOCD, and most
3455 of the OpenOCD commands support it.
3456 JTAG transports expose a chain of one or more Test Access Points (TAPs),
3457 each of which must be explicitly declared.
3458 JTAG supports both debugging and boundary scan testing.
3459 Flash programming support is built on top of debug support.
3460
3461 JTAG transport is selected with the command @command{transport select
3462 jtag}. Unless your adapter uses either @ref{hla_interface,the hla interface
3463 driver} (in which case the command is @command{transport select hla_jtag})
3464 or @ref{st_link_dap_interface,the st-link interface driver} (in which case
3465 the command is @command{transport select dapdirect_jtag}).
3466
3467 @subsection SWD Transport
3468 @cindex SWD
3469 @cindex Serial Wire Debug
3470 SWD (Serial Wire Debug) is an ARM-specific transport which exposes one
3471 Debug Access Point (DAP, which must be explicitly declared.
3472 (SWD uses fewer signal wires than JTAG.)
3473 SWD is debug-oriented, and does not support boundary scan testing.
3474 Flash programming support is built on top of debug support.
3475 (Some processors support both JTAG and SWD.)
3476
3477 SWD transport is selected with the command @command{transport select
3478 swd}. Unless your adapter uses either @ref{hla_interface,the hla interface
3479 driver} (in which case the command is @command{transport select hla_swd})
3480 or @ref{st_link_dap_interface,the st-link interface driver} (in which case
3481 the command is @command{transport select dapdirect_swd}).
3482
3483 @deffn {Config Command} {swd newdap} ...
3484 Declares a single DAP which uses SWD transport.
3485 Parameters are currently the same as "jtag newtap" but this is
3486 expected to change.
3487 @end deffn
3488
3489 @cindex SWD multi-drop
3490 The newer SWD devices (SW-DP v2 or SWJ-DP v2) support the multi-drop extension
3491 of SWD protocol: two or more devices can be connected to one SWD adapter.
3492 SWD transport works in multi-drop mode if @ref{dap_create,DAP} is configured
3493 with both @code{-dp-id} and @code{-instance-id} parameters regardless how many
3494 DAPs are created.
3495
3496 Not all adapters and adapter drivers support SWD multi-drop. Only the following
3497 adapter drivers are SWD multi-drop capable:
3498 cmsis_dap (use an adapter with CMSIS-DAP version 2.0), ftdi, all bitbang based.
3499
3500 @subsection SPI Transport
3501 @cindex SPI
3502 @cindex Serial Peripheral Interface
3503 The Serial Peripheral Interface (SPI) is a general purpose transport
3504 which uses four wire signaling. Some processors use it as part of a
3505 solution for flash programming.
3506
3507 @anchor{swimtransport}
3508 @subsection SWIM Transport
3509 @cindex SWIM
3510 @cindex Single Wire Interface Module
3511 The Single Wire Interface Module (SWIM) is a low-pin-count debug protocol used
3512 by the STMicroelectronics MCU family STM8 and documented in the
3513 @uref{https://www.st.com/resource/en/user_manual/cd00173911.pdf, User Manual UM470}.
3514
3515 SWIM does not support boundary scan testing nor multiple cores.
3516
3517 The SWIM transport is selected with the command @command{transport select swim}.
3518
3519 The concept of TAPs does not fit in the protocol since SWIM does not implement
3520 a scan chain. Nevertheless, the current SW model of OpenOCD requires defining a
3521 virtual SWIM TAP through the command @command{swim newtap basename tap_type}.
3522 The TAP definition must precede the target definition command
3523 @command{target create target_name stm8 -chain-position basename.tap_type}.
3524
3525 @anchor{jtagspeed}
3526 @section JTAG Speed
3527 JTAG clock setup is part of system setup.
3528 It @emph{does not belong with interface setup} since any interface
3529 only knows a few of the constraints for the JTAG clock speed.
3530 Sometimes the JTAG speed is
3531 changed during the target initialization process: (1) slow at
3532 reset, (2) program the CPU clocks, (3) run fast.
3533 Both the "slow" and "fast" clock rates are functions of the
3534 oscillators used, the chip, the board design, and sometimes
3535 power management software that may be active.
3536
3537 The speed used during reset, and the scan chain verification which
3538 follows reset, can be adjusted using a @code{reset-start}
3539 target event handler.
3540 It can then be reconfigured to a faster speed by a
3541 @code{reset-init} target event handler after it reprograms those
3542 CPU clocks, or manually (if something else, such as a boot loader,
3543 sets up those clocks).
3544 @xref{targetevents,,Target Events}.
3545 When the initial low JTAG speed is a chip characteristic, perhaps
3546 because of a required oscillator speed, provide such a handler
3547 in the target config file.
3548 When that speed is a function of a board-specific characteristic
3549 such as which speed oscillator is used, it belongs in the board
3550 config file instead.
3551 In both cases it's safest to also set the initial JTAG clock rate
3552 to that same slow speed, so that OpenOCD never starts up using a
3553 clock speed that's faster than the scan chain can support.
3554
3555 @example
3556 jtag_rclk 3000
3557 $_TARGET.cpu configure -event reset-start @{ jtag_rclk 3000 @}
3558 @end example
3559
3560 If your system supports adaptive clocking (RTCK), configuring
3561 JTAG to use that is probably the most robust approach.
3562 However, it introduces delays to synchronize clocks; so it
3563 may not be the fastest solution.
3564
3565 @b{NOTE:} Script writers should consider using @command{jtag_rclk}
3566 instead of @command{adapter speed}, but only for (ARM) cores and boards
3567 which support adaptive clocking.
3568
3569 @deffn {Command} {adapter speed} max_speed_kHz
3570 A non-zero speed is in KHZ. Hence: 3000 is 3mhz.
3571 JTAG interfaces usually support a limited number of
3572 speeds. The speed actually used won't be faster
3573 than the speed specified.
3574
3575 Chip data sheets generally include a top JTAG clock rate.
3576 The actual rate is often a function of a CPU core clock,
3577 and is normally less than that peak rate.
3578 For example, most ARM cores accept at most one sixth of the CPU clock.
3579
3580 Speed 0 (khz) selects RTCK method.
3581 @xref{faqrtck,,FAQ RTCK}.
3582 If your system uses RTCK, you won't need to change the
3583 JTAG clocking after setup.
3584 Not all interfaces, boards, or targets support ``rtck''.
3585 If the interface device can not
3586 support it, an error is returned when you try to use RTCK.
3587 @end deffn
3588
3589 @defun jtag_rclk fallback_speed_kHz
3590 @cindex adaptive clocking
3591 @cindex RTCK
3592 This Tcl proc (defined in @file{startup.tcl}) attempts to enable RTCK/RCLK.
3593 If that fails (maybe the interface, board, or target doesn't
3594 support it), falls back to the specified frequency.
3595 @example
3596 # Fall back to 3mhz if RTCK is not supported
3597 jtag_rclk 3000
3598 @end example
3599 @end defun
3600
3601 @node Reset Configuration
3602 @chapter Reset Configuration
3603 @cindex Reset Configuration
3604
3605 Every system configuration may require a different reset
3606 configuration. This can also be quite confusing.
3607 Resets also interact with @var{reset-init} event handlers,
3608 which do things like setting up clocks and DRAM, and
3609 JTAG clock rates. (@xref{jtagspeed,,JTAG Speed}.)
3610 They can also interact with JTAG routers.
3611 Please see the various board files for examples.
3612
3613 @quotation Note
3614 To maintainers and integrators:
3615 Reset configuration touches several things at once.
3616 Normally the board configuration file
3617 should define it and assume that the JTAG adapter supports
3618 everything that's wired up to the board's JTAG connector.
3619
3620 However, the target configuration file could also make note
3621 of something the silicon vendor has done inside the chip,
3622 which will be true for most (or all) boards using that chip.
3623 And when the JTAG adapter doesn't support everything, the
3624 user configuration file will need to override parts of
3625 the reset configuration provided by other files.
3626 @end quotation
3627
3628 @section Types of Reset
3629
3630 There are many kinds of reset possible through JTAG, but
3631 they may not all work with a given board and adapter.
3632 That's part of why reset configuration can be error prone.
3633
3634 @itemize @bullet
3635 @item
3636 @emph{System Reset} ... the @emph{SRST} hardware signal
3637 resets all chips connected to the JTAG adapter, such as processors,
3638 power management chips, and I/O controllers. Normally resets triggered
3639 with this signal behave exactly like pressing a RESET button.
3640 @item
3641 @emph{JTAG TAP Reset} ... the @emph{TRST} hardware signal resets
3642 just the TAP controllers connected to the JTAG adapter.
3643 Such resets should not be visible to the rest of the system; resetting a
3644 device's TAP controller just puts that controller into a known state.
3645 @item
3646 @emph{Emulation Reset} ... many devices can be reset through JTAG
3647 commands. These resets are often distinguishable from system
3648 resets, either explicitly (a "reset reason" register says so)
3649 or implicitly (not all parts of the chip get reset).
3650 @item
3651 @emph{Other Resets} ... system-on-chip devices often support
3652 several other types of reset.
3653 You may need to arrange that a watchdog timer stops
3654 while debugging, preventing a watchdog reset.
3655 There may be individual module resets.
3656 @end itemize
3657
3658 In the best case, OpenOCD can hold SRST, then reset
3659 the TAPs via TRST and send commands through JTAG to halt the
3660 CPU at the reset vector before the 1st instruction is executed.
3661 Then when it finally releases the SRST signal, the system is
3662 halted under debugger control before any code has executed.
3663 This is the behavior required to support the @command{reset halt}
3664 and @command{reset init} commands; after @command{reset init} a
3665 board-specific script might do things like setting up DRAM.
3666 (@xref{resetcommand,,Reset Command}.)
3667
3668 @anchor{srstandtrstissues}
3669 @section SRST and TRST Issues
3670
3671 Because SRST and TRST are hardware signals, they can have a
3672 variety of system-specific constraints. Some of the most
3673 common issues are:
3674
3675 @itemize @bullet
3676
3677 @item @emph{Signal not available} ... Some boards don't wire
3678 SRST or TRST to the JTAG connector. Some JTAG adapters don't
3679 support such signals even if they are wired up.
3680 Use the @command{reset_config} @var{signals} options to say
3681 when either of those signals is not connected.
3682 When SRST is not available, your code might not be able to rely
3683 on controllers having been fully reset during code startup.
3684 Missing TRST is not a problem, since JTAG-level resets can
3685 be triggered using with TMS signaling.
3686
3687 @item @emph{Signals shorted} ... Sometimes a chip, board, or
3688 adapter will connect SRST to TRST, instead of keeping them separate.
3689 Use the @command{reset_config} @var{combination} options to say
3690 when those signals aren't properly independent.
3691
3692 @item @emph{Timing} ... Reset circuitry like a resistor/capacitor
3693 delay circuit, reset supervisor, or on-chip features can extend
3694 the effect of a JTAG adapter's reset for some time after the adapter
3695 stops issuing the reset. For example, there may be chip or board
3696 requirements that all reset pulses last for at least a
3697 certain amount of time; and reset buttons commonly have
3698 hardware debouncing.
3699 Use the @command{adapter srst delay} and @command{jtag_ntrst_delay}
3700 commands to say when extra delays are needed.
3701
3702 @item @emph{Drive type} ... Reset lines often have a pullup
3703 resistor, letting the JTAG interface treat them as open-drain
3704 signals. But that's not a requirement, so the adapter may need
3705 to use push/pull output drivers.
3706 Also, with weak pullups it may be advisable to drive
3707 signals to both levels (push/pull) to minimize rise times.
3708 Use the @command{reset_config} @var{trst_type} and
3709 @var{srst_type} parameters to say how to drive reset signals.
3710
3711 @item @emph{Special initialization} ... Targets sometimes need
3712 special JTAG initialization sequences to handle chip-specific
3713 issues (not limited to errata).
3714 For example, certain JTAG commands might need to be issued while
3715 the system as a whole is in a reset state (SRST active)
3716 but the JTAG scan chain is usable (TRST inactive).
3717 Many systems treat combined assertion of SRST and TRST as a
3718 trigger for a harder reset than SRST alone.
3719 Such custom reset handling is discussed later in this chapter.
3720 @end itemize
3721
3722 There can also be other issues.
3723 Some devices don't fully conform to the JTAG specifications.
3724 Trivial system-specific differences are common, such as
3725 SRST and TRST using slightly different names.
3726 There are also vendors who distribute key JTAG documentation for
3727 their chips only to developers who have signed a Non-Disclosure
3728 Agreement (NDA).
3729
3730 Sometimes there are chip-specific extensions like a requirement to use
3731 the normally-optional TRST signal (precluding use of JTAG adapters which
3732 don't pass TRST through), or needing extra steps to complete a TAP reset.
3733
3734 In short, SRST and especially TRST handling may be very finicky,
3735 needing to cope with both architecture and board specific constraints.
3736
3737 @section Commands for Handling Resets
3738
3739 @deffn {Command} {adapter srst pulse_width} milliseconds
3740 Minimum amount of time (in milliseconds) OpenOCD should wait
3741 after asserting nSRST (active-low system reset) before
3742 allowing it to be deasserted.
3743 @end deffn
3744
3745 @deffn {Command} {adapter srst delay} milliseconds
3746 How long (in milliseconds) OpenOCD should wait after deasserting
3747 nSRST (active-low system reset) before starting new JTAG operations.
3748 When a board has a reset button connected to SRST line it will
3749 probably have hardware debouncing, implying you should use this.
3750 @end deffn
3751
3752 @deffn {Command} {jtag_ntrst_assert_width} milliseconds
3753 Minimum amount of time (in milliseconds) OpenOCD should wait
3754 after asserting nTRST (active-low JTAG TAP reset) before
3755 allowing it to be deasserted.
3756 @end deffn
3757
3758 @deffn {Command} {jtag_ntrst_delay} milliseconds
3759 How long (in milliseconds) OpenOCD should wait after deasserting
3760 nTRST (active-low JTAG TAP reset) before starting new JTAG operations.
3761 @end deffn
3762
3763 @anchor{reset_config}
3764 @deffn {Command} {reset_config} mode_flag ...
3765 This command displays or modifies the reset configuration
3766 of your combination of JTAG board and target in target
3767 configuration scripts.
3768
3769 Information earlier in this section describes the kind of problems
3770 the command is intended to address (@pxref{srstandtrstissues,,SRST and TRST Issues}).
3771 As a rule this command belongs only in board config files,
3772 describing issues like @emph{board doesn't connect TRST};
3773 or in user config files, addressing limitations derived
3774 from a particular combination of interface and board.
3775 (An unlikely example would be using a TRST-only adapter
3776 with a board that only wires up SRST.)
3777
3778 The @var{mode_flag} options can be specified in any order, but only one
3779 of each type -- @var{signals}, @var{combination}, @var{gates},
3780 @var{trst_type}, @var{srst_type} and @var{connect_type}
3781 -- may be specified at a time.
3782 If you don't provide a new value for a given type, its previous
3783 value (perhaps the default) is unchanged.
3784 For example, this means that you don't need to say anything at all about
3785 TRST just to declare that if the JTAG adapter should want to drive SRST,
3786 it must explicitly be driven high (@option{srst_push_pull}).
3787
3788 @itemize
3789 @item
3790 @var{signals} can specify which of the reset signals are connected.
3791 For example, If the JTAG interface provides SRST, but the board doesn't
3792 connect that signal properly, then OpenOCD can't use it.
3793 Possible values are @option{none} (the default), @option{trst_only},
3794 @option{srst_only} and @option{trst_and_srst}.
3795
3796 @quotation Tip
3797 If your board provides SRST and/or TRST through the JTAG connector,
3798 you must declare that so those signals can be used.
3799 @end quotation
3800
3801 @item
3802 The @var{combination} is an optional value specifying broken reset
3803 signal implementations.
3804 The default behaviour if no option given is @option{separate},
3805 indicating everything behaves normally.
3806 @option{srst_pulls_trst} states that the
3807 test logic is reset together with the reset of the system (e.g. NXP
3808 LPC2000, "broken" board layout), @option{trst_pulls_srst} says that
3809 the system is reset together with the test logic (only hypothetical, I
3810 haven't seen hardware with such a bug, and can be worked around).
3811 @option{combined} implies both @option{srst_pulls_trst} and
3812 @option{trst_pulls_srst}.
3813
3814 @item
3815 The @var{gates} tokens control flags that describe some cases where
3816 JTAG may be unavailable during reset.
3817 @option{srst_gates_jtag} (default)
3818 indicates that asserting SRST gates the
3819 JTAG clock. This means that no communication can happen on JTAG
3820 while SRST is asserted.
3821 Its converse is @option{srst_nogate}, indicating that JTAG commands
3822 can safely be issued while SRST is active.
3823
3824 @item
3825 The @var{connect_type} tokens control flags that describe some cases where
3826 SRST is asserted while connecting to the target. @option{srst_nogate}
3827 is required to use this option.
3828 @option{connect_deassert_srst} (default)
3829 indicates that SRST will not be asserted while connecting to the target.
3830 Its converse is @option{connect_assert_srst}, indicating that SRST will
3831 be asserted before any target connection.
3832 Only some targets support this feature, STM32 and STR9 are examples.
3833 This feature is useful if you are unable to connect to your target due
3834 to incorrect options byte config or illegal program execution.
3835 @end itemize
3836
3837 The optional @var{trst_type} and @var{srst_type} parameters allow the
3838 driver mode of each reset line to be specified. These values only affect
3839 JTAG interfaces with support for different driver modes, like the Amontec
3840 JTAGkey and JTAG Accelerator. Also, they are necessarily ignored if the
3841 relevant signal (TRST or SRST) is not connected.
3842
3843 @itemize
3844 @item
3845 Possible @var{trst_type} driver modes for the test reset signal (TRST)
3846 are the default @option{trst_push_pull}, and @option{trst_open_drain}.
3847 Most boards connect this signal to a pulldown, so the JTAG TAPs
3848 never leave reset unless they are hooked up to a JTAG adapter.
3849
3850 @item
3851 Possible @var{srst_type} driver modes for the system reset signal (SRST)
3852 are the default @option{srst_open_drain}, and @option{srst_push_pull}.
3853 Most boards connect this signal to a pullup, and allow the
3854 signal to be pulled low by various events including system
3855 power-up and pressing a reset button.
3856 @end itemize
3857 @end deffn
3858
3859 @section Custom Reset Handling
3860 @cindex events
3861
3862 OpenOCD has several ways to help support the various reset
3863 mechanisms provided by chip and board vendors.
3864 The commands shown in the previous section give standard parameters.
3865 There are also @emph{event handlers} associated with TAPs or Targets.
3866 Those handlers are Tcl procedures you can provide, which are invoked
3867 at particular points in the reset sequence.
3868
3869 @emph{When SRST is not an option} you must set
3870 up a @code{reset-assert} event handler for your target.
3871 For example, some JTAG adapters don't include the SRST signal;
3872 and some boards have multiple targets, and you won't always
3873 want to reset everything at once.
3874
3875 After configuring those mechanisms, you might still
3876 find your board doesn't start up or reset correctly.
3877 For example, maybe it needs a slightly different sequence
3878 of SRST and/or TRST manipulations, because of quirks that
3879 the @command{reset_config} mechanism doesn't address;
3880 or asserting both might trigger a stronger reset, which
3881 needs special attention.
3882
3883 Experiment with lower level operations, such as
3884 @command{adapter assert}, @command{adapter deassert}
3885 and the @command{jtag arp_*} operations shown here,
3886 to find a sequence of operations that works.
3887 @xref{JTAG Commands}.
3888 When you find a working sequence, it can be used to override
3889 @command{jtag_init}, which fires during OpenOCD startup
3890 (@pxref{configurationstage,,Configuration Stage});
3891 or @command{init_reset}, which fires during reset processing.
3892
3893 You might also want to provide some project-specific reset
3894 schemes. For example, on a multi-target board the standard
3895 @command{reset} command would reset all targets, but you
3896 may need the ability to reset only one target at time and
3897 thus want to avoid using the board-wide SRST signal.
3898
3899 @deffn {Overridable Procedure} {init_reset} mode
3900 This is invoked near the beginning of the @command{reset} command,
3901 usually to provide as much of a cold (power-up) reset as practical.
3902 By default it is also invoked from @command{jtag_init} if
3903 the scan chain does not respond to pure JTAG operations.
3904 The @var{mode} parameter is the parameter given to the
3905 low level reset command (@option{halt},
3906 @option{init}, or @option{run}), @option{setup},
3907 or potentially some other value.
3908
3909 The default implementation just invokes @command{jtag arp_init-reset}.
3910 Replacements will normally build on low level JTAG
3911 operations such as @command{adapter assert} and @command{adapter deassert}.
3912 Operations here must not address individual TAPs
3913 (or their associated targets)
3914 until the JTAG scan chain has first been verified to work.
3915
3916 Implementations must have verified the JTAG scan chain before
3917 they return.
3918 This is done by calling @command{jtag arp_init}
3919 (or @command{jtag arp_init-reset}).
3920 @end deffn
3921
3922 @deffn {Command} {jtag arp_init}
3923 This validates the scan chain using just the four
3924 standard JTAG signals (TMS, TCK, TDI, TDO).
3925 It starts by issuing a JTAG-only reset.
3926 Then it performs checks to verify that the scan chain configuration
3927 matches the TAPs it can observe.
3928 Those checks include checking IDCODE values for each active TAP,
3929 and verifying the length of their instruction registers using
3930 TAP @code{-ircapture} and @code{-irmask} values.
3931 If these tests all pass, TAP @code{setup} events are
3932 issued to all TAPs with handlers for that event.
3933 @end deffn
3934
3935 @deffn {Command} {jtag arp_init-reset}
3936 This uses TRST and SRST to try resetting
3937 everything on the JTAG scan chain
3938 (and anything else connected to SRST).
3939 It then invokes the logic of @command{jtag arp_init}.
3940 @end deffn
3941
3942
3943 @node TAP Declaration
3944 @chapter TAP Declaration
3945 @cindex TAP declaration
3946 @cindex TAP configuration
3947
3948 @emph{Test Access Ports} (TAPs) are the core of JTAG.
3949 TAPs serve many roles, including:
3950
3951 @itemize @bullet
3952 @item @b{Debug Target} A CPU TAP can be used as a GDB debug target.
3953 @item @b{Flash Programming} Some chips program the flash directly via JTAG.
3954 Others do it indirectly, making a CPU do it.
3955 @item @b{Program Download} Using the same CPU support GDB uses,
3956 you can initialize a DRAM controller, download code to DRAM, and then
3957 start running that code.
3958 @item @b{Boundary Scan} Most chips support boundary scan, which
3959 helps test for board assembly problems like solder bridges
3960 and missing connections.
3961 @end itemize
3962
3963 OpenOCD must know about the active TAPs on your board(s).
3964 Setting up the TAPs is the core task of your configuration files.
3965 Once those TAPs are set up, you can pass their names to code
3966 which sets up CPUs and exports them as GDB targets,
3967 probes flash memory, performs low-level JTAG operations, and more.
3968
3969 @section Scan Chains
3970 @cindex scan chain
3971
3972 TAPs are part of a hardware @dfn{scan chain},
3973 which is a daisy chain of TAPs.
3974 They also need to be added to
3975 OpenOCD's software mirror of that hardware list,
3976 giving each member a name and associating other data with it.
3977 Simple scan chains, with a single TAP, are common in
3978 systems with a single microcontroller or microprocessor.
3979 More complex chips may have several TAPs internally.
3980 Very complex scan chains might have a dozen or more TAPs:
3981 several in one chip, more in the next, and connecting
3982 to other boards with their own chips and TAPs.
3983
3984 You can display the list with the @command{scan_chain} command.
3985 (Don't confuse this with the list displayed by the @command{targets}
3986 command, presented in the next chapter.
3987 That only displays TAPs for CPUs which are configured as
3988 debugging targets.)
3989 Here's what the scan chain might look like for a chip more than one TAP:
3990
3991 @verbatim
3992 TapName Enabled IdCode Expected IrLen IrCap IrMask
3993 -- ------------------ ------- ---------- ---------- ----- ----- ------
3994 0 omap5912.dsp Y 0x03df1d81 0x03df1d81 38 0x01 0x03
3995 1 omap5912.arm Y 0x0692602f 0x0692602f 4 0x01 0x0f
3996 2 omap5912.unknown Y 0x00000000 0x00000000 8 0x01 0x03
3997 @end verbatim
3998
3999 OpenOCD can detect some of that information, but not all
4000 of it. @xref{autoprobing,,Autoprobing}.
4001 Unfortunately, those TAPs can't always be autoconfigured,
4002 because not all devices provide good support for that.
4003 JTAG doesn't require supporting IDCODE instructions, and
4004 chips with JTAG routers may not link TAPs into the chain
4005 until they are told to do so.
4006
4007 The configuration mechanism currently supported by OpenOCD
4008 requires explicit configuration of all TAP devices using
4009 @command{jtag newtap} commands, as detailed later in this chapter.
4010 A command like this would declare one tap and name it @code{chip1.cpu}:
4011
4012 @example
4013 jtag newtap chip1 cpu -irlen 4 -expected-id 0x3ba00477
4014 @end example
4015
4016 Each target configuration file lists the TAPs provided
4017 by a given chip.
4018 Board configuration files combine all the targets on a board,
4019 and so forth.
4020 Note that @emph{the order in which TAPs are declared is very important.}
4021 That declaration order must match the order in the JTAG scan chain,
4022 both inside a single chip and between them.
4023 @xref{faqtaporder,,FAQ TAP Order}.
4024
4025 For example, the STMicroelectronics STR912 chip has
4026 three separate TAPs@footnote{See the ST
4027 document titled: @emph{STR91xFAxxx, Section 3.15 Jtag Interface, Page:
4028 28/102, Figure 3: JTAG chaining inside the STR91xFA}.
4029 @url{http://eu.st.com/stonline/products/literature/ds/13495.pdf}}.
4030 To configure those taps, @file{target/str912.cfg}
4031 includes commands something like this:
4032
4033 @example
4034 jtag newtap str912 flash ... params ...
4035 jtag newtap str912 cpu ... params ...
4036 jtag newtap str912 bs ... params ...
4037 @end example
4038
4039 Actual config files typically use a variable such as @code{$_CHIPNAME}
4040 instead of literals like @option{str912}, to support more than one chip
4041 of each type. @xref{Config File Guidelines}.
4042
4043 @deffn {Command} {jtag names}
4044 Returns the names of all current TAPs in the scan chain.
4045 Use @command{jtag cget} or @command{jtag tapisenabled}
4046 to examine attributes and state of each TAP.
4047 @example
4048 foreach t [jtag names] @{
4049 puts [format "TAP: %s\n" $t]
4050 @}
4051 @end example
4052 @end deffn
4053
4054 @deffn {Command} {scan_chain}
4055 Displays the TAPs in the scan chain configuration,
4056 and their status.
4057 The set of TAPs listed by this command is fixed by
4058 exiting the OpenOCD configuration stage,
4059 but systems with a JTAG router can
4060 enable or disable TAPs dynamically.
4061 @end deffn
4062
4063 @c FIXME! "jtag cget" should be able to return all TAP
4064 @c attributes, like "$target_name cget" does for targets.
4065
4066 @c Probably want "jtag eventlist", and a "tap-reset" event
4067 @c (on entry to RESET state).
4068
4069 @section TAP Names
4070 @cindex dotted name
4071
4072 When TAP objects are declared with @command{jtag newtap},
4073 a @dfn{dotted.name} is created for the TAP, combining the
4074 name of a module (usually a chip) and a label for the TAP.
4075 For example: @code{xilinx.tap}, @code{str912.flash},
4076 @code{omap3530.jrc}, @code{dm6446.dsp}, or @code{stm32.cpu}.
4077 Many other commands use that dotted.name to manipulate or
4078 refer to the TAP. For example, CPU configuration uses the
4079 name, as does declaration of NAND or NOR flash banks.
4080
4081 The components of a dotted name should follow ``C'' symbol
4082 name rules: start with an alphabetic character, then numbers
4083 and underscores are OK; while others (including dots!) are not.
4084
4085 @section TAP Declaration Commands
4086
4087 @deffn {Config Command} {jtag newtap} chipname tapname configparams...
4088 Declares a new TAP with the dotted name @var{chipname}.@var{tapname},
4089 and configured according to the various @var{configparams}.
4090
4091 The @var{chipname} is a symbolic name for the chip.
4092 Conventionally target config files use @code{$_CHIPNAME},
4093 defaulting to the model name given by the chip vendor but
4094 overridable.
4095
4096 @cindex TAP naming convention
4097 The @var{tapname} reflects the role of that TAP,
4098 and should follow this convention:
4099
4100 @itemize @bullet
4101 @item @code{bs} -- For boundary scan if this is a separate TAP;
4102 @item @code{cpu} -- The main CPU of the chip, alternatively
4103 @code{arm} and @code{dsp} on chips with both ARM and DSP CPUs,
4104 @code{arm1} and @code{arm2} on chips with two ARMs, and so forth;
4105 @item @code{etb} -- For an embedded trace buffer (example: an ARM ETB11);
4106 @item @code{flash} -- If the chip has a flash TAP, like the str912;
4107 @item @code{jrc} -- For JTAG route controller (example: the ICEPick modules
4108 on many Texas Instruments chips, like the OMAP3530 on Beagleboards);
4109 @item @code{tap} -- Should be used only for FPGA- or CPLD-like devices
4110 with a single TAP;
4111 @item @code{unknownN} -- If you have no idea what the TAP is for (N is a number);
4112 @item @emph{when in doubt} -- Use the chip maker's name in their data sheet.
4113 For example, the Freescale i.MX31 has a SDMA (Smart DMA) with
4114 a JTAG TAP; that TAP should be named @code{sdma}.
4115 @end itemize
4116
4117 Every TAP requires at least the following @var{configparams}:
4118
4119 @itemize @bullet
4120 @item @code{-irlen} @var{NUMBER}
4121 @*The length in bits of the
4122 instruction register, such as 4 or 5 bits.
4123 @end itemize
4124
4125 A TAP may also provide optional @var{configparams}:
4126
4127 @itemize @bullet
4128 @item @code{-disable} (or @code{-enable})
4129 @*Use the @code{-disable} parameter to flag a TAP which is not
4130 linked into the scan chain after a reset using either TRST
4131 or the JTAG state machine's @sc{reset} state.
4132 You may use @code{-enable} to highlight the default state
4133 (the TAP is linked in).
4134 @xref{enablinganddisablingtaps,,Enabling and Disabling TAPs}.
4135 @item @code{-expected-id} @var{NUMBER}
4136 @*A non-zero @var{number} represents a 32-bit IDCODE
4137 which you expect to find when the scan chain is examined.
4138 These codes are not required by all JTAG devices.
4139 @emph{Repeat the option} as many times as required if more than one
4140 ID code could appear (for example, multiple versions).
4141 Specify @var{number} as zero to suppress warnings about IDCODE
4142 values that were found but not included in the list.
4143
4144 Provide this value if at all possible, since it lets OpenOCD
4145 tell when the scan chain it sees isn't right. These values
4146 are provided in vendors' chip documentation, usually a technical
4147 reference manual. Sometimes you may need to probe the JTAG
4148 hardware to find these values.
4149 @xref{autoprobing,,Autoprobing}.
4150 @item @code{-ignore-version}
4151 @*Specify this to ignore the JTAG version field in the @code{-expected-id}
4152 option. When vendors put out multiple versions of a chip, or use the same
4153 JTAG-level ID for several largely-compatible chips, it may be more practical
4154 to ignore the version field than to update config files to handle all of
4155 the various chip IDs. The version field is defined as bit 28-31 of the IDCODE.
4156 @item @code{-ignore-bypass}
4157 @*Specify this to ignore the 'bypass' bit of the idcode. Some vendor put
4158 an invalid idcode regarding this bit. Specify this to ignore this bit and
4159 to not consider this tap in bypass mode.
4160 @item @code{-ircapture} @var{NUMBER}
4161 @*The bit pattern loaded by the TAP into the JTAG shift register
4162 on entry to the @sc{ircapture} state, such as 0x01.
4163 JTAG requires the two LSBs of this value to be 01.
4164 By default, @code{-ircapture} and @code{-irmask} are set
4165 up to verify that two-bit value. You may provide
4166 additional bits if you know them, or indicate that
4167 a TAP doesn't conform to the JTAG specification.
4168 @item @code{-irmask} @var{NUMBER}
4169 @*A mask used with @code{-ircapture}
4170 to verify that instruction scans work correctly.
4171 Such scans are not used by OpenOCD except to verify that
4172 there seems to be no problems with JTAG scan chain operations.
4173 @item @code{-ignore-syspwrupack}
4174 @*Specify this to ignore the CSYSPWRUPACK bit in the ARM DAP DP CTRL/STAT
4175 register during initial examination and when checking the sticky error bit.
4176 This bit is normally checked after setting the CSYSPWRUPREQ bit, but some
4177 devices do not set the ack bit until sometime later.
4178 @end itemize
4179 @end deffn
4180
4181 @section Other TAP commands
4182
4183 @deffn {Command} {jtag cget} dotted.name @option{-idcode}
4184 Get the value of the IDCODE found in hardware.
4185 @end deffn
4186
4187 @deffn {Command} {jtag cget} dotted.name @option{-event} event_name
4188 @deffnx {Command} {jtag configure} dotted.name @option{-event} event_name handler
4189 At this writing this TAP attribute
4190 mechanism is limited and used mostly for event handling.
4191 (It is not a direct analogue of the @code{cget}/@code{configure}
4192 mechanism for debugger targets.)
4193 See the next section for information about the available events.
4194
4195 The @code{configure} subcommand assigns an event handler,
4196 a TCL string which is evaluated when the event is triggered.
4197 The @code{cget} subcommand returns that handler.
4198 @end deffn
4199
4200 @section TAP Events
4201 @cindex events
4202 @cindex TAP events
4203
4204 OpenOCD includes two event mechanisms.
4205 The one presented here applies to all JTAG TAPs.
4206 The other applies to debugger targets,
4207 which are associated with certain TAPs.
4208
4209 The TAP events currently defined are:
4210
4211 @itemize @bullet
4212 @item @b{post-reset}
4213 @* The TAP has just completed a JTAG reset.
4214 The tap may still be in the JTAG @sc{reset} state.
4215 Handlers for these events might perform initialization sequences
4216 such as issuing TCK cycles, TMS sequences to ensure
4217 exit from the ARM SWD mode, and more.
4218
4219 Because the scan chain has not yet been verified, handlers for these events
4220 @emph{should not issue commands which scan the JTAG IR or DR registers}
4221 of any particular target.
4222 @b{NOTE:} As this is written (September 2009), nothing prevents such access.
4223 @item @b{setup}
4224 @* The scan chain has been reset and verified.
4225 This handler may enable TAPs as needed.
4226 @item @b{tap-disable}
4227 @* The TAP needs to be disabled. This handler should
4228 implement @command{jtag tapdisable}
4229 by issuing the relevant JTAG commands.
4230 @item @b{tap-enable}
4231 @* The TAP needs to be enabled. This handler should
4232 implement @command{jtag tapenable}
4233 by issuing the relevant JTAG commands.
4234 @end itemize
4235
4236 If you need some action after each JTAG reset which isn't actually
4237 specific to any TAP (since you can't yet trust the scan chain's
4238 contents to be accurate), you might:
4239
4240 @example
4241 jtag configure CHIP.jrc -event post-reset @{
4242 echo "JTAG Reset done"
4243 ... non-scan jtag operations to be done after reset
4244 @}
4245 @end example
4246
4247
4248 @anchor{enablinganddisablingtaps}
4249 @section Enabling and Disabling TAPs
4250 @cindex JTAG Route Controller
4251 @cindex jrc
4252
4253 In some systems, a @dfn{JTAG Route Controller} (JRC)
4254 is used to enable and/or disable specific JTAG TAPs.
4255 Many ARM-based chips from Texas Instruments include
4256 an ``ICEPick'' module, which is a JRC.
4257 Such chips include DaVinci and OMAP3 processors.
4258
4259 A given TAP may not be visible until the JRC has been
4260 told to link it into the scan chain; and if the JRC
4261 has been told to unlink that TAP, it will no longer
4262 be visible.
4263 Such routers address problems that JTAG ``bypass mode''
4264 ignores, such as:
4265
4266 @itemize
4267 @item The scan chain can only go as fast as its slowest TAP.
4268 @item Having many TAPs slows instruction scans, since all
4269 TAPs receive new instructions.
4270 @item TAPs in the scan chain must be powered up, which wastes
4271 power and prevents debugging some power management mechanisms.
4272 @end itemize
4273
4274 The IEEE 1149.1 JTAG standard has no concept of a ``disabled'' tap,
4275 as implied by the existence of JTAG routers.
4276 However, the upcoming IEEE 1149.7 framework (layered on top of JTAG)
4277 does include a kind of JTAG router functionality.
4278
4279 @c (a) currently the event handlers don't seem to be able to
4280 @c fail in a way that could lead to no-change-of-state.
4281
4282 In OpenOCD, tap enabling/disabling is invoked by the Tcl commands
4283 shown below, and is implemented using TAP event handlers.
4284 So for example, when defining a TAP for a CPU connected to
4285 a JTAG router, your @file{target.cfg} file
4286 should define TAP event handlers using
4287 code that looks something like this:
4288
4289 @example
4290 jtag configure CHIP.cpu -event tap-enable @{
4291 ... jtag operations using CHIP.jrc
4292 @}
4293 jtag configure CHIP.cpu -event tap-disable @{
4294 ... jtag operations using CHIP.jrc
4295 @}
4296 @end example
4297
4298 Then you might want that CPU's TAP enabled almost all the time:
4299
4300 @example
4301 jtag configure $CHIP.jrc -event setup "jtag tapenable $CHIP.cpu"
4302 @end example
4303
4304 Note how that particular setup event handler declaration
4305 uses quotes to evaluate @code{$CHIP} when the event is configured.
4306 Using brackets @{ @} would cause it to be evaluated later,
4307 at runtime, when it might have a different value.
4308
4309 @deffn {Command} {jtag tapdisable} dotted.name
4310 If necessary, disables the tap
4311 by sending it a @option{tap-disable} event.
4312 Returns the string "1" if the tap
4313 specified by @var{dotted.name} is enabled,
4314 and "0" if it is disabled.
4315 @end deffn
4316
4317 @deffn {Command} {jtag tapenable} dotted.name
4318 If necessary, enables the tap
4319 by sending it a @option{tap-enable} event.
4320 Returns the string "1" if the tap
4321 specified by @var{dotted.name} is enabled,
4322 and "0" if it is disabled.
4323 @end deffn
4324
4325 @deffn {Command} {jtag tapisenabled} dotted.name
4326 Returns the string "1" if the tap
4327 specified by @var{dotted.name} is enabled,
4328 and "0" if it is disabled.
4329
4330 @quotation Note
4331 Humans will find the @command{scan_chain} command more helpful
4332 for querying the state of the JTAG taps.
4333 @end quotation
4334 @end deffn
4335
4336 @anchor{autoprobing}
4337 @section Autoprobing
4338 @cindex autoprobe
4339 @cindex JTAG autoprobe
4340
4341 TAP configuration is the first thing that needs to be done
4342 after interface and reset configuration. Sometimes it's
4343 hard finding out what TAPs exist, or how they are identified.
4344 Vendor documentation is not always easy to find and use.
4345
4346 To help you get past such problems, OpenOCD has a limited
4347 @emph{autoprobing} ability to look at the scan chain, doing
4348 a @dfn{blind interrogation} and then reporting the TAPs it finds.
4349 To use this mechanism, start the OpenOCD server with only data
4350 that configures your JTAG interface, and arranges to come up
4351 with a slow clock (many devices don't support fast JTAG clocks
4352 right when they come out of reset).
4353
4354 For example, your @file{openocd.cfg} file might have:
4355
4356 @example
4357 source [find interface/olimex-arm-usb-tiny-h.cfg]
4358 reset_config trst_and_srst
4359 jtag_rclk 8
4360 @end example
4361
4362 When you start the server without any TAPs configured, it will
4363 attempt to autoconfigure the TAPs. There are two parts to this:
4364
4365 @enumerate
4366 @item @emph{TAP discovery} ...
4367 After a JTAG reset (sometimes a system reset may be needed too),
4368 each TAP's data registers will hold the contents of either the
4369 IDCODE or BYPASS register.
4370 If JTAG communication is working, OpenOCD will see each TAP,
4371 and report what @option{-expected-id} to use with it.
4372 @item @emph{IR Length discovery} ...
4373 Unfortunately JTAG does not provide a reliable way to find out
4374 the value of the @option{-irlen} parameter to use with a TAP
4375 that is discovered.
4376 If OpenOCD can discover the length of a TAP's instruction
4377 register, it will report it.
4378 Otherwise you may need to consult vendor documentation, such
4379 as chip data sheets or BSDL files.
4380 @end enumerate
4381
4382 In many cases your board will have a simple scan chain with just
4383 a single device. Here's what OpenOCD reported with one board
4384 that's a bit more complex:
4385
4386 @example
4387 clock speed 8 kHz
4388 There are no enabled taps. AUTO PROBING MIGHT NOT WORK!!
4389 AUTO auto0.tap - use "jtag newtap auto0 tap -expected-id 0x2b900f0f ..."
4390 AUTO auto1.tap - use "jtag newtap auto1 tap -expected-id 0x07926001 ..."
4391 AUTO auto2.tap - use "jtag newtap auto2 tap -expected-id 0x0b73b02f ..."
4392 AUTO auto0.tap - use "... -irlen 4"
4393 AUTO auto1.tap - use "... -irlen 4"
4394 AUTO auto2.tap - use "... -irlen 6"
4395 no gdb ports allocated as no target has been specified
4396 @end example
4397
4398 Given that information, you should be able to either find some existing
4399 config files to use, or create your own. If you create your own, you
4400 would configure from the bottom up: first a @file{target.cfg} file
4401 with these TAPs, any targets associated with them, and any on-chip
4402 resources; then a @file{board.cfg} with off-chip resources, clocking,
4403 and so forth.
4404
4405 @anchor{dapdeclaration}
4406 @section DAP declaration (ARMv6-M, ARMv7 and ARMv8 targets)
4407 @cindex DAP declaration
4408
4409 Since OpenOCD version 0.11.0, the Debug Access Port (DAP) is
4410 no longer implicitly created together with the target. It must be
4411 explicitly declared using the @command{dap create} command. For all ARMv6-M, ARMv7
4412 and ARMv8 targets, the option "@option{-dap} @var{dap_name}" has to be used
4413 instead of "@option{-chain-position} @var{dotted.name}" when the target is created.
4414
4415 The @command{dap} command group supports the following sub-commands:
4416
4417 @anchor{dap_create}
4418 @deffn {Command} {dap create} dap_name @option{-chain-position} dotted.name configparams...
4419 Declare a DAP instance named @var{dap_name} linked to the JTAG tap
4420 @var{dotted.name}. This also creates a new command (@command{dap_name})
4421 which is used for various purposes including additional configuration.
4422 There can only be one DAP for each JTAG tap in the system.
4423
4424 A DAP may also provide optional @var{configparams}:
4425
4426 @itemize @bullet
4427 @item @code{-ignore-syspwrupack}
4428 @*Specify this to ignore the CSYSPWRUPACK bit in the ARM DAP DP CTRL/STAT
4429 register during initial examination and when checking the sticky error bit.
4430 This bit is normally checked after setting the CSYSPWRUPREQ bit, but some
4431 devices do not set the ack bit until sometime later.
4432
4433 @item @code{-dp-id} @var{number}
4434 @*Debug port identification number for SWD DPv2 multidrop.
4435 The @var{number} is written to bits 0..27 of DP TARGETSEL during DP selection.
4436 To find the id number of a single connected device read DP TARGETID:
4437 @code{device.dap dpreg 0x24}
4438 Use bits 0..27 of TARGETID.
4439
4440 @item @code{-instance-id} @var{number}
4441 @*Instance identification number for SWD DPv2 multidrop.
4442 The @var{number} is written to bits 28..31 of DP TARGETSEL during DP selection.
4443 To find the instance number of a single connected device read DP DLPIDR:
4444 @code{device.dap dpreg 0x34}
4445 The instance number is in bits 28..31 of DLPIDR value.
4446 @end itemize
4447 @end deffn
4448
4449 @deffn {Command} {dap names}
4450 This command returns a list of all registered DAP objects. It it useful mainly
4451 for TCL scripting.
4452 @end deffn
4453
4454 @deffn {Command} {dap info} [num]
4455 Displays the ROM table for MEM-AP @var{num},
4456 defaulting to the currently selected AP of the currently selected target.
4457 @end deffn
4458
4459 @deffn {Command} {dap init}
4460 Initialize all registered DAPs. This command is used internally
4461 during initialization. It can be issued at any time after the
4462 initialization, too.
4463 @end deffn
4464
4465 The following commands exist as subcommands of DAP instances:
4466
4467 @deffn {Command} {$dap_name info} [num]
4468 Displays the ROM table for MEM-AP @var{num},
4469 defaulting to the currently selected AP.
4470 @end deffn
4471
4472 @deffn {Command} {$dap_name apid} [num]
4473 Displays ID register from AP @var{num}, defaulting to the currently selected AP.
4474 @end deffn
4475
4476 @anchor{DAP subcommand apreg}
4477 @deffn {Command} {$dap_name apreg} ap_num reg [value]
4478 Displays content of a register @var{reg} from AP @var{ap_num}
4479 or set a new value @var{value}.
4480 @var{reg} is byte address of a word register, 0, 4, 8 ... 0xfc.
4481 @end deffn
4482
4483 @deffn {Command} {$dap_name apsel} [num]
4484 Select AP @var{num}, defaulting to 0.
4485 @end deffn
4486
4487 @deffn {Command} {$dap_name dpreg} reg [value]
4488 Displays the content of DP register at address @var{reg}, or set it to a new
4489 value @var{value}.
4490
4491 In case of SWD, @var{reg} is a value in packed format
4492 @math{dpbanksel << 4 | addr} and assumes values 0, 4, 8 ... 0xfc.
4493 In case of JTAG it only assumes values 0, 4, 8 and 0xc.
4494
4495 @emph{Note:} Consider using @command{poll off} to avoid any disturbing
4496 background activity by OpenOCD while you are operating at such low-level.
4497 @end deffn
4498
4499 @deffn {Command} {$dap_name baseaddr} [num]
4500 Displays debug base address from MEM-AP @var{num},
4501 defaulting to the currently selected AP.
4502 @end deffn
4503
4504 @deffn {Command} {$dap_name memaccess} [value]
4505 Displays the number of extra tck cycles in the JTAG idle to use for MEM-AP
4506 memory bus access [0-255], giving additional time to respond to reads.
4507 If @var{value} is defined, first assigns that.
4508 @end deffn
4509
4510 @deffn {Command} {$dap_name apcsw} [value [mask]]
4511 Displays or changes CSW bit pattern for MEM-AP transfers.
4512
4513 At the begin of each memory access the CSW pattern is extended (bitwise or-ed)
4514 by @dfn{Size} and @dfn{AddrInc} bit-fields according to transfer requirements
4515 and the result is written to the real CSW register. All bits except dynamically
4516 updated fields @dfn{Size} and @dfn{AddrInc} can be changed by changing
4517 the CSW pattern. Refer to ARM ADI v5 manual chapter 7.6.4 and appendix A
4518 for details.
4519
4520 Use @var{value} only syntax if you want to set the new CSW pattern as a whole.
4521 The example sets HPROT1 bit (required by Cortex-M) and clears the rest of
4522 the pattern:
4523 @example
4524 kx.dap apcsw 0x2000000
4525 @end example
4526
4527 If @var{mask} is also used, the CSW pattern is changed only on bit positions
4528 where the mask bit is 1. The following example sets HPROT3 (cacheable)
4529 and leaves the rest of the pattern intact. It configures memory access through
4530 DCache on Cortex-M7.
4531 @example
4532 set CSW_HPROT3_CACHEABLE [expr @{1 << 27@}]
4533 samv.dap apcsw $CSW_HPROT3_CACHEABLE $CSW_HPROT3_CACHEABLE
4534 @end example
4535
4536 Another example clears SPROT bit and leaves the rest of pattern intact:
4537 @example
4538 set CSW_SPROT [expr @{1 << 30@}]
4539 samv.dap apcsw 0 $CSW_SPROT
4540 @end example
4541
4542 @emph{Note:} If you want to check the real value of CSW, not CSW pattern, use
4543 @code{xxx.dap apreg 0}. @xref{DAP subcommand apreg,,}.
4544
4545 @emph{Warning:} Some of the CSW bits are vital for working memory transfer.
4546 If you set a wrong CSW pattern and MEM-AP stopped working, use the following
4547 example with a proper dap name:
4548 @example
4549 xxx.dap apcsw default
4550 @end example
4551 @end deffn
4552
4553 @deffn {Config Command} {$dap_name ti_be_32_quirks} [@option{enable}]
4554 Set/get quirks mode for TI TMS450/TMS570 processors
4555 Disabled by default
4556 @end deffn
4557
4558
4559 @node CPU Configuration
4560 @chapter CPU Configuration
4561 @cindex GDB target
4562
4563 This chapter discusses how to set up GDB debug targets for CPUs.
4564 You can also access these targets without GDB
4565 (@pxref{Architecture and Core Commands},
4566 and @ref{targetstatehandling,,Target State handling}) and
4567 through various kinds of NAND and NOR flash commands.
4568 If you have multiple CPUs you can have multiple such targets.
4569
4570 We'll start by looking at how to examine the targets you have,
4571 then look at how to add one more target and how to configure it.
4572
4573 @section Target List
4574 @cindex target, current
4575 @cindex target, list
4576
4577 All targets that have been set up are part of a list,
4578 where each member has a name.
4579 That name should normally be the same as the TAP name.
4580 You can display the list with the @command{targets}
4581 (plural!) command.
4582 This display often has only one CPU; here's what it might
4583 look like with more than one:
4584 @verbatim
4585 TargetName Type Endian TapName State
4586 -- ------------------ ---------- ------ ------------------ ------------
4587 0* at91rm9200.cpu arm920t little at91rm9200.cpu running
4588 1 MyTarget cortex_m little mychip.foo tap-disabled
4589 @end verbatim
4590
4591 One member of that list is the @dfn{current target}, which
4592 is implicitly referenced by many commands.
4593 It's the one marked with a @code{*} near the target name.
4594 In particular, memory addresses often refer to the address
4595 space seen by that current target.
4596 Commands like @command{mdw} (memory display words)
4597 and @command{flash erase_address} (erase NOR flash blocks)
4598 are examples; and there are many more.
4599
4600 Several commands let you examine the list of targets:
4601
4602 @deffn {Command} {target current}
4603 Returns the name of the current target.
4604 @end deffn
4605
4606 @deffn {Command} {target names}
4607 Lists the names of all current targets in the list.
4608 @example
4609 foreach t [target names] @{
4610 puts [format "Target: %s\n" $t]
4611 @}
4612 @end example
4613 @end deffn
4614
4615 @c yep, "target list" would have been better.
4616 @c plus maybe "target setdefault".
4617
4618 @deffn {Command} {targets} [name]
4619 @emph{Note: the name of this command is plural. Other target
4620 command names are singular.}
4621
4622 With no parameter, this command displays a table of all known
4623 targets in a user friendly form.
4624
4625 With a parameter, this command sets the current target to
4626 the given target with the given @var{name}; this is
4627 only relevant on boards which have more than one target.
4628 @end deffn
4629
4630 @section Target CPU Types
4631 @cindex target type
4632 @cindex CPU type
4633
4634 Each target has a @dfn{CPU type}, as shown in the output of
4635 the @command{targets} command. You need to specify that type
4636 when calling @command{target create}.
4637 The CPU type indicates more than just the instruction set.
4638 It also indicates how that instruction set is implemented,
4639 what kind of debug support it integrates,
4640 whether it has an MMU (and if so, what kind),
4641 what core-specific commands may be available
4642 (@pxref{Architecture and Core Commands}),
4643 and more.
4644
4645 It's easy to see what target types are supported,
4646 since there's a command to list them.
4647
4648 @anchor{targettypes}
4649 @deffn {Command} {target types}
4650 Lists all supported target types.
4651 At this writing, the supported CPU types are:
4652
4653 @itemize @bullet
4654 @item @code{aarch64} -- this is an ARMv8-A core with an MMU.
4655 @item @code{arm11} -- this is a generation of ARMv6 cores.
4656 @item @code{arm720t} -- this is an ARMv4 core with an MMU.
4657 @item @code{arm7tdmi} -- this is an ARMv4 core.
4658 @item @code{arm920t} -- this is an ARMv4 core with an MMU.
4659 @item @code{arm926ejs} -- this is an ARMv5 core with an MMU.
4660 @item @code{arm946e} -- this is an ARMv5 core with an MMU.
4661 @item @code{arm966e} -- this is an ARMv5 core.
4662 @item @code{arm9tdmi} -- this is an ARMv4 core.
4663 @item @code{avr} -- implements Atmel's 8-bit AVR instruction set.
4664 (Support for this is preliminary and incomplete.)
4665 @item @code{avr32_ap7k} -- this an AVR32 core.
4666 @item @code{cortex_a} -- this is an ARMv7-A core with an MMU.
4667 @item @code{cortex_m} -- this is an ARMv7-M core, supporting only the
4668 compact Thumb2 instruction set. Supports also ARMv6-M and ARMv8-M cores
4669 @item @code{cortex_r4} -- this is an ARMv7-R core.
4670 @item @code{dragonite} -- resembles arm966e.
4671 @item @code{dsp563xx} -- implements Freescale's 24-bit DSP.
4672 (Support for this is still incomplete.)
4673 @item @code{dsp5680xx} -- implements Freescale's 5680x DSP.
4674 @item @code{esirisc} -- this is an EnSilica eSi-RISC core.
4675 The current implementation supports eSi-32xx cores.
4676 @item @code{fa526} -- resembles arm920 (w/o Thumb).
4677 @item @code{feroceon} -- resembles arm926.
4678 @item @code{hla_target} -- a Cortex-M alternative to work with HL adapters like ST-Link.
4679 @item @code{ls1_sap} -- this is the SAP on NXP LS102x CPUs,
4680 allowing access to physical memory addresses independently of CPU cores.
4681 @item @code{mem_ap} -- this is an ARM debug infrastructure Access Port without
4682 a CPU, through which bus read and write cycles can be generated; it may be
4683 useful for working with non-CPU hardware behind an AP or during development of
4684 support for new CPUs.
4685 It's possible to connect a GDB client to this target (the GDB port has to be
4686 specified, @xref{gdbportoverride,,option -gdb-port}.), and a fake ARM core will
4687 be emulated to comply to GDB remote protocol.
4688 @item @code{mips_m4k} -- a MIPS core.
4689 @item @code{mips_mips64} -- a MIPS64 core.
4690 @item @code{nds32_v2} -- this is an Andes NDS32 v2 core.
4691 @item @code{nds32_v3} -- this is an Andes NDS32 v3 core.
4692 @item @code{nds32_v3m} -- this is an Andes NDS32 v3m core.
4693 @item @code{or1k} -- this is an OpenRISC 1000 core.
4694 The current implementation supports three JTAG TAP cores:
4695 @itemize @minus
4696 @item @code{OpenCores TAP} (See: @url{http://opencores.org/project@comma{}jtag})
4697 @item @code{Altera Virtual JTAG TAP} (See: @url{http://www.altera.com/literature/ug/ug_virtualjtag.pdf})
4698 @item @code{Xilinx BSCAN_* virtual JTAG interface} (See: @url{http://www.xilinx.com/support/documentation/sw_manuals/xilinx14_2/spartan6_hdl.pdf})
4699 @end itemize
4700 And two debug interfaces cores:
4701 @itemize @minus
4702 @item @code{Advanced debug interface}
4703 @*(See: @url{http://opencores.org/project@comma{}adv_debug_sys})
4704 @item @code{SoC Debug Interface}
4705 @*(See: @url{http://opencores.org/project@comma{}dbg_interface})
4706 @end itemize
4707 @item @code{quark_d20xx} -- an Intel Quark D20xx core.
4708 @item @code{quark_x10xx} -- an Intel Quark X10xx core.
4709 @item @code{riscv} -- a RISC-V core.
4710 @item @code{stm8} -- implements an STM8 core.
4711 @item @code{testee} -- a dummy target for cases without a real CPU, e.g. CPLD.
4712 @item @code{xscale} -- this is actually an architecture,
4713 not a CPU type. It is based on the ARMv5 architecture.
4714 @end itemize
4715 @end deffn
4716
4717 To avoid being confused by the variety of ARM based cores, remember
4718 this key point: @emph{ARM is a technology licencing company}.
4719 (See: @url{http://www.arm.com}.)
4720 The CPU name used by OpenOCD will reflect the CPU design that was
4721 licensed, not a vendor brand which incorporates that design.
4722 Name prefixes like arm7, arm9, arm11, and cortex
4723 reflect design generations;
4724 while names like ARMv4, ARMv5, ARMv6, ARMv7 and ARMv8
4725 reflect an architecture version implemented by a CPU design.
4726
4727 @anchor{targetconfiguration}
4728 @section Target Configuration
4729
4730 Before creating a ``target'', you must have added its TAP to the scan chain.
4731 When you've added that TAP, you will have a @code{dotted.name}
4732 which is used to set up the CPU support.
4733 The chip-specific configuration file will normally configure its CPU(s)
4734 right after it adds all of the chip's TAPs to the scan chain.
4735
4736 Although you can set up a target in one step, it's often clearer if you
4737 use shorter commands and do it in two steps: create it, then configure
4738 optional parts.
4739 All operations on the target after it's created will use a new
4740 command, created as part of target creation.
4741
4742 The two main things to configure after target creation are
4743 a work area, which usually has target-specific defaults even
4744 if the board setup code overrides them later;
4745 and event handlers (@pxref{targetevents,,Target Events}), which tend
4746 to be much more board-specific.
4747 The key steps you use might look something like this
4748
4749 @example
4750 dap create mychip.dap -chain-position mychip.cpu
4751 target create MyTarget cortex_m -dap mychip.dap
4752 MyTarget configure -work-area-phys 0x08000 -work-area-size 8096
4753 MyTarget configure -event reset-deassert-pre @{ jtag_rclk 5 @}
4754 MyTarget configure -event reset-init @{ myboard_reinit @}
4755 @end example
4756
4757 You should specify a working area if you can; typically it uses some
4758 on-chip SRAM.
4759 Such a working area can speed up many things, including bulk
4760 writes to target memory;
4761 flash operations like checking to see if memory needs to be erased;
4762 GDB memory checksumming;
4763 and more.
4764
4765 @quotation Warning
4766 On more complex chips, the work area can become
4767 inaccessible when application code
4768 (such as an operating system)
4769 enables or disables the MMU.
4770 For example, the particular MMU context used to access the virtual
4771 address will probably matter ... and that context might not have
4772 easy access to other addresses needed.
4773 At this writing, OpenOCD doesn't have much MMU intelligence.
4774 @end quotation
4775
4776 It's often very useful to define a @code{reset-init} event handler.
4777 For systems that are normally used with a boot loader,
4778 common tasks include updating clocks and initializing memory
4779 controllers.
4780 That may be needed to let you write the boot loader into flash,
4781 in order to ``de-brick'' your board; or to load programs into
4782 external DDR memory without having run the boot loader.
4783
4784 @deffn {Config Command} {target create} target_name type configparams...
4785 This command creates a GDB debug target that refers to a specific JTAG tap.
4786 It enters that target into a list, and creates a new
4787 command (@command{@var{target_name}}) which is used for various
4788 purposes including additional configuration.
4789
4790 @itemize @bullet
4791 @item @var{target_name} ... is the name of the debug target.
4792 By convention this should be the same as the @emph{dotted.name}
4793 of the TAP associated with this target, which must be specified here
4794 using the @code{-chain-position @var{dotted.name}} configparam.
4795
4796 This name is also used to create the target object command,
4797 referred to here as @command{$target_name},
4798 and in other places the target needs to be identified.
4799 @item @var{type} ... specifies the target type. @xref{targettypes,,target types}.
4800 @item @var{configparams} ... all parameters accepted by
4801 @command{$target_name configure} are permitted.
4802 If the target is big-endian, set it here with @code{-endian big}.
4803
4804 You @emph{must} set the @code{-chain-position @var{dotted.name}} or
4805 @code{-dap @var{dap_name}} here.
4806 @end itemize
4807 @end deffn
4808
4809 @deffn {Command} {$target_name configure} configparams...
4810 The options accepted by this command may also be
4811 specified as parameters to @command{target create}.
4812 Their values can later be queried one at a time by
4813 using the @command{$target_name cget} command.
4814
4815 @emph{Warning:} changing some of these after setup is dangerous.
4816 For example, moving a target from one TAP to another;
4817 and changing its endianness.
4818
4819 @itemize @bullet
4820
4821 @item @code{-chain-position} @var{dotted.name} -- names the TAP
4822 used to access this target.
4823
4824 @item @code{-dap} @var{dap_name} -- names the DAP used to access
4825 this target. @xref{dapdeclaration,,DAP declaration}, on how to
4826 create and manage DAP instances.
4827
4828 @item @code{-endian} (@option{big}|@option{little}) -- specifies
4829 whether the CPU uses big or little endian conventions
4830
4831 @item @code{-event} @var{event_name} @var{event_body} --
4832 @xref{targetevents,,Target Events}.
4833 Note that this updates a list of named event handlers.
4834 Calling this twice with two different event names assigns
4835 two different handlers, but calling it twice with the
4836 same event name assigns only one handler.
4837
4838 Current target is temporarily overridden to the event issuing target
4839 before handler code starts and switched back after handler is done.
4840
4841 @item @code{-work-area-backup} (@option{0}|@option{1}) -- says
4842 whether the work area gets backed up; by default,
4843 @emph{it is not backed up.}
4844 When possible, use a working_area that doesn't need to be backed up,
4845 since performing a backup slows down operations.
4846 For example, the beginning of an SRAM block is likely to
4847 be used by most build systems, but the end is often unused.
4848
4849 @item @code{-work-area-size} @var{size} -- specify work are size,
4850 in bytes. The same size applies regardless of whether its physical
4851 or virtual address is being used.
4852
4853 @item @code{-work-area-phys} @var{address} -- set the work area
4854 base @var{address} to be used when no MMU is active.
4855
4856 @item @code{-work-area-virt} @var{address} -- set the work area
4857 base @var{address} to be used when an MMU is active.
4858 @emph{Do not specify a value for this except on targets with an MMU.}
4859 The value should normally correspond to a static mapping for the
4860 @code{-work-area-phys} address, set up by the current operating system.
4861
4862 @anchor{rtostype}
4863 @item @code{-rtos} @var{rtos_type} -- enable rtos support for target,
4864 @var{rtos_type} can be one of @option{auto}, @option{eCos},
4865 @option{ThreadX}, @option{FreeRTOS}, @option{linux}, @option{ChibiOS},
4866 @option{embKernel}, @option{mqx}, @option{uCOS-III}, @option{nuttx},
4867 @option{RIOT}, @option{Zephyr}
4868 @xref{gdbrtossupport,,RTOS Support}.
4869
4870 @item @code{-defer-examine} -- skip target examination at initial JTAG chain
4871 scan and after a reset. A manual call to arp_examine is required to
4872 access the target for debugging.
4873
4874 @item @code{-ap-num} @var{ap_number} -- set DAP access port for target,
4875 @var{ap_number} is the numeric index of the DAP AP the target is connected to.
4876 Use this option with systems where multiple, independent cores are connected
4877 to separate access ports of the same DAP.
4878
4879 @item @code{-cti} @var{cti_name} -- set Cross-Trigger Interface (CTI) connected
4880 to the target. Currently, only the @code{aarch64} target makes use of this option,
4881 where it is a mandatory configuration for the target run control.
4882 @xref{armcrosstrigger,,ARM Cross-Trigger Interface},
4883 for instruction on how to declare and control a CTI instance.
4884
4885 @anchor{gdbportoverride}
4886 @item @code{-gdb-port} @var{number} -- see command @command{gdb_port} for the
4887 possible values of the parameter @var{number}, which are not only numeric values.
4888 Use this option to override, for this target only, the global parameter set with
4889 command @command{gdb_port}.
4890 @xref{gdb_port,,command gdb_port}.
4891
4892 @item @code{-gdb-max-connections} @var{number} -- EXPERIMENTAL: set the maximum
4893 number of GDB connections that are allowed for the target. Default is 1.
4894 A negative value for @var{number} means unlimited connections.
4895 See @xref{gdbmeminspect,,Using GDB as a non-intrusive memory inspector}.
4896 @end itemize
4897 @end deffn
4898
4899 @section Other $target_name Commands
4900 @cindex object command
4901
4902 The Tcl/Tk language has the concept of object commands,
4903 and OpenOCD adopts that same model for targets.
4904
4905 A good Tk example is a on screen button.
4906 Once a button is created a button
4907 has a name (a path in Tk terms) and that name is useable as a first
4908 class command. For example in Tk, one can create a button and later
4909 configure it like this:
4910
4911 @example
4912 # Create
4913 button .foobar -background red -command @{ foo @}
4914 # Modify
4915 .foobar configure -foreground blue
4916 # Query
4917 set x [.foobar cget -background]
4918 # Report
4919 puts [format "The button is %s" $x]
4920 @end example
4921
4922 In OpenOCD's terms, the ``target'' is an object just like a Tcl/Tk
4923 button, and its object commands are invoked the same way.
4924
4925 @example
4926 str912.cpu mww 0x1234 0x42
4927 omap3530.cpu mww 0x5555 123
4928 @end example
4929
4930 The commands supported by OpenOCD target objects are:
4931
4932 @deffn {Command} {$target_name arp_examine} @option{allow-defer}
4933 @deffnx {Command} {$target_name arp_halt}
4934 @deffnx {Command} {$target_name arp_poll}
4935 @deffnx {Command} {$target_name arp_reset}
4936 @deffnx {Command} {$target_name arp_waitstate}
4937 Internal OpenOCD scripts (most notably @file{startup.tcl})
4938 use these to deal with specific reset cases.
4939 They are not otherwise documented here.
4940 @end deffn
4941
4942 @deffn {Command} {$target_name array2mem} arrayname width address count
4943 @deffnx {Command} {$target_name mem2array} arrayname width address count
4944 These provide an efficient script-oriented interface to memory.
4945 The @code{array2mem} primitive writes bytes, halfwords, words
4946 or double-words; while @code{mem2array} reads them.
4947 In both cases, the TCL side uses an array, and
4948 the target side uses raw memory.
4949
4950 The efficiency comes from enabling the use of
4951 bulk JTAG data transfer operations.
4952 The script orientation comes from working with data
4953 values that are packaged for use by TCL scripts;
4954 @command{mdw} type primitives only print data they retrieve,
4955 and neither store nor return those values.
4956
4957 @itemize
4958 @item @var{arrayname} ... is the name of an array variable
4959 @item @var{width} ... is 8/16/32/64 - indicating the memory access size
4960 @item @var{address} ... is the target memory address
4961 @item @var{count} ... is the number of elements to process
4962 @end itemize
4963 @end deffn
4964
4965 @deffn {Command} {$target_name cget} queryparm
4966 Each configuration parameter accepted by
4967 @command{$target_name configure}
4968 can be individually queried, to return its current value.
4969 The @var{queryparm} is a parameter name
4970 accepted by that command, such as @code{-work-area-phys}.
4971 There are a few special cases:
4972
4973 @itemize @bullet
4974 @item @code{-event} @var{event_name} -- returns the handler for the
4975 event named @var{event_name}.
4976 This is a special case because setting a handler requires
4977 two parameters.
4978 @item @code{-type} -- returns the target type.
4979 This is a special case because this is set using
4980 @command{target create} and can't be changed
4981 using @command{$target_name configure}.
4982 @end itemize
4983
4984 For example, if you wanted to summarize information about
4985 all the targets you might use something like this:
4986
4987 @example
4988 foreach name [target names] @{
4989 set y [$name cget -endian]
4990 set z [$name cget -type]
4991 puts [format "Chip %d is %s, Endian: %s, type: %s" \
4992 $x $name $y $z]
4993 @}
4994 @end example
4995 @end deffn
4996
4997 @anchor{targetcurstate}
4998 @deffn {Command} {$target_name curstate}
4999 Displays the current target state:
5000 @code{debug-running},
5001 @code{halted},
5002 @code{reset},
5003 @code{running}, or @code{unknown}.
5004 (Also, @pxref{eventpolling,,Event Polling}.)
5005 @end deffn
5006
5007 @deffn {Command} {$target_name eventlist}
5008 Displays a table listing all event handlers
5009 currently associated with this target.
5010 @xref{targetevents,,Target Events}.
5011 @end deffn
5012
5013 @deffn {Command} {$target_name invoke-event} event_name
5014 Invokes the handler for the event named @var{event_name}.
5015 (This is primarily intended for use by OpenOCD framework
5016 code, for example by the reset code in @file{startup.tcl}.)
5017 @end deffn
5018
5019 @deffn {Command} {$target_name mdd} [phys] addr [count]
5020 @deffnx {Command} {$target_name mdw} [phys] addr [count]
5021 @deffnx {Command} {$target_name mdh} [phys] addr [count]
5022 @deffnx {Command} {$target_name mdb} [phys] addr [count]
5023 Display contents of address @var{addr}, as
5024 64-bit doublewords (@command{mdd}),
5025 32-bit words (@command{mdw}), 16-bit halfwords (@command{mdh}),
5026 or 8-bit bytes (@command{mdb}).
5027 When the current target has an MMU which is present and active,
5028 @var{addr} is interpreted as a virtual address.
5029 Otherwise, or if the optional @var{phys} flag is specified,
5030 @var{addr} is interpreted as a physical address.
5031 If @var{count} is specified, displays that many units.
5032 (If you want to manipulate the data instead of displaying it,
5033 see the @code{mem2array} primitives.)
5034 @end deffn
5035
5036 @deffn {Command} {$target_name mwd} [phys] addr doubleword [count]
5037 @deffnx {Command} {$target_name mww} [phys] addr word [count]
5038 @deffnx {Command} {$target_name mwh} [phys] addr halfword [count]
5039 @deffnx {Command} {$target_name mwb} [phys] addr byte [count]
5040 Writes the specified @var{doubleword} (64 bits), @var{word} (32 bits),
5041 @var{halfword} (16 bits), or @var{byte} (8-bit) value,
5042 at the specified address @var{addr}.
5043 When the current target has an MMU which is present and active,
5044 @var{addr} is interpreted as a virtual address.
5045 Otherwise, or if the optional @var{phys} flag is specified,
5046 @var{addr} is interpreted as a physical address.
5047 If @var{count} is specified, fills that many units of consecutive address.
5048 @end deffn
5049
5050 @anchor{targetevents}
5051 @section Target Events
5052 @cindex target events
5053 @cindex events
5054 At various times, certain things can happen, or you want them to happen.
5055 For example:
5056 @itemize @bullet
5057 @item What should happen when GDB connects? Should your target reset?
5058 @item When GDB tries to flash the target, do you need to enable the flash via a special command?
5059 @item Is using SRST appropriate (and possible) on your system?
5060 Or instead of that, do you need to issue JTAG commands to trigger reset?
5061 SRST usually resets everything on the scan chain, which can be inappropriate.
5062 @item During reset, do you need to write to certain memory locations
5063 to set up system clocks or
5064 to reconfigure the SDRAM?
5065 How about configuring the watchdog timer, or other peripherals,
5066 to stop running while you hold the core stopped for debugging?
5067 @end itemize
5068
5069 All of the above items can be addressed by target event handlers.
5070 These are set up by @command{$target_name configure -event} or
5071 @command{target create ... -event}.
5072
5073 The programmer's model matches the @code{-command} option used in Tcl/Tk
5074 buttons and events. The two examples below act the same, but one creates
5075 and invokes a small procedure while the other inlines it.
5076
5077 @example
5078 proc my_init_proc @{ @} @{
5079 echo "Disabling watchdog..."
5080 mww 0xfffffd44 0x00008000
5081 @}
5082 mychip.cpu configure -event reset-init my_init_proc
5083 mychip.cpu configure -event reset-init @{
5084 echo "Disabling watchdog..."
5085 mww 0xfffffd44 0x00008000
5086 @}
5087 @end example
5088
5089 The following target events are defined:
5090
5091 @itemize @bullet
5092 @item @b{debug-halted}
5093 @* The target has halted for debug reasons (i.e.: breakpoint)
5094 @item @b{debug-resumed}
5095 @* The target has resumed (i.e.: GDB said run)
5096 @item @b{early-halted}
5097 @* Occurs early in the halt process
5098 @item @b{examine-start}
5099 @* Before target examine is called.
5100 @item @b{examine-end}
5101 @* After target examine is called with no errors.
5102 @item @b{examine-fail}
5103 @* After target examine fails.
5104 @item @b{gdb-attach}
5105 @* When GDB connects. Issued before any GDB communication with the target
5106 starts. GDB expects the target is halted during attachment.
5107 @xref{gdbmeminspect,,GDB as a non-intrusive memory inspector}, how to
5108 connect GDB to running target.
5109 The event can be also used to set up the target so it is possible to probe flash.
5110 Probing flash is necessary during GDB connect if you want to use
5111 @pxref{programmingusinggdb,,programming using GDB}.
5112 Another use of the flash memory map is for GDB to automatically choose
5113 hardware or software breakpoints depending on whether the breakpoint
5114 is in RAM or read only memory.
5115 Default is @code{halt}
5116 @item @b{gdb-detach}
5117 @* When GDB disconnects
5118 @item @b{gdb-end}
5119 @* When the target has halted and GDB is not doing anything (see early halt)
5120 @item @b{gdb-flash-erase-start}
5121 @* Before the GDB flash process tries to erase the flash (default is
5122 @code{reset init})
5123 @item @b{gdb-flash-erase-end}
5124 @* After the GDB flash process has finished erasing the flash
5125 @item @b{gdb-flash-write-start}
5126 @* Before GDB writes to the flash
5127 @item @b{gdb-flash-write-end}
5128 @* After GDB writes to the flash (default is @code{reset halt})
5129 @item @b{gdb-start}
5130 @* Before the target steps, GDB is trying to start/resume the target
5131 @item @b{halted}
5132 @* The target has halted
5133 @item @b{reset-assert-pre}
5134 @* Issued as part of @command{reset} processing
5135 after @command{reset-start} was triggered
5136 but before either SRST alone is asserted on the scan chain,
5137 or @code{reset-assert} is triggered.
5138 @item @b{reset-assert}
5139 @* Issued as part of @command{reset} processing
5140 after @command{reset-assert-pre} was triggered.
5141 When such a handler is present, cores which support this event will use
5142 it instead of asserting SRST.
5143 This support is essential for debugging with JTAG interfaces which
5144 don't include an SRST line (JTAG doesn't require SRST), and for
5145 selective reset on scan chains that have multiple targets.
5146 @item @b{reset-assert-post}
5147 @* Issued as part of @command{reset} processing
5148 after @code{reset-assert} has been triggered.
5149 or the target asserted SRST on the entire scan chain.
5150 @item @b{reset-deassert-pre}
5151 @* Issued as part of @command{reset} processing
5152 after @code{reset-assert-post} has been triggered.
5153 @item @b{reset-deassert-post}
5154 @* Issued as part of @command{reset} processing
5155 after @code{reset-deassert-pre} has been triggered
5156 and (if the target is using it) after SRST has been
5157 released on the scan chain.
5158 @item @b{reset-end}
5159 @* Issued as the final step in @command{reset} processing.
5160 @item @b{reset-init}
5161 @* Used by @b{reset init} command for board-specific initialization.
5162 This event fires after @emph{reset-deassert-post}.
5163
5164 This is where you would configure PLLs and clocking, set up DRAM so
5165 you can download programs that don't fit in on-chip SRAM, set up pin
5166 multiplexing, and so on.
5167 (You may be able to switch to a fast JTAG clock rate here, after
5168 the target clocks are fully set up.)
5169 @item @b{reset-start}
5170 @* Issued as the first step in @command{reset} processing
5171 before @command{reset-assert-pre} is called.
5172
5173 This is the most robust place to use @command{jtag_rclk}
5174 or @command{adapter speed} to switch to a low JTAG clock rate,
5175 when reset disables PLLs needed to use a fast clock.
5176 @item @b{resume-start}
5177 @* Before any target is resumed
5178 @item @b{resume-end}
5179 @* After all targets have resumed
5180 @item @b{resumed}
5181 @* Target has resumed
5182 @item @b{step-start}
5183 @* Before a target is single-stepped
5184 @item @b{step-end}
5185 @* After single-step has completed
5186 @item @b{trace-config}
5187 @* After target hardware trace configuration was changed
5188 @item @b{semihosting-user-cmd-0x100}
5189 @* The target made a semihosting call with user-defined operation number 0x100
5190 @item @b{semihosting-user-cmd-0x101}
5191 @* The target made a semihosting call with user-defined operation number 0x101
5192 @item @b{semihosting-user-cmd-0x102}
5193 @* The target made a semihosting call with user-defined operation number 0x102
5194 @item @b{semihosting-user-cmd-0x103}
5195 @* The target made a semihosting call with user-defined operation number 0x103
5196 @item @b{semihosting-user-cmd-0x104}
5197 @* The target made a semihosting call with user-defined operation number 0x104
5198 @item @b{semihosting-user-cmd-0x105}
5199 @* The target made a semihosting call with user-defined operation number 0x105
5200 @item @b{semihosting-user-cmd-0x106}
5201 @* The target made a semihosting call with user-defined operation number 0x106
5202 @item @b{semihosting-user-cmd-0x107}
5203 @* The target made a semihosting call with user-defined operation number 0x107
5204 @end itemize
5205
5206 @quotation Note
5207 OpenOCD events are not supposed to be preempt by another event, but this
5208 is not enforced in current code. Only the target event @b{resumed} is
5209 executed with polling disabled; this avoids polling to trigger the event
5210 @b{halted}, reversing the logical order of execution of their handlers.
5211 Future versions of OpenOCD will prevent the event preemption and will
5212 disable the schedule of polling during the event execution. Do not rely
5213 on polling in any event handler; this means, don't expect the status of
5214 a core to change during the execution of the handler. The event handler
5215 will have to enable polling or use @command{$target_name arp_poll} to
5216 check if the core has changed status.
5217 @end quotation
5218
5219 @node Flash Commands
5220 @chapter Flash Commands
5221
5222 OpenOCD has different commands for NOR and NAND flash;
5223 the ``flash'' command works with NOR flash, while
5224 the ``nand'' command works with NAND flash.
5225 This partially reflects different hardware technologies:
5226 NOR flash usually supports direct CPU instruction and data bus access,
5227 while data from a NAND flash must be copied to memory before it can be
5228 used. (SPI flash must also be copied to memory before use.)
5229 However, the documentation also uses ``flash'' as a generic term;
5230 for example, ``Put flash configuration in board-specific files''.
5231
5232 Flash Steps:
5233 @enumerate
5234 @item Configure via the command @command{flash bank}
5235 @* Do this in a board-specific configuration file,
5236 passing parameters as needed by the driver.
5237 @item Operate on the flash via @command{flash subcommand}
5238 @* Often commands to manipulate the flash are typed by a human, or run
5239 via a script in some automated way. Common tasks include writing a
5240 boot loader, operating system, or other data.
5241 @item GDB Flashing
5242 @* Flashing via GDB requires the flash be configured via ``flash
5243 bank'', and the GDB flash features be enabled.
5244 @xref{gdbconfiguration,,GDB Configuration}.
5245 @end enumerate
5246
5247 Many CPUs have the ability to ``boot'' from the first flash bank.
5248 This means that misprogramming that bank can ``brick'' a system,
5249 so that it can't boot.
5250 JTAG tools, like OpenOCD, are often then used to ``de-brick'' the
5251 board by (re)installing working boot firmware.
5252
5253 @anchor{norconfiguration}
5254 @section Flash Configuration Commands
5255 @cindex flash configuration
5256
5257 @deffn {Config Command} {flash bank} name driver base size chip_width bus_width target [driver_options]
5258 Configures a flash bank which provides persistent storage
5259 for addresses from @math{base} to @math{base + size - 1}.
5260 These banks will often be visible to GDB through the target's memory map.
5261 In some cases, configuring a flash bank will activate extra commands;
5262 see the driver-specific documentation.
5263
5264 @itemize @bullet
5265 @item @var{name} ... may be used to reference the flash bank
5266 in other flash commands. A number is also available.
5267 @item @var{driver} ... identifies the controller driver
5268 associated with the flash bank being declared.
5269 This is usually @code{cfi} for external flash, or else
5270 the name of a microcontroller with embedded flash memory.
5271 @xref{flashdriverlist,,Flash Driver List}.
5272 @item @var{base} ... Base address of the flash chip.
5273 @item @var{size} ... Size of the chip, in bytes.
5274 For some drivers, this value is detected from the hardware.
5275 @item @var{chip_width} ... Width of the flash chip, in bytes;
5276 ignored for most microcontroller drivers.
5277 @item @var{bus_width} ... Width of the data bus used to access the
5278 chip, in bytes; ignored for most microcontroller drivers.
5279 @item @var{target} ... Names the target used to issue
5280 commands to the flash controller.
5281 @comment Actually, it's currently a controller-specific parameter...
5282 @item @var{driver_options} ... drivers may support, or require,
5283 additional parameters. See the driver-specific documentation
5284 for more information.
5285 @end itemize
5286 @quotation Note
5287 This command is not available after OpenOCD initialization has completed.
5288 Use it in board specific configuration files, not interactively.
5289 @end quotation
5290 @end deffn
5291
5292 @comment less confusing would be: "flash list" (like "nand list")
5293 @deffn {Command} {flash banks}
5294 Prints a one-line summary of each device that was
5295 declared using @command{flash bank}, numbered from zero.
5296 Note that this is the @emph{plural} form;
5297 the @emph{singular} form is a very different command.
5298 @end deffn
5299
5300 @deffn {Command} {flash list}
5301 Retrieves a list of associative arrays for each device that was
5302 declared using @command{flash bank}, numbered from zero.
5303 This returned list can be manipulated easily from within scripts.
5304 @end deffn
5305
5306 @deffn {Command} {flash probe} num
5307 Identify the flash, or validate the parameters of the configured flash. Operation
5308 depends on the flash type.
5309 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5310 Most flash commands will implicitly @emph{autoprobe} the bank;
5311 flash drivers can distinguish between probing and autoprobing,
5312 but most don't bother.
5313 @end deffn
5314
5315 @section Preparing a Target before Flash Programming
5316
5317 The target device should be in well defined state before the flash programming
5318 begins.
5319
5320 @emph{Always issue} @command{reset init} before @ref{flashprogrammingcommands,,Flash Programming Commands}.
5321 Do not issue another @command{reset} or @command{reset halt} or @command{resume}
5322 until the programming session is finished.
5323
5324 If you use @ref{programmingusinggdb,,Programming using GDB},
5325 the target is prepared automatically in the event gdb-flash-erase-start
5326
5327 The jimtcl script @command{program} calls @command{reset init} explicitly.
5328
5329 @section Erasing, Reading, Writing to Flash
5330 @cindex flash erasing
5331 @cindex flash reading
5332 @cindex flash writing
5333 @cindex flash programming
5334 @anchor{flashprogrammingcommands}
5335
5336 One feature distinguishing NOR flash from NAND or serial flash technologies
5337 is that for read access, it acts exactly like any other addressable memory.
5338 This means you can use normal memory read commands like @command{mdw} or
5339 @command{dump_image} with it, with no special @command{flash} subcommands.
5340 @xref{memoryaccess,,Memory access}, and @ref{imageaccess,,Image access}.
5341
5342 Write access works differently. Flash memory normally needs to be erased
5343 before it's written. Erasing a sector turns all of its bits to ones, and
5344 writing can turn ones into zeroes. This is why there are special commands
5345 for interactive erasing and writing, and why GDB needs to know which parts
5346 of the address space hold NOR flash memory.
5347
5348 @quotation Note
5349 Most of these erase and write commands leverage the fact that NOR flash
5350 chips consume target address space. They implicitly refer to the current
5351 JTAG target, and map from an address in that target's address space
5352 back to a flash bank.
5353 @comment In May 2009, those mappings may fail if any bank associated
5354 @comment with that target doesn't successfully autoprobe ... bug worth fixing?
5355 A few commands use abstract addressing based on bank and sector numbers,
5356 and don't depend on searching the current target and its address space.
5357 Avoid confusing the two command models.
5358 @end quotation
5359
5360 Some flash chips implement software protection against accidental writes,
5361 since such buggy writes could in some cases ``brick'' a system.
5362 For such systems, erasing and writing may require sector protection to be
5363 disabled first.
5364 Examples include CFI flash such as ``Intel Advanced Bootblock flash'',
5365 and AT91SAM7 on-chip flash.
5366 @xref{flashprotect,,flash protect}.
5367
5368 @deffn {Command} {flash erase_sector} num first last
5369 Erase sectors in bank @var{num}, starting at sector @var{first}
5370 up to and including @var{last}.
5371 Sector numbering starts at 0.
5372 Providing a @var{last} sector of @option{last}
5373 specifies "to the end of the flash bank".
5374 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5375 @end deffn
5376
5377 @deffn {Command} {flash erase_address} [@option{pad}] [@option{unlock}] address length
5378 Erase sectors starting at @var{address} for @var{length} bytes.
5379 Unless @option{pad} is specified, @math{address} must begin a
5380 flash sector, and @math{address + length - 1} must end a sector.
5381 Specifying @option{pad} erases extra data at the beginning and/or
5382 end of the specified region, as needed to erase only full sectors.
5383 The flash bank to use is inferred from the @var{address}, and
5384 the specified length must stay within that bank.
5385 As a special case, when @var{length} is zero and @var{address} is
5386 the start of the bank, the whole flash is erased.
5387 If @option{unlock} is specified, then the flash is unprotected
5388 before erase starts.
5389 @end deffn
5390
5391 @deffn {Command} {flash filld} address double-word length
5392 @deffnx {Command} {flash fillw} address word length
5393 @deffnx {Command} {flash fillh} address halfword length
5394 @deffnx {Command} {flash fillb} address byte length
5395 Fills flash memory with the specified @var{double-word} (64 bits), @var{word} (32 bits),
5396 @var{halfword} (16 bits), or @var{byte} (8-bit) pattern,
5397 starting at @var{address} and continuing
5398 for @var{length} units (word/halfword/byte).
5399 No erasure is done before writing; when needed, that must be done
5400 before issuing this command.
5401 Writes are done in blocks of up to 1024 bytes, and each write is
5402 verified by reading back the data and comparing it to what was written.
5403 The flash bank to use is inferred from the @var{address} of
5404 each block, and the specified length must stay within that bank.
5405 @end deffn
5406 @comment no current checks for errors if fill blocks touch multiple banks!
5407
5408 @deffn {Command} {flash mdw} addr [count]
5409 @deffnx {Command} {flash mdh} addr [count]
5410 @deffnx {Command} {flash mdb} addr [count]
5411 Display contents of address @var{addr}, as
5412 32-bit words (@command{mdw}), 16-bit halfwords (@command{mdh}),
5413 or 8-bit bytes (@command{mdb}).
5414 If @var{count} is specified, displays that many units.
5415 Reads from flash using the flash driver, therefore it enables reading
5416 from a bank not mapped in target address space.
5417 The flash bank to use is inferred from the @var{address} of
5418 each block, and the specified length must stay within that bank.
5419 @end deffn
5420
5421 @deffn {Command} {flash write_bank} num filename [offset]
5422 Write the binary @file{filename} to flash bank @var{num},
5423 starting at @var{offset} bytes from the beginning of the bank. If @var{offset}
5424 is omitted, start at the beginning of the flash bank.
5425 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5426 @end deffn
5427
5428 @deffn {Command} {flash read_bank} num filename [offset [length]]
5429 Read @var{length} bytes from the flash bank @var{num} starting at @var{offset}
5430 and write the contents to the binary @file{filename}. If @var{offset} is
5431 omitted, start at the beginning of the flash bank. If @var{length} is omitted,
5432 read the remaining bytes from the flash bank.
5433 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5434 @end deffn
5435
5436 @deffn {Command} {flash verify_bank} num filename [offset]
5437 Compare the contents of the binary file @var{filename} with the contents of the
5438 flash bank @var{num} starting at @var{offset}. If @var{offset} is omitted,
5439 start at the beginning of the flash bank. Fail if the contents do not match.
5440 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5441 @end deffn
5442
5443 @deffn {Command} {flash write_image} [erase] [unlock] filename [offset] [type]
5444 Write the image @file{filename} to the current target's flash bank(s).
5445 Only loadable sections from the image are written.
5446 A relocation @var{offset} may be specified, in which case it is added
5447 to the base address for each section in the image.
5448 The file [@var{type}] can be specified
5449 explicitly as @option{bin} (binary), @option{ihex} (Intel hex),
5450 @option{elf} (ELF file), @option{s19} (Motorola s19).
5451 @option{mem}, or @option{builder}.
5452 The relevant flash sectors will be erased prior to programming
5453 if the @option{erase} parameter is given. If @option{unlock} is
5454 provided, then the flash banks are unlocked before erase and
5455 program. The flash bank to use is inferred from the address of
5456 each image section.
5457
5458 @quotation Warning
5459 Be careful using the @option{erase} flag when the flash is holding
5460 data you want to preserve.
5461 Portions of the flash outside those described in the image's
5462 sections might be erased with no notice.
5463 @itemize
5464 @item
5465 When a section of the image being written does not fill out all the
5466 sectors it uses, the unwritten parts of those sectors are necessarily
5467 also erased, because sectors can't be partially erased.
5468 @item
5469 Data stored in sector "holes" between image sections are also affected.
5470 For example, "@command{flash write_image erase ...}" of an image with
5471 one byte at the beginning of a flash bank and one byte at the end
5472 erases the entire bank -- not just the two sectors being written.
5473 @end itemize
5474 Also, when flash protection is important, you must re-apply it after
5475 it has been removed by the @option{unlock} flag.
5476 @end quotation
5477
5478 @end deffn
5479
5480 @deffn {Command} {flash verify_image} filename [offset] [type]
5481 Verify the image @file{filename} to the current target's flash bank(s).
5482 Parameters follow the description of 'flash write_image'.
5483 In contrast to the 'verify_image' command, for banks with specific
5484 verify method, that one is used instead of the usual target's read
5485 memory methods. This is necessary for flash banks not readable by
5486 ordinary memory reads.
5487 This command gives only an overall good/bad result for each bank, not
5488 addresses of individual failed bytes as it's intended only as quick
5489 check for successful programming.
5490 @end deffn
5491
5492 @section Other Flash commands
5493 @cindex flash protection
5494
5495 @deffn {Command} {flash erase_check} num
5496 Check erase state of sectors in flash bank @var{num},
5497 and display that status.
5498 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5499 @end deffn
5500
5501 @deffn {Command} {flash info} num [sectors]
5502 Print info about flash bank @var{num}, a list of protection blocks
5503 and their status. Use @option{sectors} to show a list of sectors instead.
5504
5505 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5506 This command will first query the hardware, it does not print cached
5507 and possibly stale information.
5508 @end deffn
5509
5510 @anchor{flashprotect}
5511 @deffn {Command} {flash protect} num first last (@option{on}|@option{off})
5512 Enable (@option{on}) or disable (@option{off}) protection of flash blocks
5513 in flash bank @var{num}, starting at protection block @var{first}
5514 and continuing up to and including @var{last}.
5515 Providing a @var{last} block of @option{last}
5516 specifies "to the end of the flash bank".
5517 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5518 The protection block is usually identical to a flash sector.
5519 Some devices may utilize a protection block distinct from flash sector.
5520 See @command{flash info} for a list of protection blocks.
5521 @end deffn
5522
5523 @deffn {Command} {flash padded_value} num value
5524 Sets the default value used for padding any image sections, This should
5525 normally match the flash bank erased value. If not specified by this
5526 command or the flash driver then it defaults to 0xff.
5527 @end deffn
5528
5529 @anchor{program}
5530 @deffn {Command} {program} filename [preverify] [verify] [reset] [exit] [offset]
5531 This is a helper script that simplifies using OpenOCD as a standalone
5532 programmer. The only required parameter is @option{filename}, the others are optional.
5533 @xref{Flash Programming}.
5534 @end deffn
5535
5536 @anchor{flashdriverlist}
5537 @section Flash Driver List
5538 As noted above, the @command{flash bank} command requires a driver name,
5539 and allows driver-specific options and behaviors.
5540 Some drivers also activate driver-specific commands.
5541
5542 @deffn {Flash Driver} {virtual}
5543 This is a special driver that maps a previously defined bank to another
5544 address. All bank settings will be copied from the master physical bank.
5545
5546 The @var{virtual} driver defines one mandatory parameters,
5547
5548 @itemize
5549 @item @var{master_bank} The bank that this virtual address refers to.
5550 @end itemize
5551
5552 So in the following example addresses 0xbfc00000 and 0x9fc00000 refer to
5553 the flash bank defined at address 0x1fc00000. Any command executed on
5554 the virtual banks is actually performed on the physical banks.
5555 @example
5556 flash bank $_FLASHNAME pic32mx 0x1fc00000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5557 flash bank vbank0 virtual 0xbfc00000 0 0 0 \
5558 $_TARGETNAME $_FLASHNAME
5559 flash bank vbank1 virtual 0x9fc00000 0 0 0 \
5560 $_TARGETNAME $_FLASHNAME
5561 @end example
5562 @end deffn
5563
5564 @subsection External Flash
5565
5566 @deffn {Flash Driver} {cfi}
5567 @cindex Common Flash Interface
5568 @cindex CFI
5569 The ``Common Flash Interface'' (CFI) is the main standard for
5570 external NOR flash chips, each of which connects to a
5571 specific external chip select on the CPU.
5572 Frequently the first such chip is used to boot the system.
5573 Your board's @code{reset-init} handler might need to
5574 configure additional chip selects using other commands (like: @command{mww} to
5575 configure a bus and its timings), or
5576 perhaps configure a GPIO pin that controls the ``write protect'' pin
5577 on the flash chip.
5578 The CFI driver can use a target-specific working area to significantly
5579 speed up operation.
5580
5581 The CFI driver can accept the following optional parameters, in any order:
5582
5583 @itemize
5584 @item @var{jedec_probe} ... is used to detect certain non-CFI flash ROMs,
5585 like AM29LV010 and similar types.
5586 @item @var{x16_as_x8} ... when a 16-bit flash is hooked up to an 8-bit bus.
5587 @item @var{bus_swap} ... when data bytes in a 16-bit flash needs to be swapped.
5588 @item @var{data_swap} ... when data bytes in a 16-bit flash needs to be
5589 swapped when writing data values (i.e. not CFI commands).
5590 @end itemize
5591
5592 To configure two adjacent banks of 16 MBytes each, both sixteen bits (two bytes)
5593 wide on a sixteen bit bus:
5594
5595 @example
5596 flash bank $_FLASHNAME cfi 0x00000000 0x01000000 2 2 $_TARGETNAME
5597 flash bank $_FLASHNAME cfi 0x01000000 0x01000000 2 2 $_TARGETNAME
5598 @end example
5599
5600 To configure one bank of 32 MBytes
5601 built from two sixteen bit (two byte) wide parts wired in parallel
5602 to create a thirty-two bit (four byte) bus with doubled throughput:
5603
5604 @example
5605 flash bank $_FLASHNAME cfi 0x00000000 0x02000000 2 4 $_TARGETNAME
5606 @end example
5607
5608 @c "cfi part_id" disabled
5609 @end deffn
5610
5611 @deffn {Flash Driver} {jtagspi}
5612 @cindex Generic JTAG2SPI driver
5613 @cindex SPI
5614 @cindex jtagspi
5615 @cindex bscan_spi
5616 Several FPGAs and CPLDs can retrieve their configuration (bitstream) from a
5617 SPI flash connected to them. To access this flash from the host, the device
5618 is first programmed with a special proxy bitstream that
5619 exposes the SPI flash on the device's JTAG interface. The flash can then be
5620 accessed through JTAG.
5621
5622 Since signaling between JTAG and SPI is compatible, all that is required for
5623 a proxy bitstream is to connect TDI-MOSI, TDO-MISO, TCK-CLK and activate
5624 the flash chip select when the JTAG state machine is in SHIFT-DR. Such
5625 a bitstream for several Xilinx FPGAs can be found in
5626 @file{contrib/loaders/flash/fpga/xilinx_bscan_spi.py}. It requires
5627 @uref{https://github.com/m-labs/migen, migen} and a Xilinx toolchain to build.
5628
5629 This flash bank driver requires a target on a JTAG tap and will access that
5630 tap directly. Since no support from the target is needed, the target can be a
5631 "testee" dummy. Since the target does not expose the flash memory
5632 mapping, target commands that would otherwise be expected to access the flash
5633 will not work. These include all @command{*_image} and
5634 @command{$target_name m*} commands as well as @command{program}. Equivalent
5635 functionality is available through the @command{flash write_bank},
5636 @command{flash read_bank}, and @command{flash verify_bank} commands.
5637
5638 According to device size, 1- to 4-byte addresses are sent. However, some
5639 flash chips additionally have to be switched to 4-byte addresses by an extra
5640 command, see below.
5641
5642 @itemize
5643 @item @var{ir} ... is loaded into the JTAG IR to map the flash as the JTAG DR.
5644 For the bitstreams generated from @file{xilinx_bscan_spi.py} this is the
5645 @var{USER1} instruction.
5646 @end itemize
5647
5648 @example
5649 target create $_TARGETNAME testee -chain-position $_CHIPNAME.fpga
5650 set _XILINX_USER1 0x02
5651 flash bank $_FLASHNAME spi 0x0 0 0 0 \
5652 $_TARGETNAME $_XILINX_USER1
5653 @end example
5654
5655 @deffn Command {jtagspi set} bank_id name total_size page_size read_cmd unused pprg_cmd mass_erase_cmd sector_size sector_erase_cmd
5656 Sets flash parameters: @var{name} human readable string, @var{total_size}
5657 size in bytes, @var{page_size} is write page size. @var{read_cmd} and @var{pprg_cmd}
5658 are commands for read and page program, respectively. @var{mass_erase_cmd},
5659 @var{sector_size} and @var{sector_erase_cmd} are optional.
5660 @example
5661 jtagspi set 0 w25q128 0x1000000 0x100 0x03 0 0x02 0xC7 0x10000 0xD8
5662 @end example
5663 @end deffn
5664
5665 @deffn Command {jtagspi cmd} bank_id resp_num cmd_byte ...
5666 Sends command @var{cmd_byte} and at most 20 following bytes and reads
5667 @var{resp_num} bytes afterwards. E.g. for 'Enter 4-byte address mode'
5668 @example
5669 jtagspi cmd 0 0 0xB7
5670 @end example
5671 @end deffn
5672
5673 @deffn Command {jtagspi always_4byte} bank_id [ on | off ]
5674 Some devices use 4-byte addresses for all commands except the legacy 0x03 read
5675 regardless of device size. This command controls the corresponding hack.
5676 @end deffn
5677 @end deffn
5678
5679 @deffn {Flash Driver} {xcf}
5680 @cindex Xilinx Platform flash driver
5681 @cindex xcf
5682 Xilinx FPGAs can be configured from specialized flash ICs named Platform Flash.
5683 It is (almost) regular NOR flash with erase sectors, program pages, etc. The
5684 only difference is special registers controlling its FPGA specific behavior.
5685 They must be properly configured for successful FPGA loading using
5686 additional @var{xcf} driver command:
5687
5688 @deffn {Command} {xcf ccb} <bank_id>
5689 command accepts additional parameters:
5690 @itemize
5691 @item @var{external|internal} ... selects clock source.
5692 @item @var{serial|parallel} ... selects serial or parallel data bus mode.
5693 @item @var{slave|master} ... selects slave of master mode for flash device.
5694 @item @var{40|20} ... selects clock frequency in MHz for internal clock
5695 in master mode.
5696 @end itemize
5697 @example
5698 xcf ccb 0 external parallel slave 40
5699 @end example
5700 All of them must be specified even if clock frequency is pointless
5701 in slave mode. If only bank id specified than command prints current
5702 CCB register value. Note: there is no need to write this register
5703 every time you erase/program data sectors because it stores in
5704 dedicated sector.
5705 @end deffn
5706
5707 @deffn {Command} {xcf configure} <bank_id>
5708 Initiates FPGA loading procedure. Useful if your board has no "configure"
5709 button.
5710 @example
5711 xcf configure 0
5712 @end example
5713 @end deffn
5714
5715 Additional driver notes:
5716 @itemize
5717 @item Only single revision supported.
5718 @item Driver automatically detects need of bit reverse, but
5719 only "bin" (raw binary, do not confuse it with "bit") and "mcs"
5720 (Intel hex) file types supported.
5721 @item For additional info check xapp972.pdf and ug380.pdf.
5722 @end itemize
5723 @end deffn
5724
5725 @deffn {Flash Driver} {lpcspifi}
5726 @cindex NXP SPI Flash Interface
5727 @cindex SPIFI
5728 @cindex lpcspifi
5729 NXP's LPC43xx and LPC18xx families include a proprietary SPI
5730 Flash Interface (SPIFI) peripheral that can drive and provide
5731 memory mapped access to external SPI flash devices.
5732
5733 The lpcspifi driver initializes this interface and provides
5734 program and erase functionality for these serial flash devices.
5735 Use of this driver @b{requires} a working area of at least 1kB
5736 to be configured on the target device; more than this will
5737 significantly reduce flash programming times.
5738
5739 The setup command only requires the @var{base} parameter. All
5740 other parameters are ignored, and the flash size and layout
5741 are configured by the driver.
5742
5743 @example
5744 flash bank $_FLASHNAME lpcspifi 0x14000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5745 @end example
5746
5747 @end deffn
5748
5749 @deffn {Flash Driver} {stmsmi}
5750 @cindex STMicroelectronics Serial Memory Interface
5751 @cindex SMI
5752 @cindex stmsmi
5753 Some devices from STMicroelectronics (e.g. STR75x MCU family,
5754 SPEAr MPU family) include a proprietary
5755 ``Serial Memory Interface'' (SMI) controller able to drive external
5756 SPI flash devices.
5757 Depending on specific device and board configuration, up to 4 external
5758 flash devices can be connected.
5759
5760 SMI makes the flash content directly accessible in the CPU address
5761 space; each external device is mapped in a memory bank.
5762 CPU can directly read data, execute code and boot from SMI banks.
5763 Normal OpenOCD commands like @command{mdw} can be used to display
5764 the flash content.
5765
5766 The setup command only requires the @var{base} parameter in order
5767 to identify the memory bank.
5768 All other parameters are ignored. Additional information, like
5769 flash size, are detected automatically.
5770
5771 @example
5772 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stmsmi 0xf8000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5773 @end example
5774
5775 @end deffn
5776
5777 @deffn {Flash Driver} {stmqspi}
5778 @cindex STMicroelectronics QuadSPI/OctoSPI Interface
5779 @cindex QuadSPI
5780 @cindex OctoSPI
5781 @cindex stmqspi
5782 Some devices from STMicroelectronics include a proprietary ``QuadSPI Interface''
5783 (e.g. STM32F4, STM32F7, STM32L4) or ``OctoSPI Interface'' (e.g. STM32L4+)
5784 controller able to drive one or even two (dual mode) external SPI flash devices.
5785 The OctoSPI is a superset of QuadSPI, its presence is detected automatically.
5786 Currently only the regular command mode is supported, whereas the HyperFlash
5787 mode is not.
5788
5789 QuadSPI/OctoSPI makes the flash contents directly accessible in the CPU address
5790 space; in case of dual mode both devices must be of the same type and are
5791 mapped in the same memory bank (even and odd addresses interleaved).
5792 CPU can directly read data, execute code (but not boot) from QuadSPI bank.
5793
5794 The 'flash bank' command only requires the @var{base} parameter and the extra
5795 parameter @var{io_base} in order to identify the memory bank. Both are fixed
5796 by hardware, see datasheet or RM. All other parameters are ignored.
5797
5798 The controller must be initialized after each reset and properly configured
5799 for memory-mapped read operation for the particular flash chip(s), for the full
5800 list of available register settings cf. the controller's RM. This setup is quite
5801 board specific (that's why booting from this memory is not possible). The
5802 flash driver infers all parameters from current controller register values when
5803 'flash probe @var{bank_id}' is executed.
5804
5805 Normal OpenOCD commands like @command{mdw} can be used to display the flash content,
5806 but only after proper controller initialization as described above. However,
5807 due to a silicon bug in some devices, attempting to access the very last word
5808 should be avoided.
5809
5810 It is possible to use two (even different) flash chips alternatingly, if individual
5811 bank chip selects are available. For some package variants, this is not the case
5812 due to limited pin count. To switch from one to another, adjust FSEL bit accordingly
5813 and re-issue 'flash probe bank_id'. Note that the bank base address will @emph{not}
5814 change, so the address spaces of both devices will overlap. In dual flash mode
5815 both chips must be identical regarding size and most other properties.
5816
5817 Block or sector protection internal to the flash chip is not handled by this
5818 driver at all, but can be dealt with manually by the 'cmd' command, see below.
5819 The sector protection via 'flash protect' command etc. is completely internal to
5820 openocd, intended only to prevent accidental erase or overwrite and it does not
5821 persist across openocd invocations.
5822
5823 OpenOCD contains a hardcoded list of flash devices with their properties,
5824 these are auto-detected. If a device is not included in this list, SFDP discovery
5825 is attempted. If this fails or gives inappropriate results, manual setting is
5826 required (see 'set' command).
5827
5828 @example
5829 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stmqspi 0x90000000 0 0 0 \
5830 $_TARGETNAME 0xA0001000
5831 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stmqspi 0x70000000 0 0 0 \
5832 $_TARGETNAME 0xA0001400
5833 @end example
5834
5835 There are three specific commands
5836 @deffn {Command} {stmqspi mass_erase} bank_id
5837 Clears sector protections and performs a mass erase. Works only if there is no
5838 chip specific write protection engaged.
5839 @end deffn
5840
5841 @deffn {Command} {stmqspi set} bank_id name total_size page_size read_cmd fread_cmd pprg_cmd mass_erase_cmd sector_size sector_erase_cmd
5842 Set flash parameters: @var{name} human readable string, @var{total_size} size
5843 in bytes, @var{page_size} is write page size. @var{read_cmd}, @var{fread_cmd} and @var{pprg_cmd}
5844 are commands for reading and page programming. @var{fread_cmd} is used in DPI and QPI modes,
5845 @var{read_cmd} in normal SPI (single line) mode. @var{mass_erase_cmd}, @var{sector_size}
5846 and @var{sector_erase_cmd} are optional.
5847
5848 This command is required if chip id is not hardcoded yet and e.g. for EEPROMs or FRAMs
5849 which don't support an id command.
5850
5851 In dual mode parameters of both chips are set identically. The parameters refer to
5852 a single chip, so the whole bank gets twice the specified capacity etc.
5853 @end deffn
5854
5855 @deffn {Command} {stmqspi cmd} bank_id resp_num cmd_byte ...
5856 If @var{resp_num} is zero, sends command @var{cmd_byte} and following data
5857 bytes. In dual mode command byte is sent to @emph{both} chips but data bytes are
5858 sent @emph{alternatingly} to chip 1 and 2, first to flash 1, second to flash 2, etc.,
5859 i.e. the total number of bytes (including cmd_byte) must be odd.
5860
5861 If @var{resp_num} is not zero, cmd and at most four following data bytes are
5862 sent, in dual mode @emph{simultaneously} to both chips. Then @var{resp_num} bytes
5863 are read interleaved from both chips starting with chip 1. In this case
5864 @var{resp_num} must be even.
5865
5866 Note the hardware dictated subtle difference of those two cases in dual-flash mode.
5867
5868 To check basic communication settings, issue
5869 @example
5870 stmqspi cmd bank_id 0 0x04; stmqspi cmd bank_id 1 0x05
5871 stmqspi cmd bank_id 0 0x06; stmqspi cmd bank_id 1 0x05
5872 @end example
5873 for single flash mode or
5874 @example
5875 stmqspi cmd bank_id 0 0x04; stmqspi cmd bank_id 2 0x05
5876 stmqspi cmd bank_id 0 0x06; stmqspi cmd bank_id 2 0x05
5877 @end example
5878 for dual flash mode. This should return the status register contents.
5879
5880 In 8-line mode, @var{cmd_byte} is sent twice - first time as given, second time
5881 complemented. Additionally, in 8-line mode only, some commands (e.g. Read Status)
5882 need a dummy address, e.g.
5883 @example
5884 stmqspi cmd bank_id 1 0x05 0x00 0x00 0x00 0x00
5885 @end example
5886 should return the status register contents.
5887
5888 @end deffn
5889
5890 @end deffn
5891
5892 @deffn {Flash Driver} {mrvlqspi}
5893 This driver supports QSPI flash controller of Marvell's Wireless
5894 Microcontroller platform.
5895
5896 The flash size is autodetected based on the table of known JEDEC IDs
5897 hardcoded in the OpenOCD sources.
5898
5899 @example
5900 flash bank $_FLASHNAME mrvlqspi 0x0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME 0x46010000
5901 @end example
5902
5903 @end deffn
5904
5905 @deffn {Flash Driver} {ath79}
5906 @cindex Atheros ath79 SPI driver
5907 @cindex ath79
5908 Members of ATH79 SoC family from Atheros include a SPI interface with 3
5909 chip selects.
5910 On reset a SPI flash connected to the first chip select (CS0) is made
5911 directly read-accessible in the CPU address space (up to 16MBytes)
5912 and is usually used to store the bootloader and operating system.
5913 Normal OpenOCD commands like @command{mdw} can be used to display
5914 the flash content while it is in memory-mapped mode (only the first
5915 4MBytes are accessible without additional configuration on reset).
5916
5917 The setup command only requires the @var{base} parameter in order
5918 to identify the memory bank. The actual value for the base address
5919 is not otherwise used by the driver. However the mapping is passed
5920 to gdb. Thus for the memory mapped flash (chipselect CS0) the base
5921 address should be the actual memory mapped base address. For unmapped
5922 chipselects (CS1 and CS2) care should be taken to use a base address
5923 that does not overlap with real memory regions.
5924 Additional information, like flash size, are detected automatically.
5925 An optional additional parameter sets the chipselect for the bank,
5926 with the default CS0.
5927 CS1 and CS2 require additional GPIO setup before they can be used
5928 since the alternate function must be enabled on the GPIO pin
5929 CS1/CS2 is routed to on the given SoC.
5930
5931 @example
5932 flash bank $_FLASHNAME ath79 0xbf000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5933
5934 # When using multiple chipselects the base should be different
5935 # for each, otherwise the write_image command is not able to
5936 # distinguish the banks.
5937 flash bank flash0 ath79 0xbf000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME cs0
5938 flash bank flash1 ath79 0x10000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME cs1
5939 flash bank flash2 ath79 0x20000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME cs2
5940 @end example
5941
5942 @end deffn
5943
5944 @deffn {Flash Driver} {fespi}
5945 @cindex Freedom E SPI
5946 @cindex fespi
5947
5948 SiFive's Freedom E SPI controller, used in HiFive and other boards.
5949
5950 @example
5951 flash bank $_FLASHNAME fespi 0x20000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5952 @end example
5953 @end deffn
5954
5955 @subsection Internal Flash (Microcontrollers)
5956
5957 @deffn {Flash Driver} {aduc702x}
5958 The ADUC702x analog microcontrollers from Analog Devices
5959 include internal flash and use ARM7TDMI cores.
5960 The aduc702x flash driver works with models ADUC7019 through ADUC7028.
5961 The setup command only requires the @var{target} argument
5962 since all devices in this family have the same memory layout.
5963
5964 @example
5965 flash bank $_FLASHNAME aduc702x 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5966 @end example
5967 @end deffn
5968
5969 @deffn {Flash Driver} {ambiqmicro}
5970 @cindex ambiqmicro
5971 @cindex apollo
5972 All members of the Apollo microcontroller family from
5973 Ambiq Micro include internal flash and use ARM's Cortex-M4 core.
5974 The host connects over USB to an FTDI interface that communicates
5975 with the target using SWD.
5976
5977 The @var{ambiqmicro} driver reads the Chip Information Register detect
5978 the device class of the MCU.
5979 The Flash and SRAM sizes directly follow device class, and are used
5980 to set up the flash banks.
5981 If this fails, the driver will use default values set to the minimum
5982 sizes of an Apollo chip.
5983
5984 All Apollo chips have two flash banks of the same size.
5985 In all cases the first flash bank starts at location 0,
5986 and the second bank starts after the first.
5987
5988 @example
5989 # Flash bank 0
5990 flash bank $_FLASHNAME ambiqmicro 0 0x00040000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5991 # Flash bank 1 - same size as bank0, starts after bank 0.
5992 flash bank $_FLASHNAME ambiqmicro 0x00040000 0x00040000 0 0 \
5993 $_TARGETNAME
5994 @end example
5995
5996 Flash is programmed using custom entry points into the bootloader.
5997 This is the only way to program the flash as no flash control registers
5998 are available to the user.
5999
6000 The @var{ambiqmicro} driver adds some additional commands:
6001
6002 @deffn {Command} {ambiqmicro mass_erase} <bank>
6003 Erase entire bank.
6004 @end deffn
6005 @deffn {Command} {ambiqmicro page_erase} <bank> <first> <last>
6006 Erase device pages.
6007 @end deffn
6008 @deffn {Command} {ambiqmicro program_otp} <bank> <offset> <count>
6009 Program OTP is a one time operation to create write protected flash.
6010 The user writes sectors to SRAM starting at 0x10000010.
6011 Program OTP will write these sectors from SRAM to flash, and write protect
6012 the flash.
6013 @end deffn
6014 @end deffn
6015
6016 @anchor{at91samd}
6017 @deffn {Flash Driver} {at91samd}
6018 @cindex at91samd
6019 All members of the ATSAM D2x, D1x, D0x, ATSAMR, ATSAML and ATSAMC microcontroller
6020 families from Atmel include internal flash and use ARM's Cortex-M0+ core.
6021
6022 Do not use for ATSAM D51 and E5x: use @xref{atsame5}.
6023
6024 The devices have one flash bank:
6025
6026 @example
6027 flash bank $_FLASHNAME at91samd 0x00000000 0 1 1 $_TARGETNAME
6028 @end example
6029
6030 @deffn {Command} {at91samd chip-erase}
6031 Issues a complete Flash erase via the Device Service Unit (DSU). This can be
6032 used to erase a chip back to its factory state and does not require the
6033 processor to be halted.
6034 @end deffn
6035
6036 @deffn {Command} {at91samd set-security}
6037 Secures the Flash via the Set Security Bit (SSB) command. This prevents access
6038 to the Flash and can only be undone by using the chip-erase command which
6039 erases the Flash contents and turns off the security bit. Warning: at this
6040 time, openocd will not be able to communicate with a secured chip and it is
6041 therefore not possible to chip-erase it without using another tool.
6042
6043 @example
6044 at91samd set-security enable
6045 @end example
6046 @end deffn
6047
6048 @deffn {Command} {at91samd eeprom}
6049 Shows or sets the EEPROM emulation size configuration, stored in the User Row
6050 of the Flash. When setting, the EEPROM size must be specified in bytes and it
6051 must be one of the permitted sizes according to the datasheet. Settings are
6052 written immediately but only take effect on MCU reset. EEPROM emulation
6053 requires additional firmware support and the minimum EEPROM size may not be
6054 the same as the minimum that the hardware supports. Set the EEPROM size to 0
6055 in order to disable this feature.
6056
6057 @example
6058 at91samd eeprom
6059 at91samd eeprom 1024
6060 @end example
6061 @end deffn
6062
6063 @deffn {Command} {at91samd bootloader}
6064 Shows or sets the bootloader size configuration, stored in the User Row of the
6065 Flash. This is called the BOOTPROT region. When setting, the bootloader size
6066 must be specified in bytes and it must be one of the permitted sizes according
6067 to the datasheet. Settings are written immediately but only take effect on
6068 MCU reset. Setting the bootloader size to 0 disables bootloader protection.
6069
6070 @example
6071 at91samd bootloader
6072 at91samd bootloader 16384
6073 @end example
6074 @end deffn
6075
6076 @deffn {Command} {at91samd dsu_reset_deassert}
6077 This command releases internal reset held by DSU
6078 and prepares reset vector catch in case of reset halt.
6079 Command is used internally in event reset-deassert-post.
6080 @end deffn
6081
6082 @deffn {Command} {at91samd nvmuserrow}
6083 Writes or reads the entire 64 bit wide NVM user row register which is located at
6084 0x804000. This register includes various fuses lock-bits and factory calibration
6085 data. Reading the register is done by invoking this command without any
6086 arguments. Writing is possible by giving 1 or 2 hex values. The first argument
6087 is the register value to be written and the second one is an optional changemask.
6088 Every bit which value in changemask is 0 will stay unchanged. The lock- and
6089 reserved-bits are masked out and cannot be changed.
6090
6091 @example
6092 # Read user row
6093 >at91samd nvmuserrow
6094 NVMUSERROW: 0xFFFFFC5DD8E0C788
6095 # Write 0xFFFFFC5DD8E0C788 to user row
6096 >at91samd nvmuserrow 0xFFFFFC5DD8E0C788
6097 # Write 0x12300 to user row but leave other bits and low
6098 # byte unchanged
6099 >at91samd nvmuserrow 0x12345 0xFFF00
6100 @end example
6101 @end deffn
6102
6103 @end deffn
6104
6105 @anchor{at91sam3}
6106 @deffn {Flash Driver} {at91sam3}
6107 @cindex at91sam3
6108 All members of the AT91SAM3 microcontroller family from
6109 Atmel include internal flash and use ARM's Cortex-M3 core. The driver
6110 currently (6/22/09) recognizes the AT91SAM3U[1/2/4][C/E] chips. Note
6111 that the driver was orginaly developed and tested using the
6112 AT91SAM3U4E, using a SAM3U-EK eval board. Support for other chips in
6113 the family was cribbed from the data sheet. @emph{Note to future
6114 readers/updaters: Please remove this worrisome comment after other
6115 chips are confirmed.}
6116
6117 The AT91SAM3U4[E/C] (256K) chips have two flash banks; most other chips
6118 have one flash bank. In all cases the flash banks are at
6119 the following fixed locations:
6120
6121 @example
6122 # Flash bank 0 - all chips
6123 flash bank $_FLASHNAME at91sam3 0x00080000 0 1 1 $_TARGETNAME
6124 # Flash bank 1 - only 256K chips
6125 flash bank $_FLASHNAME at91sam3 0x00100000 0 1 1 $_TARGETNAME
6126 @end example
6127
6128 Internally, the AT91SAM3 flash memory is organized as follows.
6129 Unlike the AT91SAM7 chips, these are not used as parameters
6130 to the @command{flash bank} command:
6131
6132 @itemize
6133 @item @emph{N-Banks:} 256K chips have 2 banks, others have 1 bank.
6134 @item @emph{Bank Size:} 128K/64K Per flash bank
6135 @item @emph{Sectors:} 16 or 8 per bank
6136 @item @emph{SectorSize:} 8K Per Sector
6137 @item @emph{PageSize:} 256 bytes per page. Note that OpenOCD operates on 'sector' sizes, not page sizes.
6138 @end itemize
6139
6140 The AT91SAM3 driver adds some additional commands:
6141
6142 @deffn {Command} {at91sam3 gpnvm}
6143 @deffnx {Command} {at91sam3 gpnvm clear} number
6144 @deffnx {Command} {at91sam3 gpnvm set} number
6145 @deffnx {Command} {at91sam3 gpnvm show} [@option{all}|number]
6146 With no parameters, @command{show} or @command{show all},
6147 shows the status of all GPNVM bits.
6148 With @command{show} @var{number}, displays that bit.
6149
6150 With @command{set} @var{number} or @command{clear} @var{number},
6151 modifies that GPNVM bit.
6152 @end deffn
6153
6154 @deffn {Command} {at91sam3 info}
6155 This command attempts to display information about the AT91SAM3
6156 chip. @emph{First} it read the @code{CHIPID_CIDR} [address 0x400e0740, see
6157 Section 28.2.1, page 505 of the AT91SAM3U 29/may/2009 datasheet,
6158 document id: doc6430A] and decodes the values. @emph{Second} it reads the
6159 various clock configuration registers and attempts to display how it
6160 believes the chip is configured. By default, the SLOWCLK is assumed to
6161 be 32768 Hz, see the command @command{at91sam3 slowclk}.
6162 @end deffn
6163
6164 @deffn {Command} {at91sam3 slowclk} [value]
6165 This command shows/sets the slow clock frequency used in the
6166 @command{at91sam3 info} command calculations above.
6167 @end deffn
6168 @end deffn
6169
6170 @deffn {Flash Driver} {at91sam4}
6171 @cindex at91sam4
6172 All members of the AT91SAM4 microcontroller family from
6173 Atmel include internal flash and use ARM's Cortex-M4 core.
6174 This driver uses the same command names/syntax as @xref{at91sam3}.
6175 @end deffn
6176
6177 @deffn {Flash Driver} {at91sam4l}
6178 @cindex at91sam4l
6179 All members of the AT91SAM4L microcontroller family from
6180 Atmel include internal flash and use ARM's Cortex-M4 core.
6181 This driver uses the same command names/syntax as @xref{at91sam3}.
6182
6183 The AT91SAM4L driver adds some additional commands:
6184 @deffn {Command} {at91sam4l smap_reset_deassert}
6185 This command releases internal reset held by SMAP
6186 and prepares reset vector catch in case of reset halt.
6187 Command is used internally in event reset-deassert-post.
6188 @end deffn
6189 @end deffn
6190
6191 @anchor{atsame5}
6192 @deffn {Flash Driver} {atsame5}
6193 @cindex atsame5
6194 All members of the SAM E54, E53, E51 and D51 microcontroller
6195 families from Microchip (former Atmel) include internal flash
6196 and use ARM's Cortex-M4 core.
6197
6198 The devices have two ECC flash banks with a swapping feature.
6199 This driver handles both banks together as it were one.
6200 Bank swapping is not supported yet.
6201
6202 @example
6203 flash bank $_FLASHNAME atsame5 0x00000000 0 1 1 $_TARGETNAME
6204 @end example
6205
6206 @deffn {Command} {atsame5 bootloader}
6207 Shows or sets the bootloader size configuration, stored in the User Page of the
6208 Flash. This is called the BOOTPROT region. When setting, the bootloader size
6209 must be specified in bytes. The nearest bigger protection size is used.
6210 Settings are written immediately but only take effect on MCU reset.
6211 Setting the bootloader size to 0 disables bootloader protection.
6212
6213 @example
6214 atsame5 bootloader
6215 atsame5 bootloader 16384
6216 @end example
6217 @end deffn
6218
6219 @deffn {Command} {atsame5 chip-erase}
6220 Issues a complete Flash erase via the Device Service Unit (DSU). This can be
6221 used to erase a chip back to its factory state and does not require the
6222 processor to be halted.
6223 @end deffn
6224
6225 @deffn {Command} {atsame5 dsu_reset_deassert}
6226 This command releases internal reset held by DSU
6227 and prepares reset vector catch in case of reset halt.
6228 Command is used internally in event reset-deassert-post.
6229 @end deffn
6230
6231 @deffn {Command} {atsame5 userpage}
6232 Writes or reads the first 64 bits of NVM User Page which is located at
6233 0x804000. This field includes various fuses.
6234 Reading is done by invoking this command without any arguments.
6235 Writing is possible by giving 1 or 2 hex values. The first argument
6236 is the value to be written and the second one is an optional bit mask
6237 (a zero bit in the mask means the bit stays unchanged).
6238 The reserved fields are always masked out and cannot be changed.
6239
6240 @example
6241 # Read
6242 >atsame5 userpage
6243 USER PAGE: 0xAEECFF80FE9A9239
6244 # Write
6245 >atsame5 userpage 0xAEECFF80FE9A9239
6246 # Write 2 to SEESBLK and 4 to SEEPSZ fields but leave other
6247 # bits unchanged (setup SmartEEPROM of virtual size 8192
6248 # bytes)
6249 >atsame5 userpage 0x4200000000 0x7f00000000
6250 @end example
6251 @end deffn
6252
6253 @end deffn
6254
6255 @deffn {Flash Driver} {atsamv}
6256 @cindex atsamv
6257 All members of the ATSAMV7x, ATSAMS70, and ATSAME70 families from
6258 Atmel include internal flash and use ARM's Cortex-M7 core.
6259 This driver uses the same command names/syntax as @xref{at91sam3}.
6260
6261 @example
6262 flash bank $_FLASHNAME atsamv 0x00400000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6263 @end example
6264
6265 @deffn {Command} {atsamv gpnvm} [@option{show} [@option{all}|number]]
6266 @deffnx {Command} {atsamv gpnvm} (@option{clr}|@option{set}) number
6267 With no parameters, @option{show} or @option{show all},
6268 shows the status of all GPNVM bits.
6269 With @option{show} @var{number}, displays that bit.
6270
6271 With @option{set} @var{number} or @option{clear} @var{number},
6272 modifies that GPNVM bit.
6273 @end deffn
6274
6275 @end deffn
6276
6277 @deffn {Flash Driver} {at91sam7}
6278 All members of the AT91SAM7 microcontroller family from Atmel include
6279 internal flash and use ARM7TDMI cores. The driver automatically
6280 recognizes a number of these chips using the chip identification
6281 register, and autoconfigures itself.
6282
6283 @example
6284 flash bank $_FLASHNAME at91sam7 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6285 @end example
6286
6287 For chips which are not recognized by the controller driver, you must
6288 provide additional parameters in the following order:
6289
6290 @itemize
6291 @item @var{chip_model} ... label used with @command{flash info}
6292 @item @var{banks}
6293 @item @var{sectors_per_bank}
6294 @item @var{pages_per_sector}
6295 @item @var{pages_size}
6296 @item @var{num_nvm_bits}
6297 @item @var{freq_khz} ... required if an external clock is provided,
6298 optional (but recommended) when the oscillator frequency is known
6299 @end itemize
6300
6301 It is recommended that you provide zeroes for all of those values
6302 except the clock frequency, so that everything except that frequency
6303 will be autoconfigured.
6304 Knowing the frequency helps ensure correct timings for flash access.
6305
6306 The flash controller handles erases automatically on a page (128/256 byte)
6307 basis, so explicit erase commands are not necessary for flash programming.
6308 However, there is an ``EraseAll`` command that can erase an entire flash
6309 plane (of up to 256KB), and it will be used automatically when you issue
6310 @command{flash erase_sector} or @command{flash erase_address} commands.
6311
6312 @deffn {Command} {at91sam7 gpnvm} bitnum (@option{set}|@option{clear})
6313 Set or clear a ``General Purpose Non-Volatile Memory'' (GPNVM)
6314 bit for the processor. Each processor has a number of such bits,
6315 used for controlling features such as brownout detection (so they
6316 are not truly general purpose).
6317 @quotation Note
6318 This assumes that the first flash bank (number 0) is associated with
6319 the appropriate at91sam7 target.
6320 @end quotation
6321 @end deffn
6322 @end deffn
6323
6324 @deffn {Flash Driver} {avr}
6325 The AVR 8-bit microcontrollers from Atmel integrate flash memory.
6326 @emph{The current implementation is incomplete.}
6327 @comment - defines mass_erase ... pointless given flash_erase_address
6328 @end deffn
6329
6330 @deffn {Flash Driver} {bluenrg-x}
6331 STMicroelectronics BlueNRG-1, BlueNRG-2 and BlueNRG-LP Bluetooth low energy wireless system-on-chip. They include ARM Cortex-M0/M0+ core and internal flash memory.
6332 The driver automatically recognizes these chips using
6333 the chip identification registers, and autoconfigures itself.
6334
6335 @example
6336 flash bank $_FLASHNAME bluenrg-x 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6337 @end example
6338
6339 Note that when users ask to erase all the sectors of the flash, a mass erase command is used which is faster than erasing
6340 each single sector one by one.
6341
6342 @example
6343 flash erase_sector 0 0 last # It will perform a mass erase
6344 @end example
6345
6346 Triggering a mass erase is also useful when users want to disable readout protection.
6347 @end deffn
6348
6349 @deffn {Flash Driver} {cc26xx}
6350 All versions of the SimpleLink CC13xx and CC26xx microcontrollers from Texas
6351 Instruments include internal flash. The cc26xx flash driver supports both the
6352 CC13xx and CC26xx family of devices. The driver automatically recognizes the
6353 specific version's flash parameters and autoconfigures itself. The flash bank
6354 starts at address 0.
6355
6356 @example
6357 flash bank $_FLASHNAME cc26xx 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6358 @end example
6359 @end deffn
6360
6361 @deffn {Flash Driver} {cc3220sf}
6362 The CC3220SF version of the SimpleLink CC32xx microcontrollers from Texas
6363 Instruments includes 1MB of internal flash. The cc3220sf flash driver only
6364 supports the internal flash. The serial flash on SimpleLink boards is
6365 programmed via the bootloader over a UART connection. Security features of
6366 the CC3220SF may erase the internal flash during power on reset. Refer to
6367 documentation at @url{www.ti.com/cc3220sf} for details on security features
6368 and programming the serial flash.
6369
6370 @example
6371 flash bank $_FLASHNAME cc3220sf 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6372 @end example
6373 @end deffn
6374
6375 @deffn {Flash Driver} {efm32}
6376 All members of the EFM32/EFR32 microcontroller family from Energy Micro (now Silicon Labs)
6377 include internal flash and use Arm Cortex-M3 or Cortex-M4 cores. The driver automatically
6378 recognizes a number of these chips using the chip identification register, and
6379 autoconfigures itself.
6380 @example
6381 flash bank $_FLASHNAME efm32 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6382 @end example
6383 It supports writing to the user data page, as well as the portion of the lockbits page
6384 past 512 bytes on chips with larger page sizes. The latter is used by the SiLabs
6385 bootloader/AppLoader system for encryption keys. Setting protection on these pages is
6386 currently not supported.
6387 @example
6388 flash bank userdata.flash efm32 0x0FE00000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6389 flash bank lockbits.flash efm32 0x0FE04000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6390 @end example
6391
6392 A special feature of efm32 controllers is that it is possible to completely disable the
6393 debug interface by writing the correct values to the 'Debug Lock Word'. OpenOCD supports
6394 this via the following command:
6395 @example
6396 efm32 debuglock num
6397 @end example
6398 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
6399 Note that in order for this command to take effect, the target needs to be reset.
6400 @emph{The current implementation is incomplete. Unprotecting flash pages is not
6401 supported.}
6402 @end deffn
6403
6404 @deffn {Flash Driver} {esirisc}
6405 Members of the eSi-RISC family may optionally include internal flash programmed
6406 via the eSi-TSMC Flash interface. Additional parameters are required to
6407 configure the driver: @option{cfg_address} is the base address of the
6408 configuration register interface, @option{clock_hz} is the expected clock
6409 frequency, and @option{wait_states} is the number of configured read wait states.
6410
6411 @example
6412 flash bank $_FLASHNAME esirisc base_address size_bytes 0 0 \
6413 $_TARGETNAME cfg_address clock_hz wait_states
6414 @end example
6415
6416 @deffn {Command} {esirisc flash mass_erase} bank_id
6417 Erase all pages in data memory for the bank identified by @option{bank_id}.
6418 @end deffn
6419
6420 @deffn {Command} {esirisc flash ref_erase} bank_id
6421 Erase the reference cell for the bank identified by @option{bank_id}. @emph{This
6422 is an uncommon operation.}
6423 @end deffn
6424 @end deffn
6425
6426 @deffn {Flash Driver} {fm3}
6427 All members of the FM3 microcontroller family from Fujitsu
6428 include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M3 cores.
6429 The @var{fm3} driver uses the @var{target} parameter to select the
6430 correct bank config, it can currently be one of the following:
6431 @code{mb9bfxx1.cpu}, @code{mb9bfxx2.cpu}, @code{mb9bfxx3.cpu},
6432 @code{mb9bfxx4.cpu}, @code{mb9bfxx5.cpu} or @code{mb9bfxx6.cpu}.
6433
6434 @example
6435 flash bank $_FLASHNAME fm3 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6436 @end example
6437 @end deffn
6438
6439 @deffn {Flash Driver} {fm4}
6440 All members of the FM4 microcontroller family from Spansion (formerly Fujitsu)
6441 include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M4 cores.
6442 The @var{fm4} driver uses a @var{family} parameter to select the
6443 correct bank config, it can currently be one of the following:
6444 @code{MB9BFx64}, @code{MB9BFx65}, @code{MB9BFx66}, @code{MB9BFx67}, @code{MB9BFx68},
6445 @code{S6E2Cx8}, @code{S6E2Cx9}, @code{S6E2CxA} or @code{S6E2Dx},
6446 with @code{x} treated as wildcard and otherwise case (and any trailing
6447 characters) ignored.
6448
6449 @example
6450 flash bank $@{_FLASHNAME@}0 fm4 0x00000000 0 0 0 \
6451 $_TARGETNAME S6E2CCAJ0A
6452 flash bank $@{_FLASHNAME@}1 fm4 0x00100000 0 0 0 \
6453 $_TARGETNAME S6E2CCAJ0A
6454 @end example
6455 @emph{The current implementation is incomplete. Protection is not supported,
6456 nor is Chip Erase (only Sector Erase is implemented).}
6457 @end deffn
6458
6459 @deffn {Flash Driver} {kinetis}
6460 @cindex kinetis
6461 Kx, KLx, KVx and KE1x members of the Kinetis microcontroller family
6462 from NXP (former Freescale) include
6463 internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M0+ or M4 cores. The driver automatically
6464 recognizes flash size and a number of flash banks (1-4) using the chip
6465 identification register, and autoconfigures itself.
6466 Use kinetis_ke driver for KE0x and KEAx devices.
6467
6468 The @var{kinetis} driver defines option:
6469 @itemize
6470 @item -sim-base @var{addr} ... base of System Integration Module where chip identification resides. Driver tries two known locations if option is omitted.
6471 @end itemize
6472
6473 @example
6474 flash bank $_FLASHNAME kinetis 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6475 @end example
6476
6477 @deffn {Config Command} {kinetis create_banks}
6478 Configuration command enables automatic creation of additional flash banks
6479 based on real flash layout of device. Banks are created during device probe.
6480 Use 'flash probe 0' to force probe.
6481 @end deffn
6482
6483 @deffn {Command} {kinetis fcf_source} [protection|write]
6484 Select what source is used when writing to a Flash Configuration Field.
6485 @option{protection} mode builds FCF content from protection bits previously
6486 set by 'flash protect' command.
6487 This mode is default. MCU is protected from unwanted locking by immediate
6488 writing FCF after erase of relevant sector.
6489 @option{write} mode enables direct write to FCF.
6490 Protection cannot be set by 'flash protect' command. FCF is written along
6491 with the rest of a flash image.
6492 @emph{BEWARE: Incorrect flash configuration may permanently lock the device!}
6493 @end deffn
6494
6495 @deffn {Command} {kinetis fopt} [num]
6496 Set value to write to FOPT byte of Flash Configuration Field.
6497 Used in kinetis 'fcf_source protection' mode only.
6498 @end deffn
6499
6500 @deffn {Command} {kinetis mdm check_security}
6501 Checks status of device security lock. Used internally in examine-end
6502 and examine-fail event.
6503 @end deffn
6504
6505 @deffn {Command} {kinetis mdm halt}
6506 Issues a halt via the MDM-AP. This command can be used to break a watchdog reset
6507 loop when connecting to an unsecured target.
6508 @end deffn
6509
6510 @deffn {Command} {kinetis mdm mass_erase}
6511 Issues a complete flash erase via the MDM-AP. This can be used to erase a chip
6512 back to its factory state, removing security. It does not require the processor
6513 to be halted, however the target will remain in a halted state after this
6514 command completes.
6515 @end deffn
6516
6517 @deffn {Command} {kinetis nvm_partition}
6518 For FlexNVM devices only (KxxDX and KxxFX).
6519 Command shows or sets data flash or EEPROM backup size in kilobytes,
6520 sets two EEPROM blocks sizes in bytes and enables/disables loading
6521 of EEPROM contents to FlexRAM during reset.
6522
6523 For details see device reference manual, Flash Memory Module,
6524 Program Partition command.
6525
6526 Setting is possible only once after mass_erase.
6527 Reset the device after partition setting.
6528
6529 Show partition size:
6530 @example
6531 kinetis nvm_partition info
6532 @end example
6533
6534 Set 32 KB data flash, rest of FlexNVM is EEPROM backup. EEPROM has two blocks
6535 of 512 and 1536 bytes and its contents is loaded to FlexRAM during reset:
6536 @example
6537 kinetis nvm_partition dataflash 32 512 1536 on
6538 @end example
6539
6540 Set 16 KB EEPROM backup, rest of FlexNVM is a data flash. EEPROM has two blocks
6541 of 1024 bytes and its contents is not loaded to FlexRAM during reset:
6542 @example
6543 kinetis nvm_partition eebkp 16 1024 1024 off
6544 @end example
6545 @end deffn
6546
6547 @deffn {Command} {kinetis mdm reset}
6548 Issues a reset via the MDM-AP. This causes the MCU to output a low pulse on the
6549 RESET pin, which can be used to reset other hardware on board.
6550 @end deffn
6551
6552 @deffn {Command} {kinetis disable_wdog}
6553 For Kx devices only (KLx has different COP watchdog, it is not supported).
6554 Command disables watchdog timer.
6555 @end deffn
6556 @end deffn
6557
6558 @deffn {Flash Driver} {kinetis_ke}
6559 @cindex kinetis_ke
6560 KE0x and KEAx members of the Kinetis microcontroller family from NXP include
6561 internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M0+. The driver automatically recognizes
6562 the KE0x sub-family using the chip identification register, and
6563 autoconfigures itself.
6564 Use kinetis (not kinetis_ke) driver for KE1x devices.
6565
6566 @example
6567 flash bank $_FLASHNAME kinetis_ke 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6568 @end example
6569
6570 @deffn {Command} {kinetis_ke mdm check_security}
6571 Checks status of device security lock. Used internally in examine-end event.
6572 @end deffn
6573
6574 @deffn {Command} {kinetis_ke mdm mass_erase}
6575 Issues a complete Flash erase via the MDM-AP.
6576 This can be used to erase a chip back to its factory state.
6577 Command removes security lock from a device (use of SRST highly recommended).
6578 It does not require the processor to be halted.
6579 @end deffn
6580
6581 @deffn {Command} {kinetis_ke disable_wdog}
6582 Command disables watchdog timer.
6583 @end deffn
6584 @end deffn
6585
6586 @deffn {Flash Driver} {lpc2000}
6587 This is the driver to support internal flash of all members of the
6588 LPC11(x)00 and LPC1300 microcontroller families and most members of
6589 the LPC800, LPC1500, LPC1700, LPC1800, LPC2000, LPC4000, LPC54100,
6590 LPC8Nxx and NHS31xx microcontroller families from NXP.
6591
6592 @quotation Note
6593 There are LPC2000 devices which are not supported by the @var{lpc2000}
6594 driver:
6595 The LPC2888 is supported by the @var{lpc288x} driver.
6596 The LPC29xx family is supported by the @var{lpc2900} driver.
6597 @end quotation
6598
6599 The @var{lpc2000} driver defines two mandatory and two optional parameters,
6600 which must appear in the following order:
6601
6602 @itemize
6603 @item @var{variant} ... required, may be
6604 @option{lpc2000_v1} (older LPC21xx and LPC22xx)
6605 @option{lpc2000_v2} (LPC213x, LPC214x, LPC210[123], LPC23xx and LPC24xx)
6606 @option{lpc1700} (LPC175x and LPC176x and LPC177x/8x)
6607 @option{lpc4300} - available also as @option{lpc1800} alias (LPC18x[2357] and
6608 LPC43x[2357])
6609 @option{lpc800} (LPC8xx)
6610 @option{lpc1100} (LPC11(x)xx and LPC13xx)
6611 @option{lpc1500} (LPC15xx)
6612 @option{lpc54100} (LPC541xx)
6613 @option{lpc4000} (LPC40xx)
6614 or @option{auto} - automatically detects flash variant and size for LPC11(x)00,
6615 LPC8xx, LPC13xx, LPC17xx, LPC40xx, LPC8Nxx and NHS31xx
6616 @item @var{clock_kHz} ... the frequency, in kiloHertz,
6617 at which the core is running
6618 @item @option{calc_checksum} ... optional (but you probably want to provide this!),
6619 telling the driver to calculate a valid checksum for the exception vector table.
6620 @quotation Note
6621 If you don't provide @option{calc_checksum} when you're writing the vector
6622 table, the boot ROM will almost certainly ignore your flash image.
6623 However, if you do provide it,
6624 with most tool chains @command{verify_image} will fail.
6625 @end quotation
6626 @item @option{iap_entry} ... optional telling the driver to use a different
6627 ROM IAP entry point.
6628 @end itemize
6629
6630 LPC flashes don't require the chip and bus width to be specified.
6631
6632 @example
6633 flash bank $_FLASHNAME lpc2000 0x0 0x7d000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME \
6634 lpc2000_v2 14765 calc_checksum
6635 @end example
6636
6637 @deffn {Command} {lpc2000 part_id} bank
6638 Displays the four byte part identifier associated with
6639 the specified flash @var{bank}.
6640 @end deffn
6641 @end deffn
6642
6643 @deffn {Flash Driver} {lpc288x}
6644 The LPC2888 microcontroller from NXP needs slightly different flash
6645 support from its lpc2000 siblings.
6646 The @var{lpc288x} driver defines one mandatory parameter,
6647 the programming clock rate in Hz.
6648 LPC flashes don't require the chip and bus width to be specified.
6649
6650 @example
6651 flash bank $_FLASHNAME lpc288x 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME 12000000
6652 @end example
6653 @end deffn
6654
6655 @deffn {Flash Driver} {lpc2900}
6656 This driver supports the LPC29xx ARM968E based microcontroller family
6657 from NXP.
6658
6659 The predefined parameters @var{base}, @var{size}, @var{chip_width} and
6660 @var{bus_width} of the @code{flash bank} command are ignored. Flash size and
6661 sector layout are auto-configured by the driver.
6662 The driver has one additional mandatory parameter: The CPU clock rate
6663 (in kHz) at the time the flash operations will take place. Most of the time this
6664 will not be the crystal frequency, but a higher PLL frequency. The
6665 @code{reset-init} event handler in the board script is usually the place where
6666 you start the PLL.
6667
6668 The driver rejects flashless devices (currently the LPC2930).
6669
6670 The EEPROM in LPC2900 devices is not mapped directly into the address space.
6671 It must be handled much more like NAND flash memory, and will therefore be
6672 handled by a separate @code{lpc2900_eeprom} driver (not yet available).
6673
6674 Sector protection in terms of the LPC2900 is handled transparently. Every time a
6675 sector needs to be erased or programmed, it is automatically unprotected.
6676 What is shown as protection status in the @code{flash info} command, is
6677 actually the LPC2900 @emph{sector security}. This is a mechanism to prevent a
6678 sector from ever being erased or programmed again. As this is an irreversible
6679 mechanism, it is handled by a special command (@code{lpc2900 secure_sector}),
6680 and not by the standard @code{flash protect} command.
6681
6682 Example for a 125 MHz clock frequency:
6683 @example
6684 flash bank $_FLASHNAME lpc2900 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME 125000
6685 @end example
6686
6687 Some @code{lpc2900}-specific commands are defined. In the following command list,
6688 the @var{bank} parameter is the bank number as obtained by the
6689 @code{flash banks} command.
6690
6691 @deffn {Command} {lpc2900 signature} bank
6692 Calculates a 128-bit hash value, the @emph{signature}, from the whole flash
6693 content. This is a hardware feature of the flash block, hence the calculation is
6694 very fast. You may use this to verify the content of a programmed device against
6695 a known signature.
6696 Example:
6697 @example
6698 lpc2900 signature 0
6699 signature: 0x5f40cdc8:0xc64e592e:0x10490f89:0x32a0f317
6700 @end example
6701 @end deffn
6702
6703 @deffn {Command} {lpc2900 read_custom} bank filename
6704 Reads the 912 bytes of customer information from the flash index sector, and
6705 saves it to a file in binary format.
6706 Example:
6707 @example
6708 lpc2900 read_custom 0 /path_to/customer_info.bin
6709 @end example
6710 @end deffn
6711
6712 The index sector of the flash is a @emph{write-only} sector. It cannot be
6713 erased! In order to guard against unintentional write access, all following
6714 commands need to be preceded by a successful call to the @code{password}
6715 command:
6716
6717 @deffn {Command} {lpc2900 password} bank password
6718 You need to use this command right before each of the following commands:
6719 @code{lpc2900 write_custom}, @code{lpc2900 secure_sector},
6720 @code{lpc2900 secure_jtag}.
6721
6722 The password string is fixed to "I_know_what_I_am_doing".
6723 Example:
6724 @example
6725 lpc2900 password 0 I_know_what_I_am_doing
6726 Potentially dangerous operation allowed in next command!
6727 @end example
6728 @end deffn
6729
6730 @deffn {Command} {lpc2900 write_custom} bank filename type
6731 Writes the content of the file into the customer info space of the flash index
6732 sector. The filetype can be specified with the @var{type} field. Possible values
6733 for @var{type} are: @var{bin} (binary), @var{ihex} (Intel hex format),
6734 @var{elf} (ELF binary) or @var{s19} (Motorola S-records). The file must
6735 contain a single section, and the contained data length must be exactly
6736 912 bytes.
6737 @quotation Attention
6738 This cannot be reverted! Be careful!
6739 @end quotation
6740 Example:
6741 @example
6742 lpc2900 write_custom 0 /path_to/customer_info.bin bin
6743 @end example
6744 @end deffn
6745
6746 @deffn {Command} {lpc2900 secure_sector} bank first last
6747 Secures the sector range from @var{first} to @var{last} (including) against
6748 further program and erase operations. The sector security will be effective
6749 after the next power cycle.
6750 @quotation Attention
6751 This cannot be reverted! Be careful!
6752 @end quotation
6753 Secured sectors appear as @emph{protected} in the @code{flash info} command.
6754 Example:
6755 @example
6756 lpc2900 secure_sector 0 1 1
6757 flash info 0
6758 #0 : lpc2900 at 0x20000000, size 0x000c0000, (...)
6759 # 0: 0x00000000 (0x2000 8kB) not protected
6760 # 1: 0x00002000 (0x2000 8kB) protected
6761 # 2: 0x00004000 (0x2000 8kB) not protected
6762 @end example
6763 @end deffn
6764
6765 @deffn {Command} {lpc2900 secure_jtag} bank
6766 Irreversibly disable the JTAG port. The new JTAG security setting will be
6767 effective after the next power cycle.
6768 @quotation Attention
6769 This cannot be reverted! Be careful!
6770 @end quotation
6771 Examples:
6772 @example
6773 lpc2900 secure_jtag 0
6774 @end example
6775 @end deffn
6776 @end deffn
6777
6778 @deffn {Flash Driver} {mdr}
6779 This drivers handles the integrated NOR flash on Milandr Cortex-M
6780 based controllers. A known limitation is that the Info memory can't be
6781 read or verified as it's not memory mapped.
6782
6783 @example
6784 flash bank <name> mdr <base> <size> \
6785 0 0 <target#> @var{type} @var{page_count} @var{sec_count}
6786 @end example
6787
6788 @itemize @bullet
6789 @item @var{type} - 0 for main memory, 1 for info memory
6790 @item @var{page_count} - total number of pages
6791 @item @var{sec_count} - number of sector per page count
6792 @end itemize
6793
6794 Example usage:
6795 @example
6796 if @{ [info exists IMEMORY] && [string equal $IMEMORY true] @} @{
6797 flash bank $@{_CHIPNAME@}_info.flash mdr 0x00000000 0x01000 \
6798 0 0 $_TARGETNAME 1 1 4
6799 @} else @{
6800 flash bank $_CHIPNAME.flash mdr 0x00000000 0x20000 \
6801 0 0 $_TARGETNAME 0 32 4
6802 @}
6803 @end example
6804 @end deffn
6805
6806 @deffn {Flash Driver} {msp432}
6807 All versions of the SimpleLink MSP432 microcontrollers from Texas
6808 Instruments include internal flash. The msp432 flash driver automatically
6809 recognizes the specific version's flash parameters and autoconfigures itself.
6810 Main program flash starts at address 0. The information flash region on
6811 MSP432P4 versions starts at address 0x200000.
6812
6813 @example
6814 flash bank $_FLASHNAME msp432 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6815 @end example
6816
6817 @deffn {Command} {msp432 mass_erase} bank_id [main|all]
6818 Performs a complete erase of flash. By default, @command{mass_erase} will erase
6819 only the main program flash.
6820
6821 On MSP432P4 versions, using @command{mass_erase all} will erase both the
6822 main program and information flash regions. To also erase the BSL in information
6823 flash, the user must first use the @command{bsl} command.
6824 @end deffn
6825
6826 @deffn {Command} {msp432 bsl} bank_id [unlock|lock]
6827 On MSP432P4 versions, @command{bsl} unlocks and locks the bootstrap loader (BSL)
6828 region in information flash so that flash commands can erase or write the BSL.
6829 Leave the BSL locked to prevent accidentally corrupting the bootstrap loader.
6830
6831 To erase and program the BSL:
6832 @example
6833 msp432 bsl unlock
6834 flash erase_address 0x202000 0x2000
6835 flash write_image bsl.bin 0x202000
6836 msp432 bsl lock
6837 @end example
6838 @end deffn
6839 @end deffn
6840
6841 @deffn {Flash Driver} {niietcm4}
6842 This drivers handles the integrated NOR flash on NIIET Cortex-M4
6843 based controllers. Flash size and sector layout are auto-configured by the driver.
6844 Main flash memory is called "Bootflash" and has main region and info region.
6845 Info region is NOT memory mapped by default,
6846 but it can replace first part of main region if needed.
6847 Full erase, single and block writes are supported for both main and info regions.
6848 There is additional not memory mapped flash called "Userflash", which
6849 also have division into regions: main and info.
6850 Purpose of userflash - to store system and user settings.
6851 Driver has special commands to perform operations with this memory.
6852
6853 @example
6854 flash bank $_FLASHNAME niietcm4 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6855 @end example
6856
6857 Some niietcm4-specific commands are defined:
6858
6859 @deffn {Command} {niietcm4 uflash_read_byte} bank ('main'|'info') address
6860 Read byte from main or info userflash region.
6861 @end deffn
6862
6863 @deffn {Command} {niietcm4 uflash_write_byte} bank ('main'|'info') address value
6864 Write byte to main or info userflash region.
6865 @end deffn
6866
6867 @deffn {Command} {niietcm4 uflash_full_erase} bank
6868 Erase all userflash including info region.
6869 @end deffn
6870
6871 @deffn {Command} {niietcm4 uflash_erase} bank ('main'|'info') first_sector last_sector
6872 Erase sectors of main or info userflash region, starting at sector first up to and including last.
6873 @end deffn
6874
6875 @deffn {Command} {niietcm4 uflash_protect_check} bank ('main'|'info')
6876 Check sectors protect.
6877 @end deffn
6878
6879 @deffn {Command} {niietcm4 uflash_protect} bank ('main'|'info') first_sector last_sector ('on'|'off')
6880 Protect sectors of main or info userflash region, starting at sector first up to and including last.
6881 @end deffn
6882
6883 @deffn {Command} {niietcm4 bflash_info_remap} bank ('on'|'off')
6884 Enable remapping bootflash info region to 0x00000000 (or 0x40000000 if external memory boot used).
6885 @end deffn
6886
6887 @deffn {Command} {niietcm4 extmem_cfg} bank ('gpioa'|'gpiob'|'gpioc'|'gpiod'|'gpioe'|'gpiof'|'gpiog'|'gpioh') pin_num ('func1'|'func3')
6888 Configure external memory interface for boot.
6889 @end deffn
6890
6891 @deffn {Command} {niietcm4 service_mode_erase} bank
6892 Perform emergency erase of all flash (bootflash and userflash).
6893 @end deffn
6894
6895 @deffn {Command} {niietcm4 driver_info} bank
6896 Show information about flash driver.
6897 @end deffn
6898
6899 @end deffn
6900
6901 @deffn {Flash Driver} {npcx}
6902 All versions of the NPCX microcontroller families from Nuvoton include internal
6903 flash. The NPCX flash driver supports the NPCX family of devices. The driver
6904 automatically recognizes the specific version's flash parameters and
6905 autoconfigures itself. The flash bank starts at address 0x64000000.
6906
6907 @example
6908 flash bank $_FLASHNAME npcx 0x64000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6909 @end example
6910 @end deffn
6911
6912 @deffn {Flash Driver} {nrf5}
6913 All members of the nRF51 microcontroller families from Nordic Semiconductor
6914 include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M0 core. nRF52 family powered
6915 by ARM Cortex-M4 or M4F core is supported too. nRF52832 is fully supported
6916 including BPROT flash protection scheme. nRF52833 and nRF52840 devices are
6917 supported with the exception of security extensions (flash access control list
6918 - ACL).
6919
6920 @example
6921 flash bank $_FLASHNAME nrf5 0 0x00000000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6922 @end example
6923
6924 Some nrf5-specific commands are defined:
6925
6926 @deffn {Command} {nrf5 mass_erase}
6927 Erases the contents of the code memory and user information
6928 configuration registers as well. It must be noted that this command
6929 works only for chips that do not have factory pre-programmed region 0
6930 code.
6931 @end deffn
6932
6933 @deffn {Command} {nrf5 info}
6934 Decodes and shows information from FICR and UICR registers.
6935 @end deffn
6936
6937 @end deffn
6938
6939 @deffn {Flash Driver} {ocl}
6940 This driver is an implementation of the ``on chip flash loader''
6941 protocol proposed by Pavel Chromy.
6942
6943 It is a minimalistic command-response protocol intended to be used
6944 over a DCC when communicating with an internal or external flash
6945 loader running from RAM. An example implementation for AT91SAM7x is
6946 available in @file{contrib/loaders/flash/at91sam7x/}.
6947
6948 @example
6949 flash bank $_FLASHNAME ocl 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6950 @end example
6951 @end deffn
6952
6953 @deffn {Flash Driver} {pic32mx}
6954 The PIC32MX microcontrollers are based on the MIPS 4K cores,
6955 and integrate flash memory.
6956
6957 @example
6958 flash bank $_FLASHNAME pix32mx 0x1fc00000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6959 flash bank $_FLASHNAME pix32mx 0x1d000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6960 @end example
6961
6962 @comment numerous *disabled* commands are defined:
6963 @comment - chip_erase ... pointless given flash_erase_address
6964 @comment - lock, unlock ... pointless given protect on/off (yes?)
6965 @comment - pgm_word ... shouldn't bank be deduced from address??
6966 Some pic32mx-specific commands are defined:
6967 @deffn {Command} {pic32mx pgm_word} address value bank
6968 Programs the specified 32-bit @var{value} at the given @var{address}
6969 in the specified chip @var{bank}.
6970 @end deffn
6971 @deffn {Command} {pic32mx unlock} bank
6972 Unlock and erase specified chip @var{bank}.
6973 This will remove any Code Protection.
6974 @end deffn
6975 @end deffn
6976
6977 @deffn {Flash Driver} {psoc4}
6978 All members of the PSoC 41xx/42xx microcontroller family from Cypress
6979 include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M0 cores.
6980 The driver automatically recognizes a number of these chips using
6981 the chip identification register, and autoconfigures itself.
6982
6983 Note: Erased internal flash reads as 00.
6984 System ROM of PSoC 4 does not implement erase of a flash sector.
6985
6986 @example
6987 flash bank $_FLASHNAME psoc4 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6988 @end example
6989
6990 psoc4-specific commands
6991 @deffn {Command} {psoc4 flash_autoerase} num (on|off)
6992 Enables or disables autoerase mode for a flash bank.
6993
6994 If flash_autoerase is off, use mass_erase before flash programming.
6995 Flash erase command fails if region to erase is not whole flash memory.
6996
6997 If flash_autoerase is on, a sector is both erased and programmed in one
6998 system ROM call. Flash erase command is ignored.
6999 This mode is suitable for gdb load.
7000
7001 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7002 @end deffn
7003
7004 @deffn {Command} {psoc4 mass_erase} num
7005 Erases the contents of the flash memory, protection and security lock.
7006
7007 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7008 @end deffn
7009 @end deffn
7010
7011 @deffn {Flash Driver} {psoc5lp}
7012 All members of the PSoC 5LP microcontroller family from Cypress
7013 include internal program flash and use ARM Cortex-M3 cores.
7014 The driver probes for a number of these chips and autoconfigures itself,
7015 apart from the base address.
7016
7017 @example
7018 flash bank $_FLASHNAME psoc5lp 0x00000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7019 @end example
7020
7021 @b{Note:} PSoC 5LP chips can be configured to have ECC enabled or disabled.
7022 @quotation Attention
7023 If flash operations are performed in ECC-disabled mode, they will also affect
7024 the ECC flash region. Erasing a 16k flash sector in the 0x00000000 area will
7025 then also erase the corresponding 2k data bytes in the 0x48000000 area.
7026 Writing to the ECC data bytes in ECC-disabled mode is not implemented.
7027 @end quotation
7028
7029 Commands defined in the @var{psoc5lp} driver:
7030
7031 @deffn {Command} {psoc5lp mass_erase}
7032 Erases all flash data and ECC/configuration bytes, all flash protection rows,
7033 and all row latches in all flash arrays on the device.
7034 @end deffn
7035 @end deffn
7036
7037 @deffn {Flash Driver} {psoc5lp_eeprom}
7038 All members of the PSoC 5LP microcontroller family from Cypress
7039 include internal EEPROM and use ARM Cortex-M3 cores.
7040 The driver probes for a number of these chips and autoconfigures itself,
7041 apart from the base address.
7042
7043 @example
7044 flash bank $_CHIPNAME.eeprom psoc5lp_eeprom 0x40008000 0 0 0 \
7045 $_TARGETNAME
7046 @end example
7047 @end deffn
7048
7049 @deffn {Flash Driver} {psoc5lp_nvl}
7050 All members of the PSoC 5LP microcontroller family from Cypress
7051 include internal Nonvolatile Latches and use ARM Cortex-M3 cores.
7052 The driver probes for a number of these chips and autoconfigures itself.
7053
7054 @example
7055 flash bank $_CHIPNAME.nvl psoc5lp_nvl 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7056 @end example
7057
7058 PSoC 5LP chips have multiple NV Latches:
7059
7060 @itemize
7061 @item Device Configuration NV Latch - 4 bytes
7062 @item Write Once (WO) NV Latch - 4 bytes
7063 @end itemize
7064
7065 @b{Note:} This driver only implements the Device Configuration NVL.
7066
7067 The @var{psoc5lp} driver reads the ECC mode from Device Configuration NVL.
7068 @quotation Attention
7069 Switching ECC mode via write to Device Configuration NVL will require a reset
7070 after successful write.
7071 @end quotation
7072 @end deffn
7073
7074 @deffn {Flash Driver} {psoc6}
7075 Supports PSoC6 (CY8C6xxx) family of Cypress microcontrollers.
7076 PSoC6 is a dual-core device with CM0+ and CM4 cores. Both cores share
7077 the same Flash/RAM/MMIO address space.
7078
7079 Flash in PSoC6 is split into three regions:
7080 @itemize @bullet
7081 @item Main Flash - this is the main storage for user application.
7082 Total size varies among devices, sector size: 256 kBytes, row size:
7083 512 bytes. Supports erase operation on individual rows.
7084 @item Work Flash - intended to be used as storage for user data
7085 (e.g. EEPROM emulation). Total size: 32 KBytes, sector size: 32 KBytes,
7086 row size: 512 bytes.
7087 @item Supervisory Flash - special region which contains device-specific
7088 service data. This region does not support erase operation. Only few rows can
7089 be programmed by the user, most of the rows are read only. Programming
7090 operation will erase row automatically.
7091 @end itemize
7092
7093 All three flash regions are supported by the driver. Flash geometry is detected
7094 automatically by parsing data in SPCIF_GEOMETRY register.
7095
7096 PSoC6 is equipped with NOR Flash so erased Flash reads as 0x00.
7097
7098 @example
7099 flash bank main_flash_cm0 psoc6 0x10000000 0 0 0 \
7100 $@{TARGET@}.cm0
7101 flash bank work_flash_cm0 psoc6 0x14000000 0 0 0 \
7102 $@{TARGET@}.cm0
7103 flash bank super_flash_user_cm0 psoc6 0x16000800 0 0 0 \
7104 $@{TARGET@}.cm0
7105 flash bank super_flash_nar_cm0 psoc6 0x16001A00 0 0 0 \
7106 $@{TARGET@}.cm0
7107 flash bank super_flash_key_cm0 psoc6 0x16005A00 0 0 0 \
7108 $@{TARGET@}.cm0
7109 flash bank super_flash_toc2_cm0 psoc6 0x16007C00 0 0 0 \
7110 $@{TARGET@}.cm0
7111
7112 flash bank main_flash_cm4 psoc6 0x10000000 0 0 0 \
7113 $@{TARGET@}.cm4
7114 flash bank work_flash_cm4 psoc6 0x14000000 0 0 0 \
7115 $@{TARGET@}.cm4
7116 flash bank super_flash_user_cm4 psoc6 0x16000800 0 0 0 \
7117 $@{TARGET@}.cm4
7118 flash bank super_flash_nar_cm4 psoc6 0x16001A00 0 0 0 \
7119 $@{TARGET@}.cm4
7120 flash bank super_flash_key_cm4 psoc6 0x16005A00 0 0 0 \
7121 $@{TARGET@}.cm4
7122 flash bank super_flash_toc2_cm4 psoc6 0x16007C00 0 0 0 \
7123 $@{TARGET@}.cm4
7124 @end example
7125
7126 psoc6-specific commands
7127 @deffn {Command} {psoc6 reset_halt}
7128 Command can be used to simulate broken Vector Catch from gdbinit or tcl scripts.
7129 When invoked for CM0+ target, it will set break point at application entry point
7130 and issue SYSRESETREQ. This will reset both cores and all peripherals. CM0+ will
7131 reset CM4 during boot anyway so this is safe. On CM4 target, VECTRESET is used
7132 instead of SYSRESETREQ to avoid unwanted reset of CM0+;
7133 @end deffn
7134
7135 @deffn {Command} {psoc6 mass_erase} num
7136 Erases the contents given flash bank. The @var{num} parameter is a value shown
7137 by @command{flash banks}.
7138 Note: only Main and Work flash regions support Erase operation.
7139 @end deffn
7140 @end deffn
7141
7142 @deffn {Flash Driver} {rp2040}
7143 Supports RP2040 "Raspberry Pi Pico" microcontroller.
7144 RP2040 is a dual-core device with two CM0+ cores. Both cores share the same
7145 Flash/RAM/MMIO address space. Non-volatile storage is achieved with an
7146 external QSPI flash; a Boot ROM provides helper functions.
7147
7148 @example
7149 flash bank $_FLASHNAME rp2040_flash $_FLASHBASE $_FLASHSIZE 1 32 $_TARGETNAME
7150 @end example
7151 @end deffn
7152
7153 @deffn {Flash Driver} {sim3x}
7154 All members of the SiM3 microcontroller family from Silicon Laboratories
7155 include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M3 cores. It supports both JTAG
7156 and SWD interface.
7157 The @var{sim3x} driver tries to probe the device to auto detect the MCU.
7158 If this fails, it will use the @var{size} parameter as the size of flash bank.
7159
7160 @example
7161 flash bank $_FLASHNAME sim3x 0 $_CPUROMSIZE 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7162 @end example
7163
7164 There are 2 commands defined in the @var{sim3x} driver:
7165
7166 @deffn {Command} {sim3x mass_erase}
7167 Erases the complete flash. This is used to unlock the flash.
7168 And this command is only possible when using the SWD interface.
7169 @end deffn
7170
7171 @deffn {Command} {sim3x lock}
7172 Lock the flash. To unlock use the @command{sim3x mass_erase} command.
7173 @end deffn
7174 @end deffn
7175
7176 @deffn {Flash Driver} {stellaris}
7177 All members of the Stellaris LM3Sxxx, LM4x and Tiva C microcontroller
7178 families from Texas Instruments include internal flash. The driver
7179 automatically recognizes a number of these chips using the chip
7180 identification register, and autoconfigures itself.
7181
7182 @example
7183 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stellaris 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7184 @end example
7185
7186 @deffn {Command} {stellaris recover}
7187 Performs the @emph{Recovering a "Locked" Device} procedure to restore
7188 the flash and its associated nonvolatile registers to their factory
7189 default values (erased). This is the only way to remove flash
7190 protection or re-enable debugging if that capability has been
7191 disabled.
7192
7193 Note that the final "power cycle the chip" step in this procedure
7194 must be performed by hand, since OpenOCD can't do it.
7195 @quotation Warning
7196 if more than one Stellaris chip is connected, the procedure is
7197 applied to all of them.
7198 @end quotation
7199 @end deffn
7200 @end deffn
7201
7202 @deffn {Flash Driver} {stm32f1x}
7203 All members of the STM32F0, STM32F1 and STM32F3 microcontroller families
7204 from STMicroelectronics and all members of the GD32F1x0, GD32F3x0 and GD32E23x microcontroller
7205 families from GigaDevice include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M0/M3/M4/M23 cores.
7206 The driver automatically recognizes a number of these chips using
7207 the chip identification register, and autoconfigures itself.
7208
7209 @example
7210 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32f1x 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7211 @end example
7212
7213 Note that some devices have been found that have a flash size register that contains
7214 an invalid value, to workaround this issue you can override the probed value used by
7215 the flash driver.
7216
7217 @example
7218 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32f1x 0 0x20000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7219 @end example
7220
7221 If you have a target with dual flash banks then define the second bank
7222 as per the following example.
7223 @example
7224 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32f1x 0x08080000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7225 @end example
7226
7227 Some stm32f1x-specific commands are defined:
7228
7229 @deffn {Command} {stm32f1x lock} num
7230 Locks the entire stm32 device against reading.
7231 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7232 @end deffn
7233
7234 @deffn {Command} {stm32f1x unlock} num
7235 Unlocks the entire stm32 device for reading. This command will cause
7236 a mass erase of the entire stm32 device if previously locked.
7237 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7238 @end deffn
7239
7240 @deffn {Command} {stm32f1x mass_erase} num
7241 Mass erases the entire stm32 device.
7242 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7243 @end deffn
7244
7245 @deffn {Command} {stm32f1x options_read} num
7246 Reads and displays active stm32 option bytes loaded during POR
7247 or upon executing the @command{stm32f1x options_load} command.
7248 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7249 @end deffn
7250
7251 @deffn {Command} {stm32f1x options_write} num (@option{SWWDG}|@option{HWWDG}) (@option{RSTSTNDBY}|@option{NORSTSTNDBY}) (@option{RSTSTOP}|@option{NORSTSTOP}) (@option{USEROPT} user_data)
7252 Writes the stm32 option byte with the specified values.
7253 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7254 The @var{user_data} parameter is content of higher 16 bits of the option byte register (Data0 and Data1 as one 16bit number).
7255 @end deffn
7256
7257 @deffn {Command} {stm32f1x options_load} num
7258 Generates a special kind of reset to re-load the stm32 option bytes written
7259 by the @command{stm32f1x options_write} or @command{flash protect} commands
7260 without having to power cycle the target. Not applicable to stm32f1x devices.
7261 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7262 @end deffn
7263 @end deffn
7264
7265 @deffn {Flash Driver} {stm32f2x}
7266 All members of the STM32F2, STM32F4 and STM32F7 microcontroller families from STMicroelectronics
7267 include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M3/M4/M7 cores.
7268 The driver automatically recognizes a number of these chips using
7269 the chip identification register, and autoconfigures itself.
7270
7271 @example
7272 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32f2x 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7273 @end example
7274
7275 If you use OTP (One-Time Programmable) memory define it as a second bank
7276 as per the following example.
7277 @example
7278 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32f2x 0x1FFF7800 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7279 @end example
7280
7281 @deffn {Command} {stm32f2x otp} num (@option{enable}|@option{disable}|@option{show})
7282 Enables or disables OTP write commands for bank @var{num}.
7283 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7284 @end deffn
7285
7286 Note that some devices have been found that have a flash size register that contains
7287 an invalid value, to workaround this issue you can override the probed value used by
7288 the flash driver.
7289
7290 @example
7291 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32f2x 0 0x20000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7292 @end example
7293
7294 Some stm32f2x-specific commands are defined:
7295
7296 @deffn {Command} {stm32f2x lock} num
7297 Locks the entire stm32 device.
7298 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7299 @end deffn
7300
7301 @deffn {Command} {stm32f2x unlock} num
7302 Unlocks the entire stm32 device.
7303 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7304 @end deffn
7305
7306 @deffn {Command} {stm32f2x mass_erase} num
7307 Mass erases the entire stm32f2x device.
7308 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7309 @end deffn
7310
7311 @deffn {Command} {stm32f2x options_read} num
7312 Reads and displays user options and (where implemented) boot_addr0, boot_addr1, optcr2.
7313 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7314 @end deffn
7315
7316 @deffn {Command} {stm32f2x options_write} num user_options boot_addr0 boot_addr1
7317 Writes user options and (where implemented) boot_addr0 and boot_addr1 in raw format.
7318 Warning: The meaning of the various bits depends on the device, always check datasheet!
7319 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}, @var{user_options} a
7320 12 bit value, consisting of bits 31-28 and 7-0 of FLASH_OPTCR, @var{boot_addr0} and
7321 @var{boot_addr1} two halfwords (of FLASH_OPTCR1).
7322 @end deffn
7323
7324 @deffn {Command} {stm32f2x optcr2_write} num optcr2
7325 Writes FLASH_OPTCR2 options. Warning: Clearing PCROPi bits requires a full mass erase!
7326 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}, @var{optcr2} a 32-bit word.
7327 @end deffn
7328 @end deffn
7329
7330 @deffn {Flash Driver} {stm32h7x}
7331 All members of the STM32H7 microcontroller families from STMicroelectronics
7332 include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M7 core.
7333 The driver automatically recognizes a number of these chips using
7334 the chip identification register, and autoconfigures itself.
7335
7336 @example
7337 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32h7x 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7338 @end example
7339
7340 Note that some devices have been found that have a flash size register that contains
7341 an invalid value, to workaround this issue you can override the probed value used by
7342 the flash driver.
7343
7344 @example
7345 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32h7x 0 0x20000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7346 @end example
7347
7348 Some stm32h7x-specific commands are defined:
7349
7350 @deffn {Command} {stm32h7x lock} num
7351 Locks the entire stm32 device.
7352 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7353 @end deffn
7354
7355 @deffn {Command} {stm32h7x unlock} num
7356 Unlocks the entire stm32 device.
7357 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7358 @end deffn
7359
7360 @deffn {Command} {stm32h7x mass_erase} num
7361 Mass erases the entire stm32h7x device.
7362 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7363 @end deffn
7364
7365 @deffn {Command} {stm32h7x option_read} num reg_offset
7366 Reads an option byte register from the stm32h7x device.
7367 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}, @var{reg_offset}
7368 is the register offset of the option byte to read from the used bank registers' base.
7369 For example: in STM32H74x/H75x the bank 1 registers' base is 0x52002000 and 0x52002100 for bank 2.
7370
7371 Example usage:
7372 @example
7373 # read OPTSR_CUR
7374 stm32h7x option_read 0 0x1c
7375 # read WPSN_CUR1R
7376 stm32h7x option_read 0 0x38
7377 # read WPSN_CUR2R
7378 stm32h7x option_read 1 0x38
7379 @end example
7380 @end deffn
7381
7382 @deffn {Command} {stm32h7x option_write} num reg_offset value [reg_mask]
7383 Writes an option byte register of the stm32h7x device.
7384 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}, @var{reg_offset}
7385 is the register offset of the option byte to write from the used bank register base,
7386 and @var{reg_mask} is the mask to apply when writing the register (only bits with a '1'
7387 will be touched).
7388
7389 Example usage:
7390 @example
7391 # swap bank 1 and bank 2 in dual bank devices
7392 # by setting SWAP_BANK_OPT bit in OPTSR_PRG
7393 stm32h7x option_write 0 0x20 0x8000000 0x8000000
7394 @end example
7395 @end deffn
7396 @end deffn
7397
7398 @deffn {Flash Driver} {stm32lx}
7399 All members of the STM32L0 and STM32L1 microcontroller families from STMicroelectronics
7400 include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M3 and Cortex-M0+ cores.
7401 The driver automatically recognizes a number of these chips using
7402 the chip identification register, and autoconfigures itself.
7403
7404 @example
7405 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32lx 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7406 @end example
7407
7408 Note that some devices have been found that have a flash size register that contains
7409 an invalid value, to workaround this issue you can override the probed value used by
7410 the flash driver. If you use 0 as the bank base address, it tells the
7411 driver to autodetect the bank location assuming you're configuring the
7412 second bank.
7413
7414 @example
7415 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32lx 0x08000000 0x20000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7416 @end example
7417
7418 Some stm32lx-specific commands are defined:
7419
7420 @deffn {Command} {stm32lx lock} num
7421 Locks the entire stm32 device.
7422 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7423 @end deffn
7424
7425 @deffn {Command} {stm32lx unlock} num
7426 Unlocks the entire stm32 device.
7427 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7428 @end deffn
7429
7430 @deffn {Command} {stm32lx mass_erase} num
7431 Mass erases the entire stm32lx device (all flash banks and EEPROM
7432 data). This is the only way to unlock a protected flash (unless RDP
7433 Level is 2 which can't be unlocked at all).
7434 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7435 @end deffn
7436 @end deffn
7437
7438 @deffn {Flash Driver} {stm32l4x}
7439 All members of the STM32 G0, G4, L4, L4+, L5, U5, WB and WL
7440 microcontroller families from STMicroelectronics include internal flash
7441 and use ARM Cortex-M0+, M4 and M33 cores.
7442 The driver automatically recognizes a number of these chips using
7443 the chip identification register, and autoconfigures itself.
7444
7445 @example
7446 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32l4x 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7447 @end example
7448
7449 If you use OTP (One-Time Programmable) memory define it as a second bank
7450 as per the following example.
7451 @example
7452 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32l4x 0x1FFF7000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7453 @end example
7454
7455 @deffn {Command} {stm32l4x otp} num (@option{enable}|@option{disable}|@option{show})
7456 Enables or disables OTP write commands for bank @var{num}.
7457 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7458 @end deffn
7459
7460 Note that some devices have been found that have a flash size register that contains
7461 an invalid value, to workaround this issue you can override the probed value used by
7462 the flash driver. However, specifying a wrong value might lead to a completely
7463 wrong flash layout, so this feature must be used carefully.
7464
7465 @example
7466 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32l4x 0x08000000 0x40000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7467 @end example
7468
7469 Some stm32l4x-specific commands are defined:
7470
7471 @deffn {Command} {stm32l4x lock} num
7472 Locks the entire stm32 device.
7473 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7474
7475 @emph{Note:} To apply the protection change immediately, use @command{stm32l4x option_load}.
7476 @end deffn
7477
7478 @deffn {Command} {stm32l4x unlock} num
7479 Unlocks the entire stm32 device.
7480 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7481
7482 @emph{Note:} To apply the protection change immediately, use @command{stm32l4x option_load}.
7483 @end deffn
7484
7485 @deffn {Command} {stm32l4x mass_erase} num
7486 Mass erases the entire stm32l4x device.
7487 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7488 @end deffn
7489
7490 @deffn {Command} {stm32l4x option_read} num reg_offset
7491 Reads an option byte register from the stm32l4x device.
7492 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}, @var{reg_offset}
7493 is the register offset of the Option byte to read.
7494
7495 For example to read the FLASH_OPTR register:
7496 @example
7497 stm32l4x option_read 0 0x20
7498 # Option Register (for STM32L4x): <0x40022020> = 0xffeff8aa
7499 # Option Register (for STM32WBx): <0x58004020> = ...
7500 # The correct flash base address will be used automatically
7501 @end example
7502
7503 The above example will read out the FLASH_OPTR register which contains the RDP
7504 option byte, Watchdog configuration, BOR level etc.
7505 @end deffn
7506
7507 @deffn {Command} {stm32l4x option_write} num reg_offset reg_mask
7508 Write an option byte register of the stm32l4x device.
7509 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}, @var{reg_offset}
7510 is the register offset of the Option byte to write, and @var{reg_mask} is the mask
7511 to apply when writing the register (only bits with a '1' will be touched).
7512
7513 @emph{Note:} To apply the option bytes change immediately, use @command{stm32l4x option_load}.
7514
7515 For example to write the WRP1AR option bytes:
7516 @example
7517 stm32l4x option_write 0 0x28 0x00FF0000 0x00FF00FF
7518 @end example
7519
7520 The above example will write the WRP1AR option register configuring the Write protection
7521 Area A for bank 1. The above example set WRP1AR_END=255, WRP1AR_START=0.
7522 This will effectively write protect all sectors in flash bank 1.
7523 @end deffn
7524
7525 @deffn {Command} {stm32l4x wrp_info} num [device_bank]
7526 List the protected areas using WRP.
7527 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7528 @var{device_bank} parameter is optional, possible values 'bank1' or 'bank2',
7529 if not specified, the command will display the whole flash protected areas.
7530
7531 @b{Note:} @var{device_bank} is different from banks created using @code{flash bank}.
7532 Devices supported in this flash driver, can have main flash memory organized
7533 in single or dual-banks mode.
7534 Thus the usage of @var{device_bank} is meaningful only in dual-bank mode, to get
7535 write protected areas in a specific @var{device_bank}
7536
7537 @end deffn
7538
7539 @deffn {Command} {stm32l4x option_load} num
7540 Forces a re-load of the option byte registers. Will cause a system reset of the device.
7541 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7542 @end deffn
7543
7544 @deffn Command {stm32l4x trustzone} num [@option{enable} | @option{disable}]
7545 Enables or disables Global TrustZone Security, using the TZEN option bit.
7546 If neither @option{enabled} nor @option{disable} are specified, the command will display
7547 the TrustZone status.
7548 @emph{Note:} This command works only with devices with TrustZone, eg. STM32L5.
7549 @emph{Note:} This command will perform an OBL_Launch after modifying the TZEN.
7550 @end deffn
7551 @end deffn
7552
7553 @deffn {Flash Driver} {str7x}
7554 All members of the STR7 microcontroller family from STMicroelectronics
7555 include internal flash and use ARM7TDMI cores.
7556 The @var{str7x} driver defines one mandatory parameter, @var{variant},
7557 which is either @code{STR71x}, @code{STR73x} or @code{STR75x}.
7558
7559 @example
7560 flash bank $_FLASHNAME str7x \
7561 0x40000000 0x00040000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME STR71x
7562 @end example
7563
7564 @deffn {Command} {str7x disable_jtag} bank
7565 Activate the Debug/Readout protection mechanism
7566 for the specified flash bank.
7567 @end deffn
7568 @end deffn
7569
7570 @deffn {Flash Driver} {str9x}
7571 Most members of the STR9 microcontroller family from STMicroelectronics
7572 include internal flash and use ARM966E cores.
7573 The str9 needs the flash controller to be configured using
7574 the @command{str9x flash_config} command prior to Flash programming.
7575
7576 @example
7577 flash bank $_FLASHNAME str9x 0x40000000 0x00040000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7578 str9x flash_config 0 4 2 0 0x80000
7579 @end example
7580
7581 @deffn {Command} {str9x flash_config} num bbsr nbbsr bbadr nbbadr
7582 Configures the str9 flash controller.
7583 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7584
7585 @itemize @bullet
7586 @item @var{bbsr} - Boot Bank Size register
7587 @item @var{nbbsr} - Non Boot Bank Size register
7588 @item @var{bbadr} - Boot Bank Start Address register
7589 @item @var{nbbadr} - Boot Bank Start Address register
7590 @end itemize
7591 @end deffn
7592
7593 @end deffn
7594
7595 @deffn {Flash Driver} {str9xpec}
7596 @cindex str9xpec
7597
7598 Only use this driver for locking/unlocking the device or configuring the option bytes.
7599 Use the standard str9 driver for programming.
7600 Before using the flash commands the turbo mode must be enabled using the
7601 @command{str9xpec enable_turbo} command.
7602
7603 Here is some background info to help
7604 you better understand how this driver works. OpenOCD has two flash drivers for
7605 the str9:
7606 @enumerate
7607 @item
7608 Standard driver @option{str9x} programmed via the str9 core. Normally used for
7609 flash programming as it is faster than the @option{str9xpec} driver.
7610 @item
7611 Direct programming @option{str9xpec} using the flash controller. This is an
7612 ISC compliant (IEEE 1532) tap connected in series with the str9 core. The str9
7613 core does not need to be running to program using this flash driver. Typical use
7614 for this driver is locking/unlocking the target and programming the option bytes.
7615 @end enumerate
7616
7617 Before we run any commands using the @option{str9xpec} driver we must first disable
7618 the str9 core. This example assumes the @option{str9xpec} driver has been
7619 configured for flash bank 0.
7620 @example
7621 # assert srst, we do not want core running
7622 # while accessing str9xpec flash driver
7623 adapter assert srst
7624 # turn off target polling
7625 poll off
7626 # disable str9 core
7627 str9xpec enable_turbo 0
7628 # read option bytes
7629 str9xpec options_read 0
7630 # re-enable str9 core
7631 str9xpec disable_turbo 0
7632 poll on
7633 reset halt
7634 @end example
7635 The above example will read the str9 option bytes.
7636 When performing a unlock remember that you will not be able to halt the str9 - it
7637 has been locked. Halting the core is not required for the @option{str9xpec} driver
7638 as mentioned above, just issue the commands above manually or from a telnet prompt.
7639
7640 Several str9xpec-specific commands are defined:
7641
7642 @deffn {Command} {str9xpec disable_turbo} num
7643 Restore the str9 into JTAG chain.
7644 @end deffn
7645
7646 @deffn {Command} {str9xpec enable_turbo} num
7647 Enable turbo mode, will simply remove the str9 from the chain and talk
7648 directly to the embedded flash controller.
7649 @end deffn
7650
7651 @deffn {Command} {str9xpec lock} num
7652 Lock str9 device. The str9 will only respond to an unlock command that will
7653 erase the device.
7654 @end deffn
7655
7656 @deffn {Command} {str9xpec part_id} num
7657 Prints the part identifier for bank @var{num}.
7658 @end deffn
7659
7660 @deffn {Command} {str9xpec options_cmap} num (@option{bank0}|@option{bank1})
7661 Configure str9 boot bank.
7662 @end deffn
7663
7664 @deffn {Command} {str9xpec options_lvdsel} num (@option{vdd}|@option{vdd_vddq})
7665 Configure str9 lvd source.
7666 @end deffn
7667
7668 @deffn {Command} {str9xpec options_lvdthd} num (@option{2.4v}|@option{2.7v})
7669 Configure str9 lvd threshold.
7670 @end deffn
7671
7672 @deffn {Command} {str9xpec options_lvdwarn} bank (@option{vdd}|@option{vdd_vddq})
7673 Configure str9 lvd reset warning source.
7674 @end deffn
7675
7676 @deffn {Command} {str9xpec options_read} num
7677 Read str9 option bytes.
7678 @end deffn
7679
7680 @deffn {Command} {str9xpec options_write} num
7681 Write str9 option bytes.
7682 @end deffn
7683
7684 @deffn {Command} {str9xpec unlock} num
7685 unlock str9 device.
7686 @end deffn
7687
7688 @end deffn
7689
7690 @deffn {Flash Driver} {swm050}
7691 @cindex swm050
7692 All members of the swm050 microcontroller family from Foshan Synwit Tech.
7693
7694 @example
7695 flash bank $_FLASHNAME swm050 0x0 0x2000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7696 @end example
7697
7698 One swm050-specific command is defined:
7699
7700 @deffn {Command} {swm050 mass_erase} bank_id
7701 Erases the entire flash bank.
7702 @end deffn
7703
7704 @end deffn
7705
7706
7707 @deffn {Flash Driver} {tms470}
7708 Most members of the TMS470 microcontroller family from Texas Instruments
7709 include internal flash and use ARM7TDMI cores.
7710 This driver doesn't require the chip and bus width to be specified.
7711
7712 Some tms470-specific commands are defined:
7713
7714 @deffn {Command} {tms470 flash_keyset} key0 key1 key2 key3
7715 Saves programming keys in a register, to enable flash erase and write commands.
7716 @end deffn
7717
7718 @deffn {Command} {tms470 osc_megahertz} clock_mhz
7719 Reports the clock speed, which is used to calculate timings.
7720 @end deffn
7721
7722 @deffn {Command} {tms470 plldis} (0|1)
7723 Disables (@var{1}) or enables (@var{0}) use of the PLL to speed up
7724 the flash clock.
7725 @end deffn
7726 @end deffn
7727
7728 @deffn {Flash Driver} {w600}
7729 W60x series Wi-Fi SoC from WinnerMicro
7730 are designed with ARM Cortex-M3 and have 1M Byte QFLASH inside.
7731 The @var{w600} driver uses the @var{target} parameter to select the
7732 correct bank config.
7733
7734 @example
7735 flash bank $_FLASHNAME w600 0x08000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAMEs
7736 @end example
7737 @end deffn
7738
7739 @deffn {Flash Driver} {xmc1xxx}
7740 All members of the XMC1xxx microcontroller family from Infineon.
7741 This driver does not require the chip and bus width to be specified.
7742 @end deffn
7743
7744 @deffn {Flash Driver} {xmc4xxx}
7745 All members of the XMC4xxx microcontroller family from Infineon.
7746 This driver does not require the chip and bus width to be specified.
7747
7748 Some xmc4xxx-specific commands are defined:
7749
7750 @deffn {Command} {xmc4xxx flash_password} bank_id passwd1 passwd2
7751 Saves flash protection passwords which are used to lock the user flash
7752 @end deffn
7753
7754 @deffn {Command} {xmc4xxx flash_unprotect} bank_id user_level[0-1]
7755 Removes Flash write protection from the selected user bank
7756 @end deffn
7757
7758 @end deffn
7759
7760 @section NAND Flash Commands
7761 @cindex NAND
7762
7763 Compared to NOR or SPI flash, NAND devices are inexpensive
7764 and high density. Today's NAND chips, and multi-chip modules,
7765 commonly hold multiple GigaBytes of data.
7766
7767 NAND chips consist of a number of ``erase blocks'' of a given
7768 size (such as 128 KBytes), each of which is divided into a
7769 number of pages (of perhaps 512 or 2048 bytes each). Each
7770 page of a NAND flash has an ``out of band'' (OOB) area to hold
7771 Error Correcting Code (ECC) and other metadata, usually 16 bytes
7772 of OOB for every 512 bytes of page data.
7773
7774 One key characteristic of NAND flash is that its error rate
7775 is higher than that of NOR flash. In normal operation, that
7776 ECC is used to correct and detect errors. However, NAND
7777 blocks can also wear out and become unusable; those blocks
7778 are then marked "bad". NAND chips are even shipped from the
7779 manufacturer with a few bad blocks. The highest density chips
7780 use a technology (MLC) that wears out more quickly, so ECC
7781 support is increasingly important as a way to detect blocks
7782 that have begun to fail, and help to preserve data integrity
7783 with techniques such as wear leveling.
7784
7785 Software is used to manage the ECC. Some controllers don't
7786 support ECC directly; in those cases, software ECC is used.
7787 Other controllers speed up the ECC calculations with hardware.
7788 Single-bit error correction hardware is routine. Controllers
7789 geared for newer MLC chips may correct 4 or more errors for
7790 every 512 bytes of data.
7791
7792 You will need to make sure that any data you write using
7793 OpenOCD includes the appropriate kind of ECC. For example,
7794 that may mean passing the @code{oob_softecc} flag when
7795 writing NAND data, or ensuring that the correct hardware
7796 ECC mode is used.
7797
7798 The basic steps for using NAND devices include:
7799 @enumerate
7800 @item Declare via the command @command{nand device}
7801 @* Do this in a board-specific configuration file,
7802 passing parameters as needed by the controller.
7803 @item Configure each device using @command{nand probe}.
7804 @* Do this only after the associated target is set up,
7805 such as in its reset-init script or in procures defined
7806 to access that device.
7807 @item Operate on the flash via @command{nand subcommand}
7808 @* Often commands to manipulate the flash are typed by a human, or run
7809 via a script in some automated way. Common task include writing a
7810 boot loader, operating system, or other data needed to initialize or
7811 de-brick a board.
7812 @end enumerate
7813
7814 @b{NOTE:} At the time this text was written, the largest NAND
7815 flash fully supported by OpenOCD is 2 GiBytes (16 GiBits).
7816 This is because the variables used to hold offsets and lengths
7817 are only 32 bits wide.
7818 (Larger chips may work in some cases, unless an offset or length
7819 is larger than 0xffffffff, the largest 32-bit unsigned integer.)
7820 Some larger devices will work, since they are actually multi-chip
7821 modules with two smaller chips and individual chipselect lines.
7822
7823 @anchor{nandconfiguration}
7824 @subsection NAND Configuration Commands
7825 @cindex NAND configuration
7826
7827 NAND chips must be declared in configuration scripts,
7828 plus some additional configuration that's done after
7829 OpenOCD has initialized.
7830
7831 @deffn {Config Command} {nand device} name driver target [configparams...]
7832 Declares a NAND device, which can be read and written to
7833 after it has been configured through @command{nand probe}.
7834 In OpenOCD, devices are single chips; this is unlike some
7835 operating systems, which may manage multiple chips as if
7836 they were a single (larger) device.
7837 In some cases, configuring a device will activate extra
7838 commands; see the controller-specific documentation.
7839
7840 @b{NOTE:} This command is not available after OpenOCD
7841 initialization has completed. Use it in board specific
7842 configuration files, not interactively.
7843
7844 @itemize @bullet
7845 @item @var{name} ... may be used to reference the NAND bank
7846 in most other NAND commands. A number is also available.
7847 @item @var{driver} ... identifies the NAND controller driver
7848 associated with the NAND device being declared.
7849 @xref{nanddriverlist,,NAND Driver List}.
7850 @item @var{target} ... names the target used when issuing
7851 commands to the NAND controller.
7852 @comment Actually, it's currently a controller-specific parameter...
7853 @item @var{configparams} ... controllers may support, or require,
7854 additional parameters. See the controller-specific documentation
7855 for more information.
7856 @end itemize
7857 @end deffn
7858
7859 @deffn {Command} {nand list}
7860 Prints a summary of each device declared
7861 using @command{nand device}, numbered from zero.
7862 Note that un-probed devices show no details.
7863 @example
7864 > nand list
7865 #0: NAND 1GiB 3,3V 8-bit (Micron) pagesize: 2048, buswidth: 8,
7866 blocksize: 131072, blocks: 8192
7867 #1: NAND 1GiB 3,3V 8-bit (Micron) pagesize: 2048, buswidth: 8,
7868 blocksize: 131072, blocks: 8192
7869 >
7870 @end example
7871 @end deffn
7872
7873 @deffn {Command} {nand probe} num
7874 Probes the specified device to determine key characteristics
7875 like its page and block sizes, and how many blocks it has.
7876 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
7877 You must (successfully) probe a device before you can use
7878 it with most other NAND commands.
7879 @end deffn
7880
7881 @subsection Erasing, Reading, Writing to NAND Flash
7882
7883 @deffn {Command} {nand dump} num filename offset length [oob_option]
7884 @cindex NAND reading
7885 Reads binary data from the NAND device and writes it to the file,
7886 starting at the specified offset.
7887 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
7888
7889 Use a complete path name for @var{filename}, so you don't depend
7890 on the directory used to start the OpenOCD server.
7891
7892 The @var{offset} and @var{length} must be exact multiples of the
7893 device's page size. They describe a data region; the OOB data
7894 associated with each such page may also be accessed.
7895
7896 @b{NOTE:} At the time this text was written, no error correction
7897 was done on the data that's read, unless raw access was disabled
7898 and the underlying NAND controller driver had a @code{read_page}
7899 method which handled that error correction.
7900
7901 By default, only page data is saved to the specified file.
7902 Use an @var{oob_option} parameter to save OOB data:
7903 @itemize @bullet
7904 @item no oob_* parameter
7905 @*Output file holds only page data; OOB is discarded.
7906 @item @code{oob_raw}
7907 @*Output file interleaves page data and OOB data;
7908 the file will be longer than "length" by the size of the
7909 spare areas associated with each data page.
7910 Note that this kind of "raw" access is different from
7911 what's implied by @command{nand raw_access}, which just
7912 controls whether a hardware-aware access method is used.
7913 @item @code{oob_only}
7914 @*Output file has only raw OOB data, and will
7915 be smaller than "length" since it will contain only the
7916 spare areas associated with each data page.
7917 @end itemize
7918 @end deffn
7919
7920 @deffn {Command} {nand erase} num [offset length]
7921 @cindex NAND erasing
7922 @cindex NAND programming
7923 Erases blocks on the specified NAND device, starting at the
7924 specified @var{offset} and continuing for @var{length} bytes.
7925 Both of those values must be exact multiples of the device's
7926 block size, and the region they specify must fit entirely in the chip.
7927 If those parameters are not specified,
7928 the whole NAND chip will be erased.
7929 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
7930
7931 @b{NOTE:} This command will try to erase bad blocks, when told
7932 to do so, which will probably invalidate the manufacturer's bad
7933 block marker.
7934 For the remainder of the current server session, @command{nand info}
7935 will still report that the block ``is'' bad.
7936 @end deffn
7937
7938 @deffn {Command} {nand write} num filename offset [option...]
7939 @cindex NAND writing
7940 @cindex NAND programming
7941 Writes binary data from the file into the specified NAND device,
7942 starting at the specified offset. Those pages should already
7943 have been erased; you can't change zero bits to one bits.
7944 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
7945
7946 Use a complete path name for @var{filename}, so you don't depend
7947 on the directory used to start the OpenOCD server.
7948
7949 The @var{offset} must be an exact multiple of the device's page size.
7950 All data in the file will be written, assuming it doesn't run
7951 past the end of the device.
7952 Only full pages are written, and any extra space in the last
7953 page will be filled with 0xff bytes. (That includes OOB data,
7954 if that's being written.)
7955
7956 @b{NOTE:} At the time this text was written, bad blocks are
7957 ignored. That is, this routine will not skip bad blocks,
7958 but will instead try to write them. This can cause problems.
7959
7960 Provide at most one @var{option} parameter. With some
7961 NAND drivers, the meanings of these parameters may change
7962 if @command{nand raw_access} was used to disable hardware ECC.
7963 @itemize @bullet
7964 @item no oob_* parameter
7965 @*File has only page data, which is written.
7966 If raw access is in use, the OOB area will not be written.
7967 Otherwise, if the underlying NAND controller driver has
7968 a @code{write_page} routine, that routine may write the OOB
7969 with hardware-computed ECC data.
7970 @item @code{oob_only}
7971 @*File has only raw OOB data, which is written to the OOB area.
7972 Each page's data area stays untouched. @i{This can be a dangerous
7973 option}, since it can invalidate the ECC data.
7974 You may need to force raw access to use this mode.
7975 @item @code{oob_raw}
7976 @*File interleaves data and OOB data, both of which are written
7977 If raw access is enabled, the data is written first, then the
7978 un-altered OOB.
7979 Otherwise, if the underlying NAND controller driver has
7980 a @code{write_page} routine, that routine may modify the OOB
7981 before it's written, to include hardware-computed ECC data.
7982 @item @code{oob_softecc}
7983 @*File has only page data, which is written.
7984 The OOB area is filled with 0xff, except for a standard 1-bit
7985 software ECC code stored in conventional locations.
7986 You might need to force raw access to use this mode, to prevent
7987 the underlying driver from applying hardware ECC.
7988 @item @code{oob_softecc_kw}
7989 @*File has only page data, which is written.
7990 The OOB area is filled with 0xff, except for a 4-bit software ECC
7991 specific to the boot ROM in Marvell Kirkwood SoCs.
7992 You might need to force raw access to use this mode, to prevent
7993 the underlying driver from applying hardware ECC.
7994 @end itemize
7995 @end deffn
7996
7997 @deffn {Command} {nand verify} num filename offset [option...]
7998 @cindex NAND verification
7999 @cindex NAND programming
8000 Verify the binary data in the file has been programmed to the
8001 specified NAND device, starting at the specified offset.
8002 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
8003
8004 Use a complete path name for @var{filename}, so you don't depend
8005 on the directory used to start the OpenOCD server.
8006
8007 The @var{offset} must be an exact multiple of the device's page size.
8008 All data in the file will be read and compared to the contents of the
8009 flash, assuming it doesn't run past the end of the device.
8010 As with @command{nand write}, only full pages are verified, so any extra
8011 space in the last page will be filled with 0xff bytes.
8012
8013 The same @var{options} accepted by @command{nand write},
8014 and the file will be processed similarly to produce the buffers that
8015 can be compared against the contents produced from @command{nand dump}.
8016
8017 @b{NOTE:} This will not work when the underlying NAND controller
8018 driver's @code{write_page} routine must update the OOB with a
8019 hardware-computed ECC before the data is written. This limitation may
8020 be removed in a future release.
8021 @end deffn
8022
8023 @subsection Other NAND commands
8024 @cindex NAND other commands
8025
8026 @deffn {Command} {nand check_bad_blocks} num [offset length]
8027 Checks for manufacturer bad block markers on the specified NAND
8028 device. If no parameters are provided, checks the whole
8029 device; otherwise, starts at the specified @var{offset} and
8030 continues for @var{length} bytes.
8031 Both of those values must be exact multiples of the device's
8032 block size, and the region they specify must fit entirely in the chip.
8033 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
8034
8035 @b{NOTE:} Before using this command you should force raw access
8036 with @command{nand raw_access enable} to ensure that the underlying
8037 driver will not try to apply hardware ECC.
8038 @end deffn
8039
8040 @deffn {Command} {nand info} num
8041 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
8042 This prints the one-line summary from "nand list", plus for
8043 devices which have been probed this also prints any known
8044 status for each block.
8045 @end deffn
8046
8047 @deffn {Command} {nand raw_access} num (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
8048 Sets or clears an flag affecting how page I/O is done.
8049 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
8050
8051 This flag is cleared (disabled) by default, but changing that
8052 value won't affect all NAND devices. The key factor is whether
8053 the underlying driver provides @code{read_page} or @code{write_page}
8054 methods. If it doesn't provide those methods, the setting of
8055 this flag is irrelevant; all access is effectively ``raw''.
8056
8057 When those methods exist, they are normally used when reading
8058 data (@command{nand dump} or reading bad block markers) or
8059 writing it (@command{nand write}). However, enabling
8060 raw access (setting the flag) prevents use of those methods,
8061 bypassing hardware ECC logic.
8062 @i{This can be a dangerous option}, since writing blocks
8063 with the wrong ECC data can cause them to be marked as bad.
8064 @end deffn
8065
8066 @anchor{nanddriverlist}
8067 @subsection NAND Driver List
8068 As noted above, the @command{nand device} command allows
8069 driver-specific options and behaviors.
8070 Some controllers also activate controller-specific commands.
8071
8072 @deffn {NAND Driver} {at91sam9}
8073 This driver handles the NAND controllers found on AT91SAM9 family chips from
8074 Atmel. It takes two extra parameters: address of the NAND chip;
8075 address of the ECC controller.
8076 @example
8077 nand device $NANDFLASH at91sam9 $CHIPNAME 0x40000000 0xfffffe800
8078 @end example
8079 AT91SAM9 chips support single-bit ECC hardware. The @code{write_page} and
8080 @code{read_page} methods are used to utilize the ECC hardware unless they are
8081 disabled by using the @command{nand raw_access} command. There are four
8082 additional commands that are needed to fully configure the AT91SAM9 NAND
8083 controller. Two are optional; most boards use the same wiring for ALE/CLE:
8084 @deffn {Config Command} {at91sam9 cle} num addr_line
8085 Configure the address line used for latching commands. The @var{num}
8086 parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
8087 @end deffn
8088 @deffn {Config Command} {at91sam9 ale} num addr_line
8089 Configure the address line used for latching addresses. The @var{num}
8090 parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
8091 @end deffn
8092
8093 For the next two commands, it is assumed that the pins have already been
8094 properly configured for input or output.
8095 @deffn {Config Command} {at91sam9 rdy_busy} num pio_base_addr pin
8096 Configure the RDY/nBUSY input from the NAND device. The @var{num}
8097 parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}. @var{pio_base_addr}
8098 is the base address of the PIO controller and @var{pin} is the pin number.
8099 @end deffn
8100 @deffn {Config Command} {at91sam9 ce} num pio_base_addr pin
8101 Configure the chip enable input to the NAND device. The @var{num}
8102 parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}. @var{pio_base_addr}
8103 is the base address of the PIO controller and @var{pin} is the pin number.
8104 @end deffn
8105 @end deffn
8106
8107 @deffn {NAND Driver} {davinci}
8108 This driver handles the NAND controllers found on DaVinci family
8109 chips from Texas Instruments.
8110 It takes three extra parameters:
8111 address of the NAND chip;
8112 hardware ECC mode to use (@option{hwecc1},
8113 @option{hwecc4}, @option{hwecc4_infix});
8114 address of the AEMIF controller on this processor.
8115 @example
8116 nand device davinci dm355.arm 0x02000000 hwecc4 0x01e10000
8117 @end example
8118 All DaVinci processors support the single-bit ECC hardware,
8119 and newer ones also support the four-bit ECC hardware.
8120 The @code{write_page} and @code{read_page} methods are used
8121 to implement those ECC modes, unless they are disabled using
8122 the @command{nand raw_access} command.
8123 @end deffn
8124
8125 @deffn {NAND Driver} {lpc3180}
8126 These controllers require an extra @command{nand device}
8127 parameter: the clock rate used by the controller.
8128 @deffn {Command} {lpc3180 select} num [mlc|slc]
8129 Configures use of the MLC or SLC controller mode.
8130 MLC implies use of hardware ECC.
8131 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
8132 @end deffn
8133
8134 At this writing, this driver includes @code{write_page}
8135 and @code{read_page} methods. Using @command{nand raw_access}
8136 to disable those methods will prevent use of hardware ECC
8137 in the MLC controller mode, but won't change SLC behavior.
8138 @end deffn
8139 @comment current lpc3180 code won't issue 5-byte address cycles
8140
8141 @deffn {NAND Driver} {mx3}
8142 This driver handles the NAND controller in i.MX31. The mxc driver
8143 should work for this chip as well.
8144 @end deffn
8145
8146 @deffn {NAND Driver} {mxc}
8147 This driver handles the NAND controller found in Freescale i.MX
8148 chips. It has support for v1 (i.MX27 and i.MX31) and v2 (i.MX35).
8149 The driver takes 3 extra arguments, chip (@option{mx27},
8150 @option{mx31}, @option{mx35}), ecc (@option{noecc}, @option{hwecc})
8151 and optionally if bad block information should be swapped between
8152 main area and spare area (@option{biswap}), defaults to off.
8153 @example
8154 nand device mx35.nand mxc imx35.cpu mx35 hwecc biswap
8155 @end example
8156 @deffn {Command} {mxc biswap} bank_num [enable|disable]
8157 Turns on/off bad block information swapping from main area,
8158 without parameter query status.
8159 @end deffn
8160 @end deffn
8161
8162 @deffn {NAND Driver} {orion}
8163 These controllers require an extra @command{nand device}
8164 parameter: the address of the controller.
8165 @example
8166 nand device orion 0xd8000000
8167 @end example
8168 These controllers don't define any specialized commands.
8169 At this writing, their drivers don't include @code{write_page}
8170 or @code{read_page} methods, so @command{nand raw_access} won't
8171 change any behavior.
8172 @end deffn
8173
8174 @deffn {NAND Driver} {s3c2410}
8175 @deffnx {NAND Driver} {s3c2412}
8176 @deffnx {NAND Driver} {s3c2440}
8177 @deffnx {NAND Driver} {s3c2443}
8178 @deffnx {NAND Driver} {s3c6400}
8179 These S3C family controllers don't have any special
8180 @command{nand device} options, and don't define any
8181 specialized commands.
8182 At this writing, their drivers don't include @code{write_page}
8183 or @code{read_page} methods, so @command{nand raw_access} won't
8184 change any behavior.
8185 @end deffn
8186
8187 @node Flash Programming
8188 @chapter Flash Programming
8189
8190 OpenOCD implements numerous ways to program the target flash, whether internal or external.
8191 Programming can be achieved by either using @ref{programmingusinggdb,,Programming using GDB},
8192 or using the commands given in @ref{flashprogrammingcommands,,Flash Programming Commands}.
8193
8194 @*To simplify using the flash commands directly a jimtcl script is available that handles the programming and verify stage.
8195 OpenOCD will program/verify/reset the target and optionally shutdown.
8196
8197 The script is executed as follows and by default the following actions will be performed.
8198 @enumerate
8199 @item 'init' is executed.
8200 @item 'reset init' is called to reset and halt the target, any 'reset init' scripts are executed.
8201 @item @code{flash write_image} is called to erase and write any flash using the filename given.
8202 @item If the @option{preverify} parameter is given, the target is "verified" first and only flashed if this fails.
8203 @item @code{verify_image} is called if @option{verify} parameter is given.
8204 @item @code{reset run} is called if @option{reset} parameter is given.
8205 @item OpenOCD is shutdown if @option{exit} parameter is given.
8206 @end enumerate
8207
8208 An example of usage is given below. @xref{program}.
8209
8210 @example
8211 # program and verify using elf/hex/s19. verify and reset
8212 # are optional parameters
8213 openocd -f board/stm32f3discovery.cfg \
8214 -c "program filename.elf verify reset exit"
8215
8216 # binary files need the flash address passing
8217 openocd -f board/stm32f3discovery.cfg \
8218 -c "program filename.bin exit 0x08000000"
8219 @end example
8220
8221 @node PLD/FPGA Commands
8222 @chapter PLD/FPGA Commands
8223 @cindex PLD
8224 @cindex FPGA
8225
8226 Programmable Logic Devices (PLDs) and the more flexible
8227 Field Programmable Gate Arrays (FPGAs) are both types of programmable hardware.
8228 OpenOCD can support programming them.
8229 Although PLDs are generally restrictive (cells are less functional, and
8230 there are no special purpose cells for memory or computational tasks),
8231 they share the same OpenOCD infrastructure.
8232 Accordingly, both are called PLDs here.
8233
8234 @section PLD/FPGA Configuration and Commands
8235
8236 As it does for JTAG TAPs, debug targets, and flash chips (both NOR and NAND),
8237 OpenOCD maintains a list of PLDs available for use in various commands.
8238 Also, each such PLD requires a driver.
8239
8240 They are referenced by the number shown by the @command{pld devices} command,
8241 and new PLDs are defined by @command{pld device driver_name}.
8242
8243 @deffn {Config Command} {pld device} driver_name tap_name [driver_options]
8244 Defines a new PLD device, supported by driver @var{driver_name},
8245 using the TAP named @var{tap_name}.
8246 The driver may make use of any @var{driver_options} to configure its
8247 behavior.
8248 @end deffn
8249
8250 @deffn {Command} {pld devices}
8251 Lists the PLDs and their numbers.
8252 @end deffn
8253
8254 @deffn {Command} {pld load} num filename
8255 Loads the file @file{filename} into the PLD identified by @var{num}.
8256 The file format must be inferred by the driver.
8257 @end deffn
8258
8259 @section PLD/FPGA Drivers, Options, and Commands
8260
8261 Drivers may support PLD-specific options to the @command{pld device}
8262 definition command, and may also define commands usable only with
8263 that particular type of PLD.
8264
8265 @deffn {FPGA Driver} {virtex2} [no_jstart]
8266 Virtex-II is a family of FPGAs sold by Xilinx.
8267 It supports the IEEE 1532 standard for In-System Configuration (ISC).
8268
8269 If @var{no_jstart} is non-zero, the JSTART instruction is not used after
8270 loading the bitstream. While required for Series2, Series3, and Series6, it
8271 breaks bitstream loading on Series7.
8272
8273 @deffn {Command} {virtex2 read_stat} num
8274 Reads and displays the Virtex-II status register (STAT)
8275 for FPGA @var{num}.
8276 @end deffn
8277 @end deffn
8278
8279 @node General Commands
8280 @chapter General Commands
8281 @cindex commands
8282
8283 The commands documented in this chapter here are common commands that
8284 you, as a human, may want to type and see the output of. Configuration type
8285 commands are documented elsewhere.
8286
8287 Intent:
8288 @itemize @bullet
8289 @item @b{Source Of Commands}
8290 @* OpenOCD commands can occur in a configuration script (discussed
8291 elsewhere) or typed manually by a human or supplied programmatically,
8292 or via one of several TCP/IP Ports.
8293
8294 @item @b{From the human}
8295 @* A human should interact with the telnet interface (default port: 4444)
8296 or via GDB (default port 3333).
8297
8298 To issue commands from within a GDB session, use the @option{monitor}
8299 command, e.g. use @option{monitor poll} to issue the @option{poll}
8300 command. All output is relayed through the GDB session.
8301
8302 @item @b{Machine Interface}
8303 The Tcl interface's intent is to be a machine interface. The default Tcl
8304 port is 5555.
8305 @end itemize
8306
8307
8308 @section Server Commands
8309
8310 @deffn {Command} {exit}
8311 Exits the current telnet session.
8312 @end deffn
8313
8314 @deffn {Command} {help} [string]
8315 With no parameters, prints help text for all commands.
8316 Otherwise, prints each helptext containing @var{string}.
8317 Not every command provides helptext.
8318
8319 Configuration commands, and commands valid at any time, are
8320 explicitly noted in parenthesis.
8321 In most cases, no such restriction is listed; this indicates commands
8322 which are only available after the configuration stage has completed.
8323 @end deffn
8324
8325 @deffn {Command} {usage} [string]
8326 With no parameters, prints usage text for all commands. Otherwise,
8327 prints all usage text of which command, help text, and usage text
8328 containing @var{string}.
8329 Not every command provides helptext.
8330 @end deffn
8331
8332 @deffn {Command} {sleep} msec [@option{busy}]
8333 Wait for at least @var{msec} milliseconds before resuming.
8334 If @option{busy} is passed, busy-wait instead of sleeping.
8335 (This option is strongly discouraged.)
8336 Useful in connection with script files
8337 (@command{script} command and @command{target_name} configuration).
8338 @end deffn
8339
8340 @deffn {Command} {shutdown} [@option{error}]
8341 Close the OpenOCD server, disconnecting all clients (GDB, telnet,
8342 other). If option @option{error} is used, OpenOCD will return a
8343 non-zero exit code to the parent process.
8344
8345 Like any TCL commands, also @command{shutdown} can be redefined, e.g.:
8346 @example
8347 # redefine shutdown
8348 rename shutdown original_shutdown
8349 proc shutdown @{@} @{
8350 puts "This is my implementation of shutdown"
8351 # my own stuff before exit OpenOCD
8352 original_shutdown
8353 @}
8354 @end example
8355 If user types CTRL-C or kills OpenOCD, either the command @command{shutdown}
8356 or its replacement will be automatically executed before OpenOCD exits.
8357 @end deffn
8358
8359 @anchor{debuglevel}
8360 @deffn {Command} {debug_level} [n]
8361 @cindex message level
8362 Display debug level.
8363 If @var{n} (from 0..4) is provided, then set it to that level.
8364 This affects the kind of messages sent to the server log.
8365 Level 0 is error messages only;
8366 level 1 adds warnings;
8367 level 2 adds informational messages;
8368 level 3 adds debugging messages;
8369 and level 4 adds verbose low-level debug messages.
8370 The default is level 2, but that can be overridden on
8371 the command line along with the location of that log
8372 file (which is normally the server's standard output).
8373 @xref{Running}.
8374 @end deffn
8375
8376 @deffn {Command} {echo} [-n] message
8377 Logs a message at "user" priority.
8378 Option "-n" suppresses trailing newline.
8379 @example
8380 echo "Downloading kernel -- please wait"
8381 @end example
8382 @end deffn
8383
8384 @deffn {Command} {log_output} [filename | "default"]
8385 Redirect logging to @var{filename} or set it back to default output;
8386 the default log output channel is stderr.
8387 @end deffn
8388
8389 @deffn {Command} {add_script_search_dir} [directory]
8390 Add @var{directory} to the file/script search path.
8391 @end deffn
8392
8393 @deffn {Config Command} {bindto} [@var{name}]
8394 Specify hostname or IPv4 address on which to listen for incoming
8395 TCP/IP connections. By default, OpenOCD will listen on the loopback
8396 interface only. If your network environment is safe, @code{bindto
8397 0.0.0.0} can be used to cover all available interfaces.
8398 @end deffn
8399
8400 @anchor{targetstatehandling}
8401 @section Target State handling
8402 @cindex reset
8403 @cindex halt
8404 @cindex target initialization
8405
8406 In this section ``target'' refers to a CPU configured as
8407 shown earlier (@pxref{CPU Configuration}).
8408 These commands, like many, implicitly refer to
8409 a current target which is used to perform the
8410 various operations. The current target may be changed
8411 by using @command{targets} command with the name of the
8412 target which should become current.
8413
8414 @deffn {Command} {reg} [(number|name) [(value|'force')]]
8415 Access a single register by @var{number} or by its @var{name}.
8416 The target must generally be halted before access to CPU core
8417 registers is allowed. Depending on the hardware, some other
8418 registers may be accessible while the target is running.
8419
8420 @emph{With no arguments}:
8421 list all available registers for the current target,
8422 showing number, name, size, value, and cache status.
8423 For valid entries, a value is shown; valid entries
8424 which are also dirty (and will be written back later)
8425 are flagged as such.
8426
8427 @emph{With number/name}: display that register's value.
8428 Use @var{force} argument to read directly from the target,
8429 bypassing any internal cache.
8430
8431 @emph{With both number/name and value}: set register's value.
8432 Writes may be held in a writeback cache internal to OpenOCD,
8433 so that setting the value marks the register as dirty instead
8434 of immediately flushing that value. Resuming CPU execution
8435 (including by single stepping) or otherwise activating the
8436 relevant module will flush such values.
8437
8438 Cores may have surprisingly many registers in their
8439 Debug and trace infrastructure:
8440
8441 @example
8442 > reg
8443 ===== ARM registers
8444 (0) r0 (/32): 0x0000D3C2 (dirty)
8445 (1) r1 (/32): 0xFD61F31C
8446 (2) r2 (/32)
8447 ...
8448 (164) ETM_contextid_comparator_mask (/32)
8449 >
8450 @end example
8451 @end deffn
8452
8453 @deffn {Command} {halt} [ms]
8454 @deffnx {Command} {wait_halt} [ms]
8455 The @command{halt} command first sends a halt request to the target,
8456 which @command{wait_halt} doesn't.
8457 Otherwise these behave the same: wait up to @var{ms} milliseconds,
8458 or 5 seconds if there is no parameter, for the target to halt
8459 (and enter debug mode).
8460 Using 0 as the @var{ms} parameter prevents OpenOCD from waiting.
8461
8462 @quotation Warning
8463 On ARM cores, software using the @emph{wait for interrupt} operation
8464 often blocks the JTAG access needed by a @command{halt} command.
8465 This is because that operation also puts the core into a low
8466 power mode by gating the core clock;
8467 but the core clock is needed to detect JTAG clock transitions.
8468
8469 One partial workaround uses adaptive clocking: when the core is
8470 interrupted the operation completes, then JTAG clocks are accepted
8471 at least until the interrupt handler completes.
8472 However, this workaround is often unusable since the processor, board,
8473 and JTAG adapter must all support adaptive JTAG clocking.
8474 Also, it can't work until an interrupt is issued.
8475
8476 A more complete workaround is to not use that operation while you
8477 work with a JTAG debugger.
8478 Tasking environments generally have idle loops where the body is the
8479 @emph{wait for interrupt} operation.
8480 (On older cores, it is a coprocessor action;
8481 newer cores have a @option{wfi} instruction.)
8482 Such loops can just remove that operation, at the cost of higher
8483 power consumption (because the CPU is needlessly clocked).
8484 @end quotation
8485
8486 @end deffn
8487
8488 @deffn {Command} {resume} [address]
8489 Resume the target at its current code position,
8490 or the optional @var{address} if it is provided.
8491 OpenOCD will wait 5 seconds for the target to resume.
8492 @end deffn
8493
8494 @deffn {Command} {step} [address]
8495 Single-step the target at its current code position,
8496 or the optional @var{address} if it is provided.
8497 @end deffn
8498
8499 @anchor{resetcommand}
8500 @deffn {Command} {reset}
8501 @deffnx {Command} {reset run}
8502 @deffnx {Command} {reset halt}
8503 @deffnx {Command} {reset init}
8504 Perform as hard a reset as possible, using SRST if possible.
8505 @emph{All defined targets will be reset, and target
8506 events will fire during the reset sequence.}
8507
8508 The optional parameter specifies what should
8509 happen after the reset.
8510 If there is no parameter, a @command{reset run} is executed.
8511 The other options will not work on all systems.
8512 @xref{Reset Configuration}.
8513
8514 @itemize @minus
8515 @item @b{run} Let the target run
8516 @item @b{halt} Immediately halt the target
8517 @item @b{init} Immediately halt the target, and execute the reset-init script
8518 @end itemize
8519 @end deffn
8520
8521 @deffn {Command} {soft_reset_halt}
8522 Requesting target halt and executing a soft reset. This is often used
8523 when a target cannot be reset and halted. The target, after reset is
8524 released begins to execute code. OpenOCD attempts to stop the CPU and
8525 then sets the program counter back to the reset vector. Unfortunately
8526 the code that was executed may have left the hardware in an unknown
8527 state.
8528 @end deffn
8529
8530 @deffn {Command} {adapter assert} [signal [assert|deassert signal]]
8531 @deffnx {Command} {adapter deassert} [signal [assert|deassert signal]]
8532 Set values of reset signals.
8533 Without parameters returns current status of the signals.
8534 The @var{signal} parameter values may be
8535 @option{srst}, indicating that srst signal is to be asserted or deasserted,
8536 @option{trst}, indicating that trst signal is to be asserted or deasserted.
8537
8538 The @command{reset_config} command should already have been used
8539 to configure how the board and the adapter treat these two
8540 signals, and to say if either signal is even present.
8541 @xref{Reset Configuration}.
8542 Trying to assert a signal that is not present triggers an error.
8543 If a signal is present on the adapter and not specified in the command,
8544 the signal will not be modified.
8545
8546 @quotation Note
8547 TRST is specially handled.
8548 It actually signifies JTAG's @sc{reset} state.
8549 So if the board doesn't support the optional TRST signal,
8550 or it doesn't support it along with the specified SRST value,
8551 JTAG reset is triggered with TMS and TCK signals
8552 instead of the TRST signal.
8553 And no matter how that JTAG reset is triggered, once
8554 the scan chain enters @sc{reset} with TRST inactive,
8555 TAP @code{post-reset} events are delivered to all TAPs
8556 with handlers for that event.
8557 @end quotation
8558 @end deffn
8559
8560 @anchor{memoryaccess}
8561 @section Memory access commands
8562 @cindex memory access
8563
8564 These commands allow accesses of a specific size to the memory
8565 system. Often these are used to configure the current target in some
8566 special way. For example - one may need to write certain values to the
8567 SDRAM controller to enable SDRAM.
8568
8569 @enumerate
8570 @item Use the @command{targets} (plural) command
8571 to change the current target.
8572 @item In system level scripts these commands are deprecated.
8573 Please use their TARGET object siblings to avoid making assumptions
8574 about what TAP is the current target, or about MMU configuration.
8575 @end enumerate
8576
8577 @deffn {Command} {mdd} [phys] addr [count]
8578 @deffnx {Command} {mdw} [phys] addr [count]
8579 @deffnx {Command} {mdh} [phys] addr [count]
8580 @deffnx {Command} {mdb} [phys] addr [count]
8581 Display contents of address @var{addr}, as
8582 64-bit doublewords (@command{mdd}),
8583 32-bit words (@command{mdw}), 16-bit halfwords (@command{mdh}),
8584 or 8-bit bytes (@command{mdb}).
8585 When the current target has an MMU which is present and active,
8586 @var{addr} is interpreted as a virtual address.
8587 Otherwise, or if the optional @var{phys} flag is specified,
8588 @var{addr} is interpreted as a physical address.
8589 If @var{count} is specified, displays that many units.
8590 (If you want to manipulate the data instead of displaying it,
8591 see the @code{mem2array} primitives.)
8592 @end deffn
8593
8594 @deffn {Command} {mwd} [phys] addr doubleword [count]
8595 @deffnx {Command} {mww} [phys] addr word [count]
8596 @deffnx {Command} {mwh} [phys] addr halfword [count]
8597 @deffnx {Command} {mwb} [phys] addr byte [count]
8598 Writes the specified @var{doubleword} (64 bits), @var{word} (32 bits),
8599 @var{halfword} (16 bits), or @var{byte} (8-bit) value,
8600 at the specified address @var{addr}.
8601 When the current target has an MMU which is present and active,
8602 @var{addr} is interpreted as a virtual address.
8603 Otherwise, or if the optional @var{phys} flag is specified,
8604 @var{addr} is interpreted as a physical address.
8605 If @var{count} is specified, fills that many units of consecutive address.
8606 @end deffn
8607
8608 @anchor{imageaccess}
8609 @section Image loading commands
8610 @cindex image loading
8611 @cindex image dumping
8612
8613 @deffn {Command} {dump_image} filename address size
8614 Dump @var{size} bytes of target memory starting at @var{address} to the
8615 binary file named @var{filename}.
8616 @end deffn
8617
8618 @deffn {Command} {fast_load}
8619 Loads an image stored in memory by @command{fast_load_image} to the
8620 current target. Must be preceded by fast_load_image.
8621 @end deffn
8622
8623 @deffn {Command} {fast_load_image} filename address [@option{bin}|@option{ihex}|@option{elf}|@option{s19}]
8624 Normally you should be using @command{load_image} or GDB load. However, for
8625 testing purposes or when I/O overhead is significant(OpenOCD running on an embedded
8626 host), storing the image in memory and uploading the image to the target
8627 can be a way to upload e.g. multiple debug sessions when the binary does not change.
8628 Arguments are the same as @command{load_image}, but the image is stored in OpenOCD host
8629 memory, i.e. does not affect target. This approach is also useful when profiling
8630 target programming performance as I/O and target programming can easily be profiled
8631 separately.
8632 @end deffn
8633
8634 @deffn {Command} {load_image} filename address [[@option{bin}|@option{ihex}|@option{elf}|@option{s19}] @option{min_addr} @option{max_length}]
8635 Load image from file @var{filename} to target memory offset by @var{address} from its load address.
8636 The file format may optionally be specified
8637 (@option{bin}, @option{ihex}, @option{elf}, or @option{s19}).
8638 In addition the following arguments may be specified:
8639 @var{min_addr} - ignore data below @var{min_addr} (this is w.r.t. to the target's load address + @var{address})
8640 @var{max_length} - maximum number of bytes to load.
8641 @example
8642 proc load_image_bin @{fname foffset address length @} @{
8643 # Load data from fname filename at foffset offset to
8644 # target at address. Load at most length bytes.
8645 load_image $fname [expr @{$address - $foffset@}] bin \
8646 $address $length
8647 @}
8648 @end example
8649 @end deffn
8650
8651 @deffn {Command} {test_image} filename [address [@option{bin}|@option{ihex}|@option{elf}]]
8652 Displays image section sizes and addresses
8653 as if @var{filename} were loaded into target memory
8654 starting at @var{address} (defaults to zero).
8655 The file format may optionally be specified
8656 (@option{bin}, @option{ihex}, or @option{elf})
8657 @end deffn
8658
8659 @deffn {Command} {verify_image} filename address [@option{bin}|@option{ihex}|@option{elf}]
8660 Verify @var{filename} against target memory starting at @var{address}.
8661 The file format may optionally be specified
8662 (@option{bin}, @option{ihex}, or @option{elf})
8663 This will first attempt a comparison using a CRC checksum, if this fails it will try a binary compare.
8664 @end deffn
8665
8666 @deffn {Command} {verify_image_checksum} filename address [@option{bin}|@option{ihex}|@option{elf}]
8667 Verify @var{filename} against target memory starting at @var{address}.
8668 The file format may optionally be specified
8669 (@option{bin}, @option{ihex}, or @option{elf})
8670 This perform a comparison using a CRC checksum only
8671 @end deffn
8672
8673
8674 @section Breakpoint and Watchpoint commands
8675 @cindex breakpoint
8676 @cindex watchpoint
8677
8678 CPUs often make debug modules accessible through JTAG, with
8679 hardware support for a handful of code breakpoints and data
8680 watchpoints.
8681 In addition, CPUs almost always support software breakpoints.
8682
8683 @deffn {Command} {bp} [address len [@option{hw}]]
8684 With no parameters, lists all active breakpoints.
8685 Else sets a breakpoint on code execution starting
8686 at @var{address} for @var{length} bytes.
8687 This is a software breakpoint, unless @option{hw} is specified
8688 in which case it will be a hardware breakpoint.
8689
8690 (@xref{arm9vectorcatch,,arm9 vector_catch}, or @pxref{xscalevectorcatch,,xscale vector_catch},
8691 for similar mechanisms that do not consume hardware breakpoints.)
8692 @end deffn
8693
8694 @deffn {Command} {rbp} @option{all} | address
8695 Remove the breakpoint at @var{address} or all breakpoints.
8696 @end deffn
8697
8698 @deffn {Command} {rwp} address
8699 Remove data watchpoint on @var{address}
8700 @end deffn
8701
8702 @deffn {Command} {wp} [address len [(@option{r}|@option{w}|@option{a}) [value [mask]]]]
8703 With no parameters, lists all active watchpoints.
8704 Else sets a data watchpoint on data from @var{address} for @var{length} bytes.
8705 The watch point is an "access" watchpoint unless
8706 the @option{r} or @option{w} parameter is provided,
8707 defining it as respectively a read or write watchpoint.
8708 If a @var{value} is provided, that value is used when determining if
8709 the watchpoint should trigger. The value may be first be masked
8710 using @var{mask} to mark ``don't care'' fields.
8711 @end deffn
8712
8713
8714 @section Real Time Transfer (RTT)
8715
8716 Real Time Transfer (RTT) is an interface specified by SEGGER based on basic
8717 memory reads and writes to transfer data bidirectionally between target and host.
8718 The specification is independent of the target architecture.
8719 Every target that supports so called "background memory access", which means
8720 that the target memory can be accessed by the debugger while the target is
8721 running, can be used.
8722 This interface is especially of interest for targets without
8723 Serial Wire Output (SWO), such as ARM Cortex-M0, or where semihosting is not
8724 applicable because of real-time constraints.
8725
8726 @quotation Note
8727 The current implementation supports only single target devices.
8728 @end quotation
8729
8730 The data transfer between host and target device is organized through
8731 unidirectional up/down-channels for target-to-host and host-to-target
8732 communication, respectively.
8733
8734 @quotation Note
8735 The current implementation does not respect channel buffer flags.
8736 They are used to determine what happens when writing to a full buffer, for
8737 example.
8738 @end quotation
8739
8740 Channels are exposed via raw TCP/IP connections. One or more RTT servers can be
8741 assigned to each channel to make them accessible to an unlimited number
8742 of TCP/IP connections.
8743
8744 @deffn {Command} {rtt setup} address size ID
8745 Configure RTT for the currently selected target.
8746 Once RTT is started, OpenOCD searches for a control block with the
8747 identifier @var{ID} starting at the memory address @var{address} within the next
8748 @var{size} bytes.
8749 @end deffn
8750
8751 @deffn {Command} {rtt start}
8752 Start RTT.
8753 If the control block location is not known, OpenOCD starts searching for it.
8754 @end deffn
8755
8756 @deffn {Command} {rtt stop}
8757 Stop RTT.
8758 @end deffn
8759
8760 @deffn {Command} {rtt polling_interval} [interval]
8761 Display the polling interval.
8762 If @var{interval} is provided, set the polling interval.
8763 The polling interval determines (in milliseconds) how often the up-channels are
8764 checked for new data.
8765 @end deffn
8766
8767 @deffn {Command} {rtt channels}
8768 Display a list of all channels and their properties.
8769 @end deffn
8770
8771 @deffn {Command} {rtt channellist}
8772 Return a list of all channels and their properties as Tcl list.
8773 The list can be manipulated easily from within scripts.
8774 @end deffn
8775
8776 @deffn {Command} {rtt server start} port channel
8777 Start a TCP server on @var{port} for the channel @var{channel}.
8778 @end deffn
8779
8780 @deffn {Command} {rtt server stop} port
8781 Stop the TCP sever with port @var{port}.
8782 @end deffn
8783
8784 The following example shows how to setup RTT using the SEGGER RTT implementation
8785 on the target device.
8786
8787 @example
8788 resume
8789
8790 rtt setup 0x20000000 2048 "SEGGER RTT"
8791 rtt start
8792
8793 rtt server start 9090 0
8794 @end example
8795
8796 In this example, OpenOCD searches the control block with the ID "SEGGER RTT"
8797 starting at 0x20000000 for 2048 bytes. The RTT channel 0 is exposed through the
8798 TCP/IP port 9090.
8799
8800
8801 @section Misc Commands
8802
8803 @cindex profiling
8804 @deffn {Command} {profile} seconds filename [start end]
8805 Profiling samples the CPU's program counter as quickly as possible,
8806 which is useful for non-intrusive stochastic profiling.
8807 Saves up to 10000 samples in @file{filename} using ``gmon.out''
8808 format. Optional @option{start} and @option{end} parameters allow to
8809 limit the address range.
8810 @end deffn
8811
8812 @deffn {Command} {version}
8813 Displays a string identifying the version of this OpenOCD server.
8814 @end deffn
8815
8816 @deffn {Command} {virt2phys} virtual_address
8817 Requests the current target to map the specified @var{virtual_address}
8818 to its corresponding physical address, and displays the result.
8819 @end deffn
8820
8821 @deffn {Command} {add_help_text} 'command_name' 'help-string'
8822 Add or replace help text on the given @var{command_name}.
8823 @end deffn
8824
8825 @deffn {Command} {add_usage_text} 'command_name' 'help-string'
8826 Add or replace usage text on the given @var{command_name}.
8827 @end deffn
8828
8829 @node Architecture and Core Commands
8830 @chapter Architecture and Core Commands
8831 @cindex Architecture Specific Commands
8832 @cindex Core Specific Commands
8833
8834 Most CPUs have specialized JTAG operations to support debugging.
8835 OpenOCD packages most such operations in its standard command framework.
8836 Some of those operations don't fit well in that framework, so they are
8837 exposed here as architecture or implementation (core) specific commands.
8838
8839 @anchor{armhardwaretracing}
8840 @section ARM Hardware Tracing
8841 @cindex tracing
8842 @cindex ETM
8843 @cindex ETB
8844
8845 CPUs based on ARM cores may include standard tracing interfaces,
8846 based on an ``Embedded Trace Module'' (ETM) which sends voluminous
8847 address and data bus trace records to a ``Trace Port''.
8848
8849 @itemize
8850 @item
8851 Development-oriented boards will sometimes provide a high speed
8852 trace connector for collecting that data, when the particular CPU
8853 supports such an interface.
8854 (The standard connector is a 38-pin Mictor, with both JTAG
8855 and trace port support.)
8856 Those trace connectors are supported by higher end JTAG adapters
8857 and some logic analyzer modules; frequently those modules can
8858 buffer several megabytes of trace data.
8859 Configuring an ETM coupled to such an external trace port belongs
8860 in the board-specific configuration file.
8861 @item
8862 If the CPU doesn't provide an external interface, it probably
8863 has an ``Embedded Trace Buffer'' (ETB) on the chip, which is a
8864 dedicated SRAM. 4KBytes is one common ETB size.
8865 Configuring an ETM coupled only to an ETB belongs in the CPU-specific
8866 (target) configuration file, since it works the same on all boards.
8867 @end itemize
8868
8869 ETM support in OpenOCD doesn't seem to be widely used yet.
8870
8871 @quotation Issues
8872 ETM support may be buggy, and at least some @command{etm config}
8873 parameters should be detected by asking the ETM for them.
8874
8875 ETM trigger events could also implement a kind of complex
8876 hardware breakpoint, much more powerful than the simple
8877 watchpoint hardware exported by EmbeddedICE modules.
8878 @emph{Such breakpoints can be triggered even when using the
8879 dummy trace port driver}.
8880
8881 It seems like a GDB hookup should be possible,
8882 as well as tracing only during specific states
8883 (perhaps @emph{handling IRQ 23} or @emph{calls foo()}).
8884
8885 There should be GUI tools to manipulate saved trace data and help
8886 analyse it in conjunction with the source code.
8887 It's unclear how much of a common interface is shared
8888 with the current XScale trace support, or should be
8889 shared with eventual Nexus-style trace module support.
8890
8891 At this writing (November 2009) only ARM7, ARM9, and ARM11 support
8892 for ETM modules is available. The code should be able to
8893 work with some newer cores; but not all of them support
8894 this original style of JTAG access.
8895 @end quotation
8896
8897 @subsection ETM Configuration
8898 ETM setup is coupled with the trace port driver configuration.
8899
8900 @deffn {Config Command} {etm config} target width mode clocking driver
8901 Declares the ETM associated with @var{target}, and associates it
8902 with a given trace port @var{driver}. @xref{traceportdrivers,,Trace Port Drivers}.
8903
8904 Several of the parameters must reflect the trace port capabilities,
8905 which are a function of silicon capabilities (exposed later
8906 using @command{etm info}) and of what hardware is connected to
8907 that port (such as an external pod, or ETB).
8908 The @var{width} must be either 4, 8, or 16,
8909 except with ETMv3.0 and newer modules which may also
8910 support 1, 2, 24, 32, 48, and 64 bit widths.
8911 (With those versions, @command{etm info} also shows whether
8912 the selected port width and mode are supported.)
8913
8914 The @var{mode} must be @option{normal}, @option{multiplexed},
8915 or @option{demultiplexed}.
8916 The @var{clocking} must be @option{half} or @option{full}.
8917
8918 @quotation Warning
8919 With ETMv3.0 and newer, the bits set with the @var{mode} and
8920 @var{clocking} parameters both control the mode.
8921 This modified mode does not map to the values supported by
8922 previous ETM modules, so this syntax is subject to change.
8923 @end quotation
8924
8925 @quotation Note
8926 You can see the ETM registers using the @command{reg} command.
8927 Not all possible registers are present in every ETM.
8928 Most of the registers are write-only, and are used to configure
8929 what CPU activities are traced.
8930 @end quotation
8931 @end deffn
8932
8933 @deffn {Command} {etm info}
8934 Displays information about the current target's ETM.
8935 This includes resource counts from the @code{ETM_CONFIG} register,
8936 as well as silicon capabilities (except on rather old modules).
8937 from the @code{ETM_SYS_CONFIG} register.
8938 @end deffn
8939
8940 @deffn {Command} {etm status}
8941 Displays status of the current target's ETM and trace port driver:
8942 is the ETM idle, or is it collecting data?
8943 Did trace data overflow?
8944 Was it triggered?
8945 @end deffn
8946
8947 @deffn {Command} {etm tracemode} [type context_id_bits cycle_accurate branch_output]
8948 Displays what data that ETM will collect.
8949 If arguments are provided, first configures that data.
8950 When the configuration changes, tracing is stopped
8951 and any buffered trace data is invalidated.
8952
8953 @itemize
8954 @item @var{type} ... describing how data accesses are traced,
8955 when they pass any ViewData filtering that was set up.
8956 The value is one of
8957 @option{none} (save nothing),
8958 @option{data} (save data),
8959 @option{address} (save addresses),
8960 @option{all} (save data and addresses)
8961 @item @var{context_id_bits} ... 0, 8, 16, or 32
8962 @item @var{cycle_accurate} ... @option{enable} or @option{disable}
8963 cycle-accurate instruction tracing.
8964 Before ETMv3, enabling this causes much extra data to be recorded.
8965 @item @var{branch_output} ... @option{enable} or @option{disable}.
8966 Disable this unless you need to try reconstructing the instruction
8967 trace stream without an image of the code.
8968 @end itemize
8969 @end deffn
8970
8971 @deffn {Command} {etm trigger_debug} (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
8972 Displays whether ETM triggering debug entry (like a breakpoint) is
8973 enabled or disabled, after optionally modifying that configuration.
8974 The default behaviour is @option{disable}.
8975 Any change takes effect after the next @command{etm start}.
8976
8977 By using script commands to configure ETM registers, you can make the
8978 processor enter debug state automatically when certain conditions,
8979 more complex than supported by the breakpoint hardware, happen.
8980 @end deffn
8981
8982 @subsection ETM Trace Operation
8983
8984 After setting up the ETM, you can use it to collect data.
8985 That data can be exported to files for later analysis.
8986 It can also be parsed with OpenOCD, for basic sanity checking.
8987
8988 To configure what is being traced, you will need to write
8989 various trace registers using @command{reg ETM_*} commands.
8990 For the definitions of these registers, read ARM publication
8991 @emph{IHI 0014, ``Embedded Trace Macrocell, Architecture Specification''}.
8992 Be aware that most of the relevant registers are write-only,
8993 and that ETM resources are limited. There are only a handful
8994 of address comparators, data comparators, counters, and so on.
8995
8996 Examples of scenarios you might arrange to trace include:
8997
8998 @itemize
8999 @item Code flow within a function, @emph{excluding} subroutines
9000 it calls. Use address range comparators to enable tracing
9001 for instruction access within that function's body.
9002 @item Code flow within a function, @emph{including} subroutines
9003 it calls. Use the sequencer and address comparators to activate
9004 tracing on an ``entered function'' state, then deactivate it by
9005 exiting that state when the function's exit code is invoked.
9006 @item Code flow starting at the fifth invocation of a function,
9007 combining one of the above models with a counter.
9008 @item CPU data accesses to the registers for a particular device,
9009 using address range comparators and the ViewData logic.
9010 @item Such data accesses only during IRQ handling, combining the above
9011 model with sequencer triggers which on entry and exit to the IRQ handler.
9012 @item @emph{... more}
9013 @end itemize
9014
9015 At this writing, September 2009, there are no Tcl utility
9016 procedures to help set up any common tracing scenarios.
9017
9018 @deffn {Command} {etm analyze}
9019 Reads trace data into memory, if it wasn't already present.
9020 Decodes and prints the data that was collected.
9021 @end deffn
9022
9023 @deffn {Command} {etm dump} filename
9024 Stores the captured trace data in @file{filename}.
9025 @end deffn
9026
9027 @deffn {Command} {etm image} filename [base_address] [type]
9028 Opens an image file.
9029 @end deffn
9030
9031 @deffn {Command} {etm load} filename
9032 Loads captured trace data from @file{filename}.
9033 @end deffn
9034
9035 @deffn {Command} {etm start}
9036 Starts trace data collection.
9037 @end deffn
9038
9039 @deffn {Command} {etm stop}
9040 Stops trace data collection.
9041 @end deffn
9042
9043 @anchor{traceportdrivers}
9044 @subsection Trace Port Drivers
9045
9046 To use an ETM trace port it must be associated with a driver.
9047
9048 @deffn {Trace Port Driver} {dummy}
9049 Use the @option{dummy} driver if you are configuring an ETM that's
9050 not connected to anything (on-chip ETB or off-chip trace connector).
9051 @emph{This driver lets OpenOCD talk to the ETM, but it does not expose
9052 any trace data collection.}
9053 @deffn {Config Command} {etm_dummy config} target
9054 Associates the ETM for @var{target} with a dummy driver.
9055 @end deffn
9056 @end deffn
9057
9058 @deffn {Trace Port Driver} {etb}
9059 Use the @option{etb} driver if you are configuring an ETM
9060 to use on-chip ETB memory.
9061 @deffn {Config Command} {etb config} target etb_tap
9062 Associates the ETM for @var{target} with the ETB at @var{etb_tap}.
9063 You can see the ETB registers using the @command{reg} command.
9064 @end deffn
9065 @deffn {Command} {etb trigger_percent} [percent]
9066 This displays, or optionally changes, ETB behavior after the
9067 ETM's configured @emph{trigger} event fires.
9068 It controls how much more trace data is saved after the (single)
9069 trace trigger becomes active.
9070
9071 @itemize
9072 @item The default corresponds to @emph{trace around} usage,
9073 recording 50 percent data before the event and the rest
9074 afterwards.
9075 @item The minimum value of @var{percent} is 2 percent,
9076 recording almost exclusively data before the trigger.
9077 Such extreme @emph{trace before} usage can help figure out
9078 what caused that event to happen.
9079 @item The maximum value of @var{percent} is 100 percent,
9080 recording data almost exclusively after the event.
9081 This extreme @emph{trace after} usage might help sort out
9082 how the event caused trouble.
9083 @end itemize
9084 @c REVISIT allow "break" too -- enter debug mode.
9085 @end deffn
9086
9087 @end deffn
9088
9089 @anchor{armcrosstrigger}
9090 @section ARM Cross-Trigger Interface
9091 @cindex CTI
9092
9093 The ARM Cross-Trigger Interface (CTI) is a generic CoreSight component
9094 that connects event sources like tracing components or CPU cores with each
9095 other through a common trigger matrix (CTM). For ARMv8 architecture, a
9096 CTI is mandatory for core run control and each core has an individual
9097 CTI instance attached to it. OpenOCD has limited support for CTI using
9098 the @emph{cti} group of commands.
9099
9100 @deffn {Command} {cti create} cti_name @option{-dap} dap_name @option{-ap-num} apn @option{-baseaddr} base_address
9101 Creates a CTI instance @var{cti_name} on the DAP instance @var{dap_name} on MEM-AP
9102 @var{apn}. The @var{base_address} must match the base address of the CTI
9103 on the respective MEM-AP. All arguments are mandatory. This creates a
9104 new command @command{$cti_name} which is used for various purposes
9105 including additional configuration.
9106 @end deffn
9107
9108 @deffn {Command} {$cti_name enable} @option{on|off}
9109 Enable (@option{on}) or disable (@option{off}) the CTI.
9110 @end deffn
9111
9112 @deffn {Command} {$cti_name dump}
9113 Displays a register dump of the CTI.
9114 @end deffn
9115
9116 @deffn {Command} {$cti_name write} @var{reg_name} @var{value}
9117 Write @var{value} to the CTI register with the symbolic name @var{reg_name}.
9118 @end deffn
9119
9120 @deffn {Command} {$cti_name read} @var{reg_name}
9121 Print the value read from the CTI register with the symbolic name @var{reg_name}.
9122 @end deffn
9123
9124 @deffn {Command} {$cti_name ack} @var{event}
9125 Acknowledge a CTI @var{event}.
9126 @end deffn
9127
9128 @deffn {Command} {$cti_name channel} @var{channel_number} @var{operation}
9129 Perform a specific channel operation, the possible operations are:
9130 gate, ungate, set, clear and pulse
9131 @end deffn
9132
9133 @deffn {Command} {$cti_name testmode} @option{on|off}
9134 Enable (@option{on}) or disable (@option{off}) the integration test mode
9135 of the CTI.
9136 @end deffn
9137
9138 @deffn {Command} {cti names}
9139 Prints a list of names of all CTI objects created. This command is mainly
9140 useful in TCL scripting.
9141 @end deffn
9142
9143 @section Generic ARM
9144 @cindex ARM
9145
9146 These commands should be available on all ARM processors.
9147 They are available in addition to other core-specific
9148 commands that may be available.
9149
9150 @deffn {Command} {arm core_state} [@option{arm}|@option{thumb}]
9151 Displays the core_state, optionally changing it to process
9152 either @option{arm} or @option{thumb} instructions.
9153 The target may later be resumed in the currently set core_state.
9154 (Processors may also support the Jazelle state, but
9155 that is not currently supported in OpenOCD.)
9156 @end deffn
9157
9158 @deffn {Command} {arm disassemble} address [count [@option{thumb}]]
9159 @cindex disassemble
9160 Disassembles @var{count} instructions starting at @var{address}.
9161 If @var{count} is not specified, a single instruction is disassembled.
9162 If @option{thumb} is specified, or the low bit of the address is set,
9163 Thumb2 (mixed 16/32-bit) instructions are used;
9164 else ARM (32-bit) instructions are used.
9165 (Processors may also support the Jazelle state, but
9166 those instructions are not currently understood by OpenOCD.)
9167
9168 Note that all Thumb instructions are Thumb2 instructions,
9169 so older processors (without Thumb2 support) will still
9170 see correct disassembly of Thumb code.
9171 Also, ThumbEE opcodes are the same as Thumb2,
9172 with a handful of exceptions.
9173 ThumbEE disassembly currently has no explicit support.
9174 @end deffn
9175
9176 @deffn {Command} {arm mcr} pX op1 CRn CRm op2 value
9177 Write @var{value} to a coprocessor @var{pX} register
9178 passing parameters @var{CRn},
9179 @var{CRm}, opcodes @var{opc1} and @var{opc2},
9180 and using the MCR instruction.
9181 (Parameter sequence matches the ARM instruction, but omits
9182 an ARM register.)
9183 @end deffn
9184
9185 @deffn {Command} {arm mrc} pX coproc op1 CRn CRm op2
9186 Read a coprocessor @var{pX} register passing parameters @var{CRn},
9187 @var{CRm}, opcodes @var{opc1} and @var{opc2},
9188 and the MRC instruction.
9189 Returns the result so it can be manipulated by Jim scripts.
9190 (Parameter sequence matches the ARM instruction, but omits
9191 an ARM register.)
9192 @end deffn
9193
9194 @deffn {Command} {arm reg}
9195 Display a table of all banked core registers, fetching the current value from every
9196 core mode if necessary.
9197 @end deffn
9198
9199 @deffn {Command} {arm semihosting} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
9200 @cindex ARM semihosting
9201 Display status of semihosting, after optionally changing that status.
9202
9203 Semihosting allows for code executing on an ARM target to use the
9204 I/O facilities on the host computer i.e. the system where OpenOCD
9205 is running. The target application must be linked against a library
9206 implementing the ARM semihosting convention that forwards operation
9207 requests by using a special SVC instruction that is trapped at the
9208 Supervisor Call vector by OpenOCD.
9209 @end deffn
9210
9211 @deffn {Command} {arm semihosting_cmdline} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
9212 @cindex ARM semihosting
9213 Set the command line to be passed to the debugger.
9214
9215 @example
9216 arm semihosting_cmdline argv0 argv1 argv2 ...
9217 @end example
9218
9219 This option lets one set the command line arguments to be passed to
9220 the program. The first argument (argv0) is the program name in a
9221 standard C environment (argv[0]). Depending on the program (not much
9222 programs look at argv[0]), argv0 is ignored and can be any string.
9223 @end deffn
9224
9225 @deffn {Command} {arm semihosting_fileio} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
9226 @cindex ARM semihosting
9227 Display status of semihosting fileio, after optionally changing that
9228 status.
9229
9230 Enabling this option forwards semihosting I/O to GDB process using the
9231 File-I/O remote protocol extension. This is especially useful for
9232 interacting with remote files or displaying console messages in the
9233 debugger.
9234 @end deffn
9235
9236 @deffn {Command} {arm semihosting_resexit} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
9237 @cindex ARM semihosting
9238 Enable resumable SEMIHOSTING_SYS_EXIT.
9239
9240 When SEMIHOSTING_SYS_EXIT is called outside a debug session,
9241 things are simple, the openocd process calls exit() and passes
9242 the value returned by the target.
9243
9244 When SEMIHOSTING_SYS_EXIT is called during a debug session,
9245 by default execution returns to the debugger, leaving the
9246 debugger in a HALT state, similar to the state entered when
9247 encountering a break.
9248
9249 In some use cases, it is useful to have SEMIHOSTING_SYS_EXIT
9250 return normally, as any semihosting call, and do not break
9251 to the debugger.
9252 The standard allows this to happen, but the condition
9253 to trigger it is a bit obscure ("by performing an RDI_Execute
9254 request or equivalent").
9255
9256 To make the SEMIHOSTING_SYS_EXIT call return normally, enable
9257 this option (default: disabled).
9258 @end deffn
9259
9260 @deffn {Command} {arm semihosting_read_user_param}
9261 @cindex ARM semihosting
9262 Read parameter of the semihosting call from the target. Usable in
9263 semihosting-user-cmd-0x10* event handlers, returning a string.
9264
9265 When the target makes semihosting call with operation number from range 0x100-
9266 0x107, an optional string parameter can be passed to the server. This parameter
9267 is valid during the run of the event handlers and is accessible with this
9268 command.
9269 @end deffn
9270
9271 @section ARMv4 and ARMv5 Architecture
9272 @cindex ARMv4
9273 @cindex ARMv5
9274
9275 The ARMv4 and ARMv5 architectures are widely used in embedded systems,
9276 and introduced core parts of the instruction set in use today.
9277 That includes the Thumb instruction set, introduced in the ARMv4T
9278 variant.
9279
9280 @subsection ARM7 and ARM9 specific commands
9281 @cindex ARM7
9282 @cindex ARM9
9283
9284 These commands are specific to ARM7 and ARM9 cores, like ARM7TDMI, ARM720T,
9285 ARM9TDMI, ARM920T or ARM926EJ-S.
9286 They are available in addition to the ARM commands,
9287 and any other core-specific commands that may be available.
9288
9289 @deffn {Command} {arm7_9 dbgrq} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
9290 Displays the value of the flag controlling use of the
9291 EmbeddedIce DBGRQ signal to force entry into debug mode,
9292 instead of breakpoints.
9293 If a boolean parameter is provided, first assigns that flag.
9294
9295 This should be
9296 safe for all but ARM7TDMI-S cores (like NXP LPC).
9297 This feature is enabled by default on most ARM9 cores,
9298 including ARM9TDMI, ARM920T, and ARM926EJ-S.
9299 @end deffn
9300
9301 @deffn {Command} {arm7_9 dcc_downloads} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
9302 @cindex DCC
9303 Displays the value of the flag controlling use of the debug communications
9304 channel (DCC) to write larger (>128 byte) amounts of memory.
9305 If a boolean parameter is provided, first assigns that flag.
9306
9307 DCC downloads offer a huge speed increase, but might be
9308 unsafe, especially with targets running at very low speeds. This command was introduced
9309 with OpenOCD rev. 60, and requires a few bytes of working area.
9310 @end deffn
9311
9312 @deffn {Command} {arm7_9 fast_memory_access} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
9313 Displays the value of the flag controlling use of memory writes and reads
9314 that don't check completion of the operation.
9315 If a boolean parameter is provided, first assigns that flag.
9316
9317 This provides a huge speed increase, especially with USB JTAG
9318 cables (FT2232), but might be unsafe if used with targets running at very low
9319 speeds, like the 32kHz startup clock of an AT91RM9200.
9320 @end deffn
9321
9322 @subsection ARM9 specific commands
9323 @cindex ARM9
9324
9325 ARM9-family cores are built around ARM9TDMI or ARM9E (including ARM9EJS)
9326 integer processors.
9327 Such cores include the ARM920T, ARM926EJ-S, and ARM966.
9328
9329 @c 9-june-2009: tried this on arm920t, it didn't work.
9330 @c no-params always lists nothing caught, and that's how it acts.
9331 @c 23-oct-2009: doesn't work _consistently_ ... as if the ICE
9332 @c versions have different rules about when they commit writes.
9333
9334 @anchor{arm9vectorcatch}
9335 @deffn {Command} {arm9 vector_catch} [@option{all}|@option{none}|list]
9336 @cindex vector_catch
9337 Vector Catch hardware provides a sort of dedicated breakpoint
9338 for hardware events such as reset, interrupt, and abort.
9339 You can use this to conserve normal breakpoint resources,
9340 so long as you're not concerned with code that branches directly
9341 to those hardware vectors.
9342
9343 This always finishes by listing the current configuration.
9344 If parameters are provided, it first reconfigures the
9345 vector catch hardware to intercept
9346 @option{all} of the hardware vectors,
9347 @option{none} of them,
9348 or a list with one or more of the following:
9349 @option{reset} @option{undef} @option{swi} @option{pabt} @option{dabt}
9350 @option{irq} @option{fiq}.
9351 @end deffn
9352
9353 @subsection ARM920T specific commands
9354 @cindex ARM920T
9355
9356 These commands are available to ARM920T based CPUs,
9357 which are implementations of the ARMv4T architecture
9358 built using the ARM9TDMI integer core.
9359 They are available in addition to the ARM, ARM7/ARM9,
9360 and ARM9 commands.
9361
9362 @deffn {Command} {arm920t cache_info}
9363 Print information about the caches found. This allows to see whether your target
9364 is an ARM920T (2x16kByte cache) or ARM922T (2x8kByte cache).
9365 @end deffn
9366
9367 @deffn {Command} {arm920t cp15} regnum [value]
9368 Display cp15 register @var{regnum};
9369 else if a @var{value} is provided, that value is written to that register.
9370 This uses "physical access" and the register number is as
9371 shown in bits 38..33 of table 9-9 in the ARM920T TRM.
9372 (Not all registers can be written.)
9373 @end deffn
9374
9375 @deffn {Command} {arm920t read_cache} filename
9376 Dump the content of ICache and DCache to a file named @file{filename}.
9377 @end deffn
9378
9379 @deffn {Command} {arm920t read_mmu} filename
9380 Dump the content of the ITLB and DTLB to a file named @file{filename}.
9381 @end deffn
9382
9383 @subsection ARM926ej-s specific commands
9384 @cindex ARM926ej-s
9385
9386 These commands are available to ARM926ej-s based CPUs,
9387 which are implementations of the ARMv5TEJ architecture
9388 based on the ARM9EJ-S integer core.
9389 They are available in addition to the ARM, ARM7/ARM9,
9390 and ARM9 commands.
9391
9392 The Feroceon cores also support these commands, although
9393 they are not built from ARM926ej-s designs.
9394
9395 @deffn {Command} {arm926ejs cache_info}
9396 Print information about the caches found.
9397 @end deffn
9398
9399 @subsection ARM966E specific commands
9400 @cindex ARM966E
9401
9402 These commands are available to ARM966 based CPUs,
9403 which are implementations of the ARMv5TE architecture.
9404 They are available in addition to the ARM, ARM7/ARM9,
9405 and ARM9 commands.
9406
9407 @deffn {Command} {arm966e cp15} regnum [value]
9408 Display cp15 register @var{regnum};
9409 else if a @var{value} is provided, that value is written to that register.
9410 The six bit @var{regnum} values are bits 37..32 from table 7-2 of the
9411 ARM966E-S TRM.
9412 There is no current control over bits 31..30 from that table,
9413 as required for BIST support.
9414 @end deffn
9415
9416 @subsection XScale specific commands
9417 @cindex XScale
9418
9419 Some notes about the debug implementation on the XScale CPUs:
9420
9421 The XScale CPU provides a special debug-only mini-instruction cache
9422 (mini-IC) in which exception vectors and target-resident debug handler
9423 code are placed by OpenOCD. In order to get access to the CPU, OpenOCD
9424 must point vector 0 (the reset vector) to the entry of the debug
9425 handler. However, this means that the complete first cacheline in the
9426 mini-IC is marked valid, which makes the CPU fetch all exception
9427 handlers from the mini-IC, ignoring the code in RAM.
9428
9429 To address this situation, OpenOCD provides the @code{xscale
9430 vector_table} command, which allows the user to explicitly write
9431 individual entries to either the high or low vector table stored in
9432 the mini-IC.
9433
9434 It is recommended to place a pc-relative indirect branch in the vector
9435 table, and put the branch destination somewhere in memory. Doing so
9436 makes sure the code in the vector table stays constant regardless of
9437 code layout in memory:
9438 @example
9439 _vectors:
9440 ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
9441 ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
9442 ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
9443 ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
9444 ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
9445 ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
9446 ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
9447 ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
9448 .org 0x100
9449 .long real_reset_vector
9450 .long real_ui_handler
9451 .long real_swi_handler
9452 .long real_pf_abort
9453 .long real_data_abort
9454 .long 0 /* unused */
9455 .long real_irq_handler
9456 .long real_fiq_handler
9457 @end example
9458
9459 Alternatively, you may choose to keep some or all of the mini-IC
9460 vector table entries synced with those written to memory by your
9461 system software. The mini-IC can not be modified while the processor
9462 is executing, but for each vector table entry not previously defined
9463 using the @code{xscale vector_table} command, OpenOCD will copy the
9464 value from memory to the mini-IC every time execution resumes from a
9465 halt. This is done for both high and low vector tables (although the
9466 table not in use may not be mapped to valid memory, and in this case
9467 that copy operation will silently fail). This means that you will
9468 need to briefly halt execution at some strategic point during system
9469 start-up; e.g., after the software has initialized the vector table,
9470 but before exceptions are enabled. A breakpoint can be used to
9471 accomplish this once the appropriate location in the start-up code has
9472 been identified. A watchpoint over the vector table region is helpful
9473 in finding the location if you're not sure. Note that the same
9474 situation exists any time the vector table is modified by the system
9475 software.
9476
9477 The debug handler must be placed somewhere in the address space using
9478 the @code{xscale debug_handler} command. The allowed locations for the
9479 debug handler are either (0x800 - 0x1fef800) or (0xfe000800 -
9480 0xfffff800). The default value is 0xfe000800.
9481
9482 XScale has resources to support two hardware breakpoints and two
9483 watchpoints. However, the following restrictions on watchpoint
9484 functionality apply: (1) the value and mask arguments to the @code{wp}
9485 command are not supported, (2) the watchpoint length must be a
9486 power of two and not less than four, and can not be greater than the
9487 watchpoint address, and (3) a watchpoint with a length greater than
9488 four consumes all the watchpoint hardware resources. This means that
9489 at any one time, you can have enabled either two watchpoints with a
9490 length of four, or one watchpoint with a length greater than four.
9491
9492 These commands are available to XScale based CPUs,
9493 which are implementations of the ARMv5TE architecture.
9494
9495 @deffn {Command} {xscale analyze_trace}
9496 Displays the contents of the trace buffer.
9497 @end deffn
9498
9499 @deffn {Command} {xscale cache_clean_address} address
9500 Changes the address used when cleaning the data cache.
9501 @end deffn
9502
9503 @deffn {Command} {xscale cache_info}
9504 Displays information about the CPU caches.
9505 @end deffn
9506
9507 @deffn {Command} {xscale cp15} regnum [value]
9508 Display cp15 register @var{regnum};
9509 else if a @var{value} is provided, that value is written to that register.
9510 @end deffn
9511
9512 @deffn {Command} {xscale debug_handler} target address
9513 Changes the address used for the specified target's debug handler.
9514 @end deffn
9515
9516 @deffn {Command} {xscale dcache} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
9517 Enables or disable the CPU's data cache.
9518 @end deffn
9519
9520 @deffn {Command} {xscale dump_trace} filename
9521 Dumps the raw contents of the trace buffer to @file{filename}.
9522 @end deffn
9523
9524 @deffn {Command} {xscale icache} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
9525 Enables or disable the CPU's instruction cache.
9526 @end deffn
9527
9528 @deffn {Command} {xscale mmu} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
9529 Enables or disable the CPU's memory management unit.
9530 @end deffn
9531
9532 @deffn {Command} {xscale trace_buffer} [@option{enable}|@option{disable} [@option{fill} [n] | @option{wrap}]]
9533 Displays the trace buffer status, after optionally
9534 enabling or disabling the trace buffer
9535 and modifying how it is emptied.
9536 @end deffn
9537
9538 @deffn {Command} {xscale trace_image} filename [offset [type]]
9539 Opens a trace image from @file{filename}, optionally rebasing
9540 its segment addresses by @var{offset}.
9541 The image @var{type} may be one of
9542 @option{bin} (binary), @option{ihex} (Intel hex),
9543 @option{elf} (ELF file), @option{s19} (Motorola s19),
9544 @option{mem}, or @option{builder}.
9545 @end deffn
9546
9547 @anchor{xscalevectorcatch}
9548 @deffn {Command} {xscale vector_catch} [mask]
9549 @cindex vector_catch
9550 Display a bitmask showing the hardware vectors to catch.
9551 If the optional parameter is provided, first set the bitmask to that value.
9552
9553 The mask bits correspond with bit 16..23 in the DCSR:
9554 @example
9555 0x01 Trap Reset
9556 0x02 Trap Undefined Instructions
9557 0x04 Trap Software Interrupt
9558 0x08 Trap Prefetch Abort
9559 0x10 Trap Data Abort
9560 0x20 reserved
9561 0x40 Trap IRQ
9562 0x80 Trap FIQ
9563 @end example
9564 @end deffn
9565
9566 @deffn {Command} {xscale vector_table} [(@option{low}|@option{high}) index value]
9567 @cindex vector_table
9568
9569 Set an entry in the mini-IC vector table. There are two tables: one for
9570 low vectors (at 0x00000000), and one for high vectors (0xFFFF0000), each
9571 holding the 8 exception vectors. @var{index} can be 1-7, because vector 0
9572 points to the debug handler entry and can not be overwritten.
9573 @var{value} holds the 32-bit opcode that is placed in the mini-IC.
9574
9575 Without arguments, the current settings are displayed.
9576
9577 @end deffn
9578
9579 @section ARMv6 Architecture
9580 @cindex ARMv6
9581
9582 @subsection ARM11 specific commands
9583 @cindex ARM11
9584
9585 @deffn {Command} {arm11 memwrite burst} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
9586 Displays the value of the memwrite burst-enable flag,
9587 which is enabled by default.
9588 If a boolean parameter is provided, first assigns that flag.
9589 Burst writes are only used for memory writes larger than 1 word.
9590 They improve performance by assuming that the CPU has read each data
9591 word over JTAG and completed its write before the next word arrives,
9592 instead of polling for a status flag to verify that completion.
9593 This is usually safe, because JTAG runs much slower than the CPU.
9594 @end deffn
9595
9596 @deffn {Command} {arm11 memwrite error_fatal} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
9597 Displays the value of the memwrite error_fatal flag,
9598 which is enabled by default.
9599 If a boolean parameter is provided, first assigns that flag.
9600 When set, certain memory write errors cause earlier transfer termination.
9601 @end deffn
9602
9603 @deffn {Command} {arm11 step_irq_enable} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
9604 Displays the value of the flag controlling whether
9605 IRQs are enabled during single stepping;
9606 they are disabled by default.
9607 If a boolean parameter is provided, first assigns that.
9608 @end deffn
9609
9610 @deffn {Command} {arm11 vcr} [value]
9611 @cindex vector_catch
9612 Displays the value of the @emph{Vector Catch Register (VCR)},
9613 coprocessor 14 register 7.
9614 If @var{value} is defined, first assigns that.
9615
9616 Vector Catch hardware provides dedicated breakpoints
9617 for certain hardware events.
9618 The specific bit values are core-specific (as in fact is using
9619 coprocessor 14 register 7 itself) but all current ARM11
9620 cores @emph{except the ARM1176} use the same six bits.
9621 @end deffn
9622
9623 @section ARMv7 and ARMv8 Architecture
9624 @cindex ARMv7
9625 @cindex ARMv8
9626
9627 @subsection ARMv7-A specific commands
9628 @cindex Cortex-A
9629
9630 @deffn {Command} {cortex_a cache_info}
9631 display information about target caches
9632 @end deffn
9633
9634 @deffn {Command} {cortex_a dacrfixup} [@option{on}|@option{off}]
9635 Work around issues with software breakpoints when the program text is
9636 mapped read-only by the operating system. This option sets the CP15 DACR
9637 to "all-manager" to bypass MMU permission checks on memory access.
9638 Defaults to 'off'.
9639 @end deffn
9640
9641 @deffn {Command} {cortex_a dbginit}
9642 Initialize core debug
9643 Enables debug by unlocking the Software Lock and clearing sticky powerdown indications
9644 @end deffn
9645
9646 @deffn {Command} {cortex_a smp} [on|off]
9647 Display/set the current SMP mode
9648 @end deffn
9649
9650 @deffn {Command} {cortex_a smp_gdb} [core_id]
9651 Display/set the current core displayed in GDB
9652 @end deffn
9653
9654 @deffn {Command} {cortex_a maskisr} [@option{on}|@option{off}]
9655 Selects whether interrupts will be processed when single stepping
9656 @end deffn
9657
9658 @deffn {Command} {cache_config l2x} [base way]
9659 configure l2x cache
9660 @end deffn
9661
9662 @deffn {Command} {cortex_a mmu dump} [@option{0}|@option{1}|@option{addr} address [@option{num_entries}]]
9663 Dump the MMU translation table from TTB0 or TTB1 register, or from physical
9664 memory location @var{address}. When dumping the table from @var{address}, print at most
9665 @var{num_entries} page table entries. @var{num_entries} is optional, if omitted, the maximum
9666 possible (4096) entries are printed.
9667 @end deffn
9668
9669 @subsection ARMv7-R specific commands
9670 @cindex Cortex-R
9671
9672 @deffn {Command} {cortex_r4 dbginit}
9673 Initialize core debug
9674 Enables debug by unlocking the Software Lock and clearing sticky powerdown indications
9675 @end deffn
9676
9677 @deffn {Command} {cortex_r4 maskisr} [@option{on}|@option{off}]
9678 Selects whether interrupts will be processed when single stepping
9679 @end deffn
9680
9681
9682 @subsection ARM CoreSight TPIU and SWO specific commands
9683 @cindex tracing
9684 @cindex SWO
9685 @cindex SWV
9686 @cindex TPIU
9687
9688 ARM CoreSight provides several modules to generate debugging
9689 information internally (ITM, DWT and ETM). Their output is directed
9690 through TPIU or SWO modules to be captured externally either on an SWO pin (this
9691 configuration is called SWV) or on a synchronous parallel trace port.
9692
9693 ARM CoreSight provides independent HW blocks named TPIU and SWO each with its
9694 own functionality. Embedded in Cortex-M3 and M4, ARM provides an optional HW
9695 block that includes both TPIU and SWO functionalities and is again named TPIU,
9696 which causes quite some confusion.
9697 The registers map of all the TPIU and SWO implementations allows using a single
9698 driver that detects at runtime the features available.
9699
9700 The @command{tpiu} is used for either TPIU or SWO.
9701 A convenient alias @command{swo} is available to help distinguish, in scripts,
9702 the commands for SWO from the commands for TPIU.
9703
9704 @deffn {Command} {swo} ...
9705 Alias of @command{tpiu ...}. Can be used in scripts to distinguish the commands
9706 for SWO from the commands for TPIU.
9707 @end deffn
9708
9709 @deffn {Command} {tpiu create} tpiu_name configparams...
9710 Creates a TPIU or a SWO object. The two commands are equivalent.
9711 Add the object in a list and add new commands (@command{@var{tpiu_name}})
9712 which are used for various purposes including additional configuration.
9713
9714 @itemize @bullet
9715 @item @var{tpiu_name} -- the name of the TPIU or SWO object.
9716 This name is also used to create the object's command, referred to here
9717 as @command{$tpiu_name}, and in other places where the TPIU or SWO needs to be identified.
9718 @item @var{configparams} -- all parameters accepted by @command{$tpiu_name configure} are permitted.
9719
9720 You @emph{must} set here the AP and MEM_AP base_address through @code{-dap @var{dap_name}},
9721 @code{-ap-num @var{ap_number}} and @code{-baseaddr @var{base_address}}.
9722 @end itemize
9723 @end deffn
9724
9725 @deffn {Command} {tpiu names}
9726 Lists all the TPIU or SWO objects created so far. The two commands are equivalent.
9727 @end deffn
9728
9729 @deffn {Command} {tpiu init}
9730 Initialize all registered TPIU and SWO. The two commands are equivalent.
9731 These commands are used internally during initialization. They can be issued
9732 at any time after the initialization, too.
9733 @end deffn
9734
9735 @deffn {Command} {$tpiu_name cget} queryparm
9736 Each configuration parameter accepted by @command{$tpiu_name configure} can be
9737 individually queried, to return its current value.
9738 The @var{queryparm} is a parameter name accepted by that command, such as @code{-dap}.
9739 @end deffn
9740
9741 @deffn {Command} {$tpiu_name configure} configparams...
9742 The options accepted by this command may also be specified as parameters
9743 to @command{tpiu create}. Their values can later be queried one at a time by
9744 using the @command{$tpiu_name cget} command.
9745
9746 @itemize @bullet
9747 @item @code{-dap} @var{dap_name} -- names the DAP used to access this
9748 TPIU. @xref{dapdeclaration,,DAP declaration}, on how to create and manage DAP instances.
9749
9750 @item @code{-ap-num} @var{ap_number} -- sets DAP access port for TPIU,
9751 @var{ap_number} is the numeric index of the DAP AP the TPIU is connected to.
9752
9753 @item @code{-baseaddr} @var{base_address} -- sets the TPIU @var{base_address} where
9754 to access the TPIU in the DAP AP memory space.
9755
9756 @item @code{-protocol} (@option{sync}|@option{uart}|@option{manchester}) -- sets the
9757 protocol used for trace data:
9758 @itemize @minus
9759 @item @option{sync} -- synchronous parallel trace output mode, using @var{port_width}
9760 data bits (default);
9761 @item @option{uart} -- use asynchronous SWO mode with NRZ (same as regular UART 8N1) coding;
9762 @item @option{manchester} -- use asynchronous SWO mode with Manchester coding.
9763 @end itemize
9764
9765 @item @code{-event} @var{event_name} @var{event_body} -- assigns an event handler,
9766 a TCL string which is evaluated when the event is triggered. The events
9767 @code{pre-enable}, @code{post-enable}, @code{pre-disable} and @code{post-disable}
9768 are defined for TPIU/SWO.
9769 A typical use case for the event @code{pre-enable} is to enable the trace clock
9770 of the TPIU.
9771
9772 @item @code{-output} (@option{external}|@option{:}@var{port}|@var{filename}|@option{-}) -- specifies
9773 the destination of the trace data:
9774 @itemize @minus
9775 @item @option{external} -- configure TPIU/SWO to let user capture trace
9776 output externally, either with an additional UART or with a logic analyzer (default);
9777 @item @option{-} -- configure TPIU/SWO and debug adapter to gather trace data
9778 and forward it to @command{tcl_trace} command;
9779 @item @option{:}@var{port} -- configure TPIU/SWO and debug adapter to gather
9780 trace data, open a TCP server at port @var{port} and send the trace data to
9781 each connected client;
9782 @item @var{filename} -- configure TPIU/SWO and debug adapter to
9783 gather trace data and append it to @var{filename}, which can be
9784 either a regular file or a named pipe.
9785 @end itemize
9786
9787 @item @code{-traceclk} @var{TRACECLKIN_freq} -- mandatory parameter.
9788 Specifies the frequency in Hz of the trace clock. For the TPIU embedded in
9789 Cortex-M3 or M4, this is usually the same frequency as HCLK. For protocol
9790 @option{sync} this is twice the frequency of the pin data rate.
9791
9792 @item @code{-pin-freq} @var{trace_freq} -- specifies the expected data rate
9793 in Hz of the SWO pin. Parameter used only on protocols @option{uart} and
9794 @option{manchester}. Can be omitted to let the adapter driver select the
9795 maximum supported rate automatically.
9796
9797 @item @code{-port-width} @var{port_width} -- sets to @var{port_width} the width
9798 of the synchronous parallel port used for trace output. Parameter used only on
9799 protocol @option{sync}. If not specified, default value is @var{1}.
9800
9801 @item @code{-formatter} (@option{0}|@option{1}) -- specifies if the formatter
9802 should be enabled. Parameter used only on protocol @option{sync}. If not specified,
9803 default value is @var{0}.
9804 @end itemize
9805 @end deffn
9806
9807 @deffn {Command} {$tpiu_name enable}
9808 Uses the parameters specified by the previous @command{$tpiu_name configure}
9809 to configure and enable the TPIU or the SWO.
9810 If required, the adapter is also configured and enabled to receive the trace
9811 data.
9812 This command can be used before @command{init}, but it will take effect only
9813 after the @command{init}.
9814 @end deffn
9815
9816 @deffn {Command} {$tpiu_name disable}
9817 Disable the TPIU or the SWO, terminating the receiving of the trace data.
9818 @end deffn
9819
9820
9821
9822 Example usage:
9823 @enumerate
9824 @item STM32L152 board is programmed with an application that configures
9825 PLL to provide core clock with 24MHz frequency; to use ITM output it's
9826 enough to:
9827 @example
9828 #include <libopencm3/cm3/itm.h>
9829 ...
9830 ITM_STIM8(0) = c;
9831 ...
9832 @end example
9833 (the most obvious way is to use the first stimulus port for printf,
9834 for that this ITM_STIM8 assignment can be used inside _write(); to make it
9835 blocking to avoid data loss, add @code{while (!(ITM_STIM8(0) &
9836 ITM_STIM_FIFOREADY));});
9837 @item An FT2232H UART is connected to the SWO pin of the board;
9838 @item Commands to configure UART for 12MHz baud rate:
9839 @example
9840 $ setserial /dev/ttyUSB1 spd_cust divisor 5
9841 $ stty -F /dev/ttyUSB1 38400
9842 @end example
9843 (FT2232H's base frequency is 60MHz, spd_cust allows to alias 38400
9844 baud with our custom divisor to get 12MHz)
9845 @item @code{itmdump -f /dev/ttyUSB1 -d1}
9846 @item OpenOCD invocation line:
9847 @example
9848 openocd -f interface/stlink.cfg \
9849 -c "transport select hla_swd" \
9850 -f target/stm32l1.cfg \
9851 -c "stm32l1.tpiu configure -protocol uart" \
9852 -c "stm32l1.tpiu configure -traceclk 24000000 -pin-freq 12000000" \
9853 -c "stm32l1.tpiu enable"
9854 @end example
9855 @end enumerate
9856
9857 @subsection ARMv7-M specific commands
9858 @cindex tracing
9859 @cindex SWO
9860 @cindex SWV
9861 @cindex ITM
9862 @cindex ETM
9863
9864 @deffn {Command} {itm port} @var{port} (@option{0}|@option{1}|@option{on}|@option{off})
9865 Enable or disable trace output for ITM stimulus @var{port} (counting
9866 from 0). Port 0 is enabled on target creation automatically.
9867 @end deffn
9868
9869 @deffn {Command} {itm ports} (@option{0}|@option{1}|@option{on}|@option{off})
9870 Enable or disable trace output for all ITM stimulus ports.
9871 @end deffn
9872
9873 @subsection Cortex-M specific commands
9874 @cindex Cortex-M
9875
9876 @deffn {Command} {cortex_m maskisr} (@option{auto}|@option{on}|@option{off}|@option{steponly})
9877 Control masking (disabling) interrupts during target step/resume.
9878
9879 The @option{auto} option handles interrupts during stepping in a way that they
9880 get served but don't disturb the program flow. The step command first allows
9881 pending interrupt handlers to execute, then disables interrupts and steps over
9882 the next instruction where the core was halted. After the step interrupts
9883 are enabled again. If the interrupt handlers don't complete within 500ms,
9884 the step command leaves with the core running.
9885
9886 The @option{steponly} option disables interrupts during single-stepping but
9887 enables them during normal execution. This can be used as a partial workaround
9888 for 702596 erratum in Cortex-M7 r0p1. See "Cortex-M7 (AT610) and Cortex-M7 with
9889 FPU (AT611) Software Developer Errata Notice" from ARM for further details.
9890
9891 Note that a free hardware (FPB) breakpoint is required for the @option{auto}
9892 option. If no breakpoint is available at the time of the step, then the step
9893 is taken with interrupts enabled, i.e. the same way the @option{off} option
9894 does.
9895
9896 Default is @option{auto}.
9897 @end deffn
9898
9899 @deffn {Command} {cortex_m vector_catch} [@option{all}|@option{none}|list]
9900 @cindex vector_catch
9901 Vector Catch hardware provides dedicated breakpoints
9902 for certain hardware events.
9903
9904 Parameters request interception of
9905 @option{all} of these hardware event vectors,
9906 @option{none} of them,
9907 or one or more of the following:
9908 @option{hard_err} for a HardFault exception;
9909 @option{mm_err} for a MemManage exception;
9910 @option{bus_err} for a BusFault exception;
9911 @option{irq_err},
9912 @option{state_err},
9913 @option{chk_err}, or
9914 @option{nocp_err} for various UsageFault exceptions; or
9915 @option{reset}.
9916 If NVIC setup code does not enable them,
9917 MemManage, BusFault, and UsageFault exceptions
9918 are mapped to HardFault.
9919 UsageFault checks for
9920 divide-by-zero and unaligned access
9921 must also be explicitly enabled.
9922
9923 This finishes by listing the current vector catch configuration.
9924 @end deffn
9925
9926 @deffn {Command} {cortex_m reset_config} (@option{sysresetreq}|@option{vectreset})
9927 Control reset handling if hardware srst is not fitted
9928 @xref{reset_config,,reset_config}.
9929
9930 @itemize @minus
9931 @item @option{sysresetreq} use AIRCR SYSRESETREQ to reset system.
9932 @item @option{vectreset} use AIRCR VECTRESET to reset system (default).
9933 @end itemize
9934
9935 Using @option{vectreset} is a safe option for Cortex-M3, M4 and M7 cores.
9936 This however has the disadvantage of only resetting the core, all peripherals
9937 are unaffected. A solution would be to use a @code{reset-init} event handler
9938 to manually reset the peripherals.
9939 @xref{targetevents,,Target Events}.
9940
9941 Cortex-M0, M0+ and M1 do not support @option{vectreset}, use @option{sysresetreq}
9942 instead.
9943 @end deffn
9944
9945 @subsection ARMv8-A specific commands
9946 @cindex ARMv8-A
9947 @cindex aarch64
9948
9949 @deffn {Command} {aarch64 cache_info}
9950 Display information about target caches
9951 @end deffn
9952
9953 @deffn {Command} {aarch64 dbginit}
9954 This command enables debugging by clearing the OS Lock and sticky power-down and reset
9955 indications. It also establishes the expected, basic cross-trigger configuration the aarch64
9956 target code relies on. In a configuration file, the command would typically be called from a
9957 @code{reset-end} or @code{reset-deassert-post} handler, to re-enable debugging after a system reset.
9958 However, normally it is not necessary to use the command at all.
9959 @end deffn
9960
9961 @deffn {Command} {aarch64 disassemble} address [count]
9962 @cindex disassemble
9963 Disassembles @var{count} instructions starting at @var{address}.
9964 If @var{count} is not specified, a single instruction is disassembled.
9965 @end deffn
9966
9967 @deffn {Command} {aarch64 smp} [on|off]
9968 Display, enable or disable SMP handling mode. The state of SMP handling influences the way targets in an SMP group
9969 are handled by the run control. With SMP handling enabled, issuing halt or resume to one core will trigger
9970 halting or resuming of all cores in the group. The command @code{target smp} defines which targets are in the SMP
9971 group. With SMP handling disabled, all targets need to be treated individually.
9972 @end deffn
9973
9974 @deffn {Command} {aarch64 maskisr} [@option{on}|@option{off}]
9975 Selects whether interrupts will be processed when single stepping. The default configuration is
9976 @option{on}.
9977 @end deffn
9978
9979 @deffn {Command} {$target_name catch_exc} [@option{off}|@option{sec_el1}|@option{sec_el3}|@option{nsec_el1}|@option{nsec_el2}]+
9980 Cause @command{$target_name} to halt when an exception is taken. Any combination of
9981 Secure (sec) EL1/EL3 or Non-Secure (nsec) EL1/EL2 is valid. The target
9982 @command{$target_name} will halt before taking the exception. In order to resume
9983 the target, the exception catch must be disabled again with @command{$target_name catch_exc off}.
9984 Issuing the command without options prints the current configuration.
9985 @end deffn
9986
9987 @section EnSilica eSi-RISC Architecture
9988
9989 eSi-RISC is a highly configurable microprocessor architecture for embedded systems
9990 provided by EnSilica. (See: @url{http://www.ensilica.com/risc-ip/}.)
9991
9992 @subsection eSi-RISC Configuration
9993
9994 @deffn {Command} {esirisc cache_arch} (@option{harvard}|@option{von_neumann})
9995 Configure the caching architecture. Targets with the @code{UNIFIED_ADDRESS_SPACE}
9996 option disabled employ a Harvard architecture. By default, @option{von_neumann} is assumed.
9997 @end deffn
9998
9999 @deffn {Command} {esirisc hwdc} (@option{all}|@option{none}|mask ...)
10000 Configure hardware debug control. The HWDC register controls which exceptions return
10001 control back to the debugger. Possible masks are @option{all}, @option{none},
10002 @option{reset}, @option{interrupt}, @option{syscall}, @option{error}, and @option{debug}.
10003 By default, @option{reset}, @option{error}, and @option{debug} are enabled.
10004 @end deffn
10005
10006 @subsection eSi-RISC Operation
10007
10008 @deffn {Command} {esirisc flush_caches}
10009 Flush instruction and data caches. This command requires that the target is halted
10010 when the command is issued and configured with an instruction or data cache.
10011 @end deffn
10012
10013 @subsection eSi-Trace Configuration
10014
10015 eSi-RISC targets may be configured with support for instruction tracing. Trace
10016 data may be written to an in-memory buffer or FIFO. If a FIFO is configured, DMA
10017 is typically employed to move trace data off-device using a high-speed
10018 peripheral (eg. SPI). Collected trace data is encoded in one of three different
10019 formats. At a minimum, @command{esirisc trace buffer} or @command{esirisc trace
10020 fifo} must be issued along with @command{esirisc trace format} before trace data
10021 can be collected.
10022
10023 OpenOCD provides rudimentary analysis of collected trace data. If more detail is
10024 needed, collected trace data can be dumped to a file and processed by external
10025 tooling.
10026
10027 @quotation Issues
10028 OpenOCD is unable to process trace data sent to a FIFO. A potential workaround
10029 for this issue is to configure DMA to copy trace data to an in-memory buffer,
10030 which can then be passed to the @command{esirisc trace analyze} and
10031 @command{esirisc trace dump} commands.
10032
10033 It is possible to corrupt trace data when using a FIFO if the peripheral
10034 responsible for draining data from the FIFO is not fast enough. This can be
10035 managed by enabling flow control, however this can impact timing-sensitive
10036 software operation on the CPU.
10037 @end quotation
10038
10039 @deffn {Command} {esirisc trace buffer} address size [@option{wrap}]
10040 Configure trace buffer using the provided address and size. If the @option{wrap}
10041 option is specified, trace collection will continue once the end of the buffer
10042 is reached. By default, wrap is disabled.
10043 @end deffn
10044
10045 @deffn {Command} {esirisc trace fifo} address
10046 Configure trace FIFO using the provided address.
10047 @end deffn
10048
10049 @deffn {Command} {esirisc trace flow_control} (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
10050 Enable or disable stalling the CPU to collect trace data. By default, flow
10051 control is disabled.
10052 @end deffn
10053
10054 @deffn {Command} {esirisc trace format} (@option{full}|@option{branch}|@option{icache}) pc_bits
10055 Configure trace format and number of PC bits to be captured. @option{pc_bits}
10056 must be within 1 and 31 as the LSB is not collected. If external tooling is used
10057 to analyze collected trace data, these values must match.
10058
10059 Supported trace formats:
10060 @itemize
10061 @item @option{full} capture full trace data, allowing execution history and
10062 timing to be determined.
10063 @item @option{branch} capture taken branch instructions and branch target
10064 addresses.
10065 @item @option{icache} capture instruction cache misses.
10066 @end itemize
10067 @end deffn
10068
10069 @deffn {Command} {esirisc trace trigger start} (@option{condition}) [start_data start_mask]
10070 Configure trigger start condition using the provided start data and mask. A
10071 brief description of each condition is provided below; for more detail on how
10072 these values are used, see the eSi-RISC Architecture Manual.
10073
10074 Supported conditions:
10075 @itemize
10076 @item @option{none} manual tracing (see @command{esirisc trace start}).
10077 @item @option{pc} start tracing if the PC matches start data and mask.
10078 @item @option{load} start tracing if the effective address of a load
10079 instruction matches start data and mask.
10080 @item @option{store} start tracing if the effective address of a store
10081 instruction matches start data and mask.
10082 @item @option{exception} start tracing if the EID of an exception matches start
10083 data and mask.
10084 @item @option{eret} start tracing when an @code{ERET} instruction is executed.
10085 @item @option{wait} start tracing when a @code{WAIT} instruction is executed.
10086 @item @option{stop} start tracing when a @code{STOP} instruction is executed.
10087 @item @option{high} start tracing when an external signal is a logical high.
10088 @item @option{low} start tracing when an external signal is a logical low.
10089 @end itemize
10090 @end deffn
10091
10092 @deffn {Command} {esirisc trace trigger stop} (@option{condition}) [stop_data stop_mask]
10093 Configure trigger stop condition using the provided stop data and mask. A brief
10094 description of each condition is provided below; for more detail on how these
10095 values are used, see the eSi-RISC Architecture Manual.
10096
10097 Supported conditions:
10098 @itemize
10099 @item @option{none} manual tracing (see @command{esirisc trace stop}).
10100 @item @option{pc} stop tracing if the PC matches stop data and mask.
10101 @item @option{load} stop tracing if the effective address of a load
10102 instruction matches stop data and mask.
10103 @item @option{store} stop tracing if the effective address of a store
10104 instruction matches stop data and mask.
10105 @item @option{exception} stop tracing if the EID of an exception matches stop
10106 data and mask.
10107 @item @option{eret} stop tracing when an @code{ERET} instruction is executed.
10108 @item @option{wait} stop tracing when a @code{WAIT} instruction is executed.
10109 @item @option{stop} stop tracing when a @code{STOP} instruction is executed.
10110 @end itemize
10111 @end deffn
10112
10113 @deffn {Command} {esirisc trace trigger delay} (@option{trigger}) [cycles]
10114 Configure trigger start/stop delay in clock cycles.
10115
10116 Supported triggers:
10117 @itemize
10118 @item @option{none} no delay to start or stop collection.
10119 @item @option{start} delay @option{cycles} after trigger to start collection.
10120 @item @option{stop} delay @option{cycles} after trigger to stop collection.
10121 @item @option{both} delay @option{cycles} after both triggers to start or stop
10122 collection.
10123 @end itemize
10124 @end deffn
10125
10126 @subsection eSi-Trace Operation
10127
10128 @deffn {Command} {esirisc trace init}
10129 Initialize trace collection. This command must be called any time the
10130 configuration changes. If a trace buffer has been configured, the contents will
10131 be overwritten when trace collection starts.
10132 @end deffn
10133
10134 @deffn {Command} {esirisc trace info}
10135 Display trace configuration.
10136 @end deffn
10137
10138 @deffn {Command} {esirisc trace status}
10139 Display trace collection status.
10140 @end deffn
10141
10142 @deffn {Command} {esirisc trace start}
10143 Start manual trace collection.
10144 @end deffn
10145
10146 @deffn {Command} {esirisc trace stop}
10147 Stop manual trace collection.
10148 @end deffn
10149
10150 @deffn {Command} {esirisc trace analyze} [address size]
10151 Analyze collected trace data. This command may only be used if a trace buffer
10152 has been configured. If a trace FIFO has been configured, trace data must be
10153 copied to an in-memory buffer identified by the @option{address} and
10154 @option{size} options using DMA.
10155 @end deffn
10156
10157 @deffn {Command} {esirisc trace dump} [address size] @file{filename}
10158 Dump collected trace data to file. This command may only be used if a trace
10159 buffer has been configured. If a trace FIFO has been configured, trace data must
10160 be copied to an in-memory buffer identified by the @option{address} and
10161 @option{size} options using DMA.
10162 @end deffn
10163
10164 @section Intel Architecture
10165
10166 Intel Quark X10xx is the first product in the Quark family of SoCs. It is an IA-32
10167 (Pentium x86 ISA) compatible SoC. The core CPU in the X10xx is codenamed Lakemont.
10168 Lakemont version 1 (LMT1) is used in X10xx. The CPU TAP (Lakemont TAP) is used for
10169 software debug and the CLTAP is used for SoC level operations.
10170 Useful docs are here: https://communities.intel.com/community/makers/documentation
10171 @itemize
10172 @item Intel Quark SoC X1000 OpenOCD/GDB/Eclipse App Note (web search for doc num 330015)
10173 @item Intel Quark SoC X1000 Debug Operations User Guide (web search for doc num 329866)
10174 @item Intel Quark SoC X1000 Datasheet (web search for doc num 329676)
10175 @end itemize
10176
10177 @subsection x86 32-bit specific commands
10178 The three main address spaces for x86 are memory, I/O and configuration space.
10179 These commands allow a user to read and write to the 64Kbyte I/O address space.
10180
10181 @deffn {Command} {x86_32 idw} address
10182 Display the contents of a 32-bit I/O port from address range 0x0000 - 0xffff.
10183 @end deffn
10184
10185 @deffn {Command} {x86_32 idh} address
10186 Display the contents of a 16-bit I/O port from address range 0x0000 - 0xffff.
10187 @end deffn
10188
10189 @deffn {Command} {x86_32 idb} address
10190 Display the contents of a 8-bit I/O port from address range 0x0000 - 0xffff.
10191 @end deffn
10192
10193 @deffn {Command} {x86_32 iww} address
10194 Write the contents of a 32-bit I/O port to address range 0x0000 - 0xffff.
10195 @end deffn
10196
10197 @deffn {Command} {x86_32 iwh} address
10198 Write the contents of a 16-bit I/O port to address range 0x0000 - 0xffff.
10199 @end deffn
10200
10201 @deffn {Command} {x86_32 iwb} address
10202 Write the contents of a 8-bit I/O port to address range 0x0000 - 0xffff.
10203 @end deffn
10204
10205 @section OpenRISC Architecture
10206
10207 The OpenRISC CPU is a soft core. It is used in a programmable SoC which can be
10208 configured with any of the TAP / Debug Unit available.
10209
10210 @subsection TAP and Debug Unit selection commands
10211 @deffn {Command} {tap_select} (@option{vjtag}|@option{mohor}|@option{xilinx_bscan})
10212 Select between the Altera Virtual JTAG , Xilinx Virtual JTAG and Mohor TAP.
10213 @end deffn
10214 @deffn {Command} {du_select} (@option{adv}|@option{mohor}) [option]
10215 Select between the Advanced Debug Interface and the classic one.
10216
10217 An option can be passed as a second argument to the debug unit.
10218
10219 When using the Advanced Debug Interface, option = 1 means the RTL core is
10220 configured with ADBG_USE_HISPEED = 1. This configuration skips status checking
10221 between bytes while doing read or write bursts.
10222 @end deffn
10223
10224 @subsection Registers commands
10225 @deffn {Command} {addreg} [name] [address] [feature] [reg_group]
10226 Add a new register in the cpu register list. This register will be
10227 included in the generated target descriptor file.
10228
10229 @strong{[feature]} must be "org.gnu.gdb.or1k.group[0..10]".
10230
10231 @strong{[reg_group]} can be anything. The default register list defines "system",
10232 "dmmu", "immu", "dcache", "icache", "mac", "debug", "perf", "power", "pic"
10233 and "timer" groups.
10234
10235 @emph{example:}
10236 @example
10237 addreg rtest 0x1234 org.gnu.gdb.or1k.group0 system
10238 @end example
10239
10240 @end deffn
10241
10242 @section RISC-V Architecture
10243
10244 @uref{http://riscv.org/, RISC-V} is a free and open ISA. OpenOCD supports JTAG
10245 debug of RV32 and RV64 cores in heterogeneous multicore systems of up to 32
10246 harts. (It's possible to increase this limit to 1024 by changing
10247 RISCV_MAX_HARTS in riscv.h.) OpenOCD primarily supports 0.13 of the RISC-V
10248 Debug Specification, but there is also support for legacy targets that
10249 implement version 0.11.
10250
10251 @subsection RISC-V Terminology
10252
10253 A @emph{hart} is a hardware thread. A hart may share resources (eg. FPU) with
10254 another hart, or may be a separate core. RISC-V treats those the same, and
10255 OpenOCD exposes each hart as a separate core.
10256
10257 @subsection Vector Registers
10258
10259 For harts that implement the vector extension, OpenOCD provides access to the
10260 relevant CSRs, as well as the vector registers (v0-v31). The size of each
10261 vector register is dependent on the value of vlenb. RISC-V allows each vector
10262 register to be divided into selected-width elements, and this division can be
10263 changed at run-time. Because OpenOCD cannot update register definitions at
10264 run-time, it exposes each vector register to gdb as a union of fields of
10265 vectors so that users can easily access individual bytes, shorts, words,
10266 longs, and quads inside each vector register. It is left to gdb or
10267 higher-level debuggers to present this data in a more intuitive format.
10268
10269 In the XML register description, the vector registers (when vlenb=16) look as
10270 follows:
10271
10272 @example
10273 <feature name="org.gnu.gdb.riscv.vector">
10274 <vector id="bytes" type="uint8" count="16"/>
10275 <vector id="shorts" type="uint16" count="8"/>
10276 <vector id="words" type="uint32" count="4"/>
10277 <vector id="longs" type="uint64" count="2"/>
10278 <vector id="quads" type="uint128" count="1"/>
10279 <union id="riscv_vector">
10280 <field name="b" type="bytes"/>
10281 <field name="s" type="shorts"/>
10282 <field name="w" type="words"/>
10283 <field name="l" type="longs"/>
10284 <field name="q" type="quads"/>
10285 </union>
10286 <reg name="v0" bitsize="128" regnum="4162" save-restore="no"
10287 type="riscv_vector" group="vector"/>
10288 ...
10289 <reg name="v31" bitsize="128" regnum="4193" save-restore="no"
10290 type="riscv_vector" group="vector"/>
10291 </feature>
10292 @end example
10293
10294 @subsection RISC-V Debug Configuration Commands
10295
10296 @deffn {Config Command} {riscv expose_csrs} n[-m|=name] [...]
10297 Configure which CSRs to expose in addition to the standard ones. The CSRs to expose
10298 can be specified as individual register numbers or register ranges (inclusive). For the
10299 individually listed CSRs, a human-readable name can optionally be set using the @code{n=name}
10300 syntax, which will get @code{csr_} prepended to it. If no name is provided, the register will be
10301 named @code{csr<n>}.
10302
10303 By default OpenOCD attempts to expose only CSRs that are mentioned in a spec,
10304 and then only if the corresponding extension appears to be implemented. This
10305 command can be used if OpenOCD gets this wrong, or if the target implements custom
10306 CSRs.
10307
10308 @example
10309 # Expose a single RISC-V CSR number 128 under the name "csr128":
10310 $_TARGETNAME expose_csrs 128
10311
10312 # Expose multiple RISC-V CSRs 128..132 under names "csr128" through "csr132":
10313 $_TARGETNAME expose_csrs 128-132
10314
10315 # Expose a single RISC-V CSR number 1996 under custom name "csr_myregister":
10316 $_TARGETNAME expose_csrs 1996=myregister
10317 @end example
10318 @end deffn
10319
10320 @deffn {Config Command} {riscv expose_custom} n[-m|=name] [...]
10321 The RISC-V Debug Specification allows targets to expose custom registers
10322 through abstract commands. (See Section 3.5.1.1 in that document.) This command
10323 configures individual registers or register ranges (inclusive) that shall be exposed.
10324 Number 0 indicates the first custom register, whose abstract command number is 0xc000.
10325 For individually listed registers, a human-readable name can be optionally provided
10326 using the @code{n=name} syntax, which will get @code{custom_} prepended to it. If no
10327 name is provided, the register will be named @code{custom<n>}.
10328
10329 @example
10330 # Expose one RISC-V custom register with number 0xc010 (0xc000 + 16)
10331 # under the name "custom16":
10332 $_TARGETNAME expose_custom 16
10333
10334 # Expose a range of RISC-V custom registers with numbers 0xc010 .. 0xc018
10335 # (0xc000+16 .. 0xc000+24) under the names "custom16" through "custom24":
10336 $_TARGETNAME expose_custom 16-24
10337
10338 # Expose one RISC-V custom register with number 0xc020 (0xc000 + 32) under
10339 # user-defined name "custom_myregister":
10340 $_TARGETNAME expose_custom 32=myregister
10341 @end example
10342 @end deffn
10343
10344 @deffn {Command} {riscv set_command_timeout_sec} [seconds]
10345 Set the wall-clock timeout (in seconds) for individual commands. The default
10346 should work fine for all but the slowest targets (eg. simulators).
10347 @end deffn
10348
10349 @deffn {Command} {riscv set_reset_timeout_sec} [seconds]
10350 Set the maximum time to wait for a hart to come out of reset after reset is
10351 deasserted.
10352 @end deffn
10353
10354 @deffn {Command} {riscv set_scratch_ram} none|[address]
10355 Set the address of 16 bytes of scratch RAM the debugger can use, or 'none'.
10356 This is used to access 64-bit floating point registers on 32-bit targets.
10357 @end deffn
10358
10359 @deffn Command {riscv set_mem_access} method1 [method2] [method3]
10360 Specify which RISC-V memory access method(s) shall be used, and in which order
10361 of priority. At least one method must be specified.
10362
10363 Available methods are:
10364 @itemize
10365 @item @code{progbuf} - Use RISC-V Debug Program Buffer to access memory.
10366 @item @code{sysbus} - Access memory via RISC-V Debug System Bus interface.
10367 @item @code{abstract} - Access memory via RISC-V Debug abstract commands.
10368 @end itemize
10369
10370 By default, all memory access methods are enabled in the following order:
10371 @code{progbuf sysbus abstract}.
10372
10373 This command can be used to change the memory access methods if the default
10374 behavior is not suitable for a particular target.
10375 @end deffn
10376
10377 @deffn {Command} {riscv set_enable_virtual} on|off
10378 When on, memory accesses are performed on physical or virtual memory depending
10379 on the current system configuration. When off (default), all memory accessses are performed
10380 on physical memory.
10381 @end deffn
10382
10383 @deffn {Command} {riscv set_enable_virt2phys} on|off
10384 When on (default), memory accesses are performed on physical or virtual memory
10385 depending on the current satp configuration. When off, all memory accessses are
10386 performed on physical memory.
10387 @end deffn
10388
10389 @deffn {Command} {riscv resume_order} normal|reversed
10390 Some software assumes all harts are executing nearly continuously. Such
10391 software may be sensitive to the order that harts are resumed in. On harts
10392 that don't support hasel, this option allows the user to choose the order the
10393 harts are resumed in. If you are using this option, it's probably masking a
10394 race condition problem in your code.
10395
10396 Normal order is from lowest hart index to highest. This is the default
10397 behavior. Reversed order is from highest hart index to lowest.
10398 @end deffn
10399
10400 @deffn {Command} {riscv set_ir} (@option{idcode}|@option{dtmcs}|@option{dmi}) [value]
10401 Set the IR value for the specified JTAG register. This is useful, for
10402 example, when using the existing JTAG interface on a Xilinx FPGA by
10403 way of BSCANE2 primitives that only permit a limited selection of IR
10404 values.
10405
10406 When utilizing version 0.11 of the RISC-V Debug Specification,
10407 @option{dtmcs} and @option{dmi} set the IR values for the DTMCONTROL
10408 and DBUS registers, respectively.
10409 @end deffn
10410
10411 @deffn {Command} {riscv use_bscan_tunnel} value
10412 Enable or disable use of a BSCAN tunnel to reach DM. Supply the width of
10413 the DM transport TAP's instruction register to enable. Supply a value of 0 to disable.
10414 @end deffn
10415
10416 @deffn {Command} {riscv set_ebreakm} on|off
10417 Control dcsr.ebreakm. When on (default), M-mode ebreak instructions trap to
10418 OpenOCD. When off, they generate a breakpoint exception handled internally.
10419 @end deffn
10420
10421 @deffn {Command} {riscv set_ebreaks} on|off
10422 Control dcsr.ebreaks. When on (default), S-mode ebreak instructions trap to
10423 OpenOCD. When off, they generate a breakpoint exception handled internally.
10424 @end deffn
10425
10426 @deffn {Command} {riscv set_ebreaku} on|off
10427 Control dcsr.ebreaku. When on (default), U-mode ebreak instructions trap to
10428 OpenOCD. When off, they generate a breakpoint exception handled internally.
10429 @end deffn
10430
10431 @subsection RISC-V Authentication Commands
10432
10433 The following commands can be used to authenticate to a RISC-V system. Eg. a
10434 trivial challenge-response protocol could be implemented as follows in a
10435 configuration file, immediately following @command{init}:
10436 @example
10437 set challenge [riscv authdata_read]
10438 riscv authdata_write [expr @{$challenge + 1@}]
10439 @end example
10440
10441 @deffn {Command} {riscv authdata_read}
10442 Return the 32-bit value read from authdata.
10443 @end deffn
10444
10445 @deffn {Command} {riscv authdata_write} value
10446 Write the 32-bit value to authdata.
10447 @end deffn
10448
10449 @subsection RISC-V DMI Commands
10450
10451 The following commands allow direct access to the Debug Module Interface, which
10452 can be used to interact with custom debug features.
10453
10454 @deffn {Command} {riscv dmi_read} address
10455 Perform a 32-bit DMI read at address, returning the value.
10456 @end deffn
10457
10458 @deffn {Command} {riscv dmi_write} address value
10459 Perform a 32-bit DMI write of value at address.
10460 @end deffn
10461
10462 @section ARC Architecture
10463 @cindex ARC
10464
10465 Synopsys DesignWare ARC Processors are a family of 32-bit CPUs that SoC
10466 designers can optimize for a wide range of uses, from deeply embedded to
10467 high-performance host applications in a variety of market segments. See more
10468 at: @url{http://www.synopsys.com/IP/ProcessorIP/ARCProcessors/Pages/default.aspx}.
10469 OpenOCD currently supports ARC EM processors.
10470 There is a set ARC-specific OpenOCD commands that allow low-level
10471 access to the core and provide necessary support for ARC extensibility and
10472 configurability capabilities. ARC processors has much more configuration
10473 capabilities than most of the other processors and in addition there is an
10474 extension interface that allows SoC designers to add custom registers and
10475 instructions. For the OpenOCD that mostly means that set of core and AUX
10476 registers in target will vary and is not fixed for a particular processor
10477 model. To enable extensibility several TCL commands are provided that allow to
10478 describe those optional registers in OpenOCD configuration files. Moreover
10479 those commands allow for a dynamic target features discovery.
10480
10481
10482 @subsection General ARC commands
10483
10484 @deffn {Config Command} {arc add-reg} configparams
10485
10486 Add a new register to processor target. By default newly created register is
10487 marked as not existing. @var{configparams} must have following required
10488 arguments:
10489
10490 @itemize @bullet
10491
10492 @item @code{-name} name
10493 @*Name of a register.
10494
10495 @item @code{-num} number
10496 @*Architectural register number: core register number or AUX register number.
10497
10498 @item @code{-feature} XML_feature
10499 @*Name of GDB XML target description feature.
10500
10501 @end itemize
10502
10503 @var{configparams} may have following optional arguments:
10504
10505 @itemize @bullet
10506
10507 @item @code{-gdbnum} number
10508 @*GDB register number. It is recommended to not assign GDB register number
10509 manually, because there would be a risk that two register will have same
10510 number. When register GDB number is not set with this option, then register
10511 will get a previous register number + 1. This option is required only for those
10512 registers that must be at particular address expected by GDB.
10513
10514 @item @code{-core}
10515 @*This option specifies that register is a core registers. If not - this is an
10516 AUX register. AUX registers and core registers reside in different address
10517 spaces.
10518
10519 @item @code{-bcr}
10520 @*This options specifies that register is a BCR register. BCR means Build
10521 Configuration Registers - this is a special type of AUX registers that are read
10522 only and non-volatile, that is - they never change their value. Therefore OpenOCD
10523 never invalidates values of those registers in internal caches. Because BCR is a
10524 type of AUX registers, this option cannot be used with @code{-core}.
10525
10526 @item @code{-type} type_name
10527 @*Name of type of this register. This can be either one of the basic GDB types,
10528 or a custom types described with @command{arc add-reg-type-[flags|struct]}.
10529
10530 @item @code{-g}
10531 @* If specified then this is a "general" register. General registers are always
10532 read by OpenOCD on context save (when core has just been halted) and is always
10533 transferred to GDB client in a response to g-packet. Contrary to this,
10534 non-general registers are read and sent to GDB client on-demand. In general it
10535 is not recommended to apply this option to custom registers.
10536
10537 @end itemize
10538
10539 @end deffn
10540
10541 @deffn {Config Command} {arc add-reg-type-flags} -name name flags...
10542 Adds new register type of ``flags'' class. ``Flags'' types can contain only
10543 one-bit fields. Each flag definition looks like @code{-flag name bit-position}.
10544 @end deffn
10545
10546 @anchor{add-reg-type-struct}
10547 @deffn {Config Command} {arc add-reg-type-struct} -name name structs...
10548 Adds new register type of ``struct'' class. ``Struct'' types can contain either
10549 bit-fields or fields of other types, however at the moment only bit fields are
10550 supported. Structure bit field definition looks like @code{-bitfield name
10551 startbit endbit}.
10552 @end deffn
10553
10554 @deffn {Command} {arc get-reg-field} reg-name field-name
10555 Returns value of bit-field in a register. Register must be ``struct'' register
10556 type, @xref{add-reg-type-struct}. command definition.
10557 @end deffn
10558
10559 @deffn {Command} {arc set-reg-exists} reg-names...
10560 Specify that some register exists. Any amount of names can be passed
10561 as an argument for a single command invocation.
10562 @end deffn
10563
10564 @subsection ARC JTAG commands
10565
10566 @deffn {Command} {arc jtag set-aux-reg} regnum value
10567 This command writes value to AUX register via its number. This command access
10568 register in target directly via JTAG, bypassing any OpenOCD internal caches,
10569 therefore it is unsafe to use if that register can be operated by other means.
10570
10571 @end deffn
10572
10573 @deffn {Command} {arc jtag set-core-reg} regnum value
10574 This command is similar to @command{arc jtag set-aux-reg} but is for core
10575 registers.
10576 @end deffn
10577
10578 @deffn {Command} {arc jtag get-aux-reg} regnum
10579 This command returns the value storded in AUX register via its number. This commands access
10580 register in target directly via JTAG, bypassing any OpenOCD internal caches,
10581 therefore it is unsafe to use if that register can be operated by other means.
10582
10583 @end deffn
10584
10585 @deffn {Command} {arc jtag get-core-reg} regnum
10586 This command is similar to @command{arc jtag get-aux-reg} but is for core
10587 registers.
10588 @end deffn
10589
10590 @section STM8 Architecture
10591 @uref{http://st.com/stm8/, STM8} is a 8-bit microcontroller platform from
10592 STMicroelectronics, based on a proprietary 8-bit core architecture.
10593
10594 OpenOCD supports debugging STM8 through the STMicroelectronics debug
10595 protocol SWIM, @pxref{swimtransport,,SWIM}.
10596
10597 @anchor{softwaredebugmessagesandtracing}
10598 @section Software Debug Messages and Tracing
10599 @cindex Linux-ARM DCC support
10600 @cindex tracing
10601 @cindex libdcc
10602 @cindex DCC
10603 OpenOCD can process certain requests from target software, when
10604 the target uses appropriate libraries.
10605 The most powerful mechanism is semihosting, but there is also
10606 a lighter weight mechanism using only the DCC channel.
10607
10608 Currently @command{target_request debugmsgs}
10609 is supported only for @option{arm7_9} and @option{cortex_m} cores.
10610 These messages are received as part of target polling, so
10611 you need to have @command{poll on} active to receive them.
10612 They are intrusive in that they will affect program execution
10613 times. If that is a problem, @pxref{armhardwaretracing,,ARM Hardware Tracing}.
10614
10615 See @file{libdcc} in the contrib dir for more details.
10616 In addition to sending strings, characters, and
10617 arrays of various size integers from the target,
10618 @file{libdcc} also exports a software trace point mechanism.
10619 The target being debugged may
10620 issue trace messages which include a 24-bit @dfn{trace point} number.
10621 Trace point support includes two distinct mechanisms,
10622 each supported by a command:
10623
10624 @itemize
10625 @item @emph{History} ... A circular buffer of trace points
10626 can be set up, and then displayed at any time.
10627 This tracks where code has been, which can be invaluable in
10628 finding out how some fault was triggered.
10629
10630 The buffer may overflow, since it collects records continuously.
10631 It may be useful to use some of the 24 bits to represent a
10632 particular event, and other bits to hold data.
10633
10634 @item @emph{Counting} ... An array of counters can be set up,
10635 and then displayed at any time.
10636 This can help establish code coverage and identify hot spots.
10637
10638 The array of counters is directly indexed by the trace point
10639 number, so trace points with higher numbers are not counted.
10640 @end itemize
10641
10642 Linux-ARM kernels have a ``Kernel low-level debugging
10643 via EmbeddedICE DCC channel'' option (CONFIG_DEBUG_ICEDCC,
10644 depends on CONFIG_DEBUG_LL) which uses this mechanism to
10645 deliver messages before a serial console can be activated.
10646 This is not the same format used by @file{libdcc}.
10647 Other software, such as the U-Boot boot loader, sometimes
10648 does the same thing.
10649
10650 @deffn {Command} {target_request debugmsgs} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}|@option{charmsg}]
10651 Displays current handling of target DCC message requests.
10652 These messages may be sent to the debugger while the target is running.
10653 The optional @option{enable} and @option{charmsg} parameters
10654 both enable the messages, while @option{disable} disables them.
10655
10656 With @option{charmsg} the DCC words each contain one character,
10657 as used by Linux with CONFIG_DEBUG_ICEDCC;
10658 otherwise the libdcc format is used.
10659 @end deffn
10660
10661 @deffn {Command} {trace history} [@option{clear}|count]
10662 With no parameter, displays all the trace points that have triggered
10663 in the order they triggered.
10664 With the parameter @option{clear}, erases all current trace history records.
10665 With a @var{count} parameter, allocates space for that many
10666 history records.
10667 @end deffn
10668
10669 @deffn {Command} {trace point} [@option{clear}|identifier]
10670 With no parameter, displays all trace point identifiers and how many times
10671 they have been triggered.
10672 With the parameter @option{clear}, erases all current trace point counters.
10673 With a numeric @var{identifier} parameter, creates a new a trace point counter
10674 and associates it with that identifier.
10675
10676 @emph{Important:} The identifier and the trace point number
10677 are not related except by this command.
10678 These trace point numbers always start at zero (from server startup,
10679 or after @command{trace point clear}) and count up from there.
10680 @end deffn
10681
10682
10683 @node JTAG Commands
10684 @chapter JTAG Commands
10685 @cindex JTAG Commands
10686 Most general purpose JTAG commands have been presented earlier.
10687 (@xref{jtagspeed,,JTAG Speed}, @ref{Reset Configuration}, and @ref{TAP Declaration}.)
10688 Lower level JTAG commands, as presented here,
10689 may be needed to work with targets which require special
10690 attention during operations such as reset or initialization.
10691
10692 To use these commands you will need to understand some
10693 of the basics of JTAG, including:
10694
10695 @itemize @bullet
10696 @item A JTAG scan chain consists of a sequence of individual TAP
10697 devices such as a CPUs.
10698 @item Control operations involve moving each TAP through the same
10699 standard state machine (in parallel)
10700 using their shared TMS and clock signals.
10701 @item Data transfer involves shifting data through the chain of
10702 instruction or data registers of each TAP, writing new register values
10703 while the reading previous ones.
10704 @item Data register sizes are a function of the instruction active in
10705 a given TAP, while instruction register sizes are fixed for each TAP.
10706 All TAPs support a BYPASS instruction with a single bit data register.
10707 @item The way OpenOCD differentiates between TAP devices is by
10708 shifting different instructions into (and out of) their instruction
10709 registers.
10710 @end itemize
10711
10712 @section Low Level JTAG Commands
10713
10714 These commands are used by developers who need to access
10715 JTAG instruction or data registers, possibly controlling
10716 the order of TAP state transitions.
10717 If you're not debugging OpenOCD internals, or bringing up a
10718 new JTAG adapter or a new type of TAP device (like a CPU or
10719 JTAG router), you probably won't need to use these commands.
10720 In a debug session that doesn't use JTAG for its transport protocol,
10721 these commands are not available.
10722
10723 @deffn {Command} {drscan} tap [numbits value]+ [@option{-endstate} tap_state]
10724 Loads the data register of @var{tap} with a series of bit fields
10725 that specify the entire register.
10726 Each field is @var{numbits} bits long with
10727 a numeric @var{value} (hexadecimal encouraged).
10728 The return value holds the original value of each
10729 of those fields.
10730
10731 For example, a 38 bit number might be specified as one
10732 field of 32 bits then one of 6 bits.
10733 @emph{For portability, never pass fields which are more
10734 than 32 bits long. Many OpenOCD implementations do not
10735 support 64-bit (or larger) integer values.}
10736
10737 All TAPs other than @var{tap} must be in BYPASS mode.
10738 The single bit in their data registers does not matter.
10739
10740 When @var{tap_state} is specified, the JTAG state machine is left
10741 in that state.
10742 For example @sc{drpause} might be specified, so that more
10743 instructions can be issued before re-entering the @sc{run/idle} state.
10744 If the end state is not specified, the @sc{run/idle} state is entered.
10745
10746 @quotation Warning
10747 OpenOCD does not record information about data register lengths,
10748 so @emph{it is important that you get the bit field lengths right}.
10749 Remember that different JTAG instructions refer to different
10750 data registers, which may have different lengths.
10751 Moreover, those lengths may not be fixed;
10752 the SCAN_N instruction can change the length of
10753 the register accessed by the INTEST instruction
10754 (by connecting a different scan chain).
10755 @end quotation
10756 @end deffn
10757
10758 @deffn {Command} {flush_count}
10759 Returns the number of times the JTAG queue has been flushed.
10760 This may be used for performance tuning.
10761
10762 For example, flushing a queue over USB involves a
10763 minimum latency, often several milliseconds, which does
10764 not change with the amount of data which is written.
10765 You may be able to identify performance problems by finding
10766 tasks which waste bandwidth by flushing small transfers too often,
10767 instead of batching them into larger operations.
10768 @end deffn
10769
10770 @deffn {Command} {irscan} [tap instruction]+ [@option{-endstate} tap_state]
10771 For each @var{tap} listed, loads the instruction register
10772 with its associated numeric @var{instruction}.
10773 (The number of bits in that instruction may be displayed
10774 using the @command{scan_chain} command.)
10775 For other TAPs, a BYPASS instruction is loaded.
10776
10777 When @var{tap_state} is specified, the JTAG state machine is left
10778 in that state.
10779 For example @sc{irpause} might be specified, so the data register
10780 can be loaded before re-entering the @sc{run/idle} state.
10781 If the end state is not specified, the @sc{run/idle} state is entered.
10782
10783 @quotation Note
10784 OpenOCD currently supports only a single field for instruction
10785 register values, unlike data register values.
10786 For TAPs where the instruction register length is more than 32 bits,
10787 portable scripts currently must issue only BYPASS instructions.
10788 @end quotation
10789 @end deffn
10790
10791 @deffn {Command} {pathmove} start_state [next_state ...]
10792 Start by moving to @var{start_state}, which
10793 must be one of the @emph{stable} states.
10794 Unless it is the only state given, this will often be the
10795 current state, so that no TCK transitions are needed.
10796 Then, in a series of single state transitions
10797 (conforming to the JTAG state machine) shift to
10798 each @var{next_state} in sequence, one per TCK cycle.
10799 The final state must also be stable.
10800 @end deffn
10801
10802 @deffn {Command} {runtest} @var{num_cycles}
10803 Move to the @sc{run/idle} state, and execute at least
10804 @var{num_cycles} of the JTAG clock (TCK).
10805 Instructions often need some time
10806 to execute before they take effect.
10807 @end deffn
10808
10809 @c tms_sequence (short|long)
10810 @c ... temporary, debug-only, other than USBprog bug workaround...
10811
10812 @deffn {Command} {verify_ircapture} (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
10813 Verify values captured during @sc{ircapture} and returned
10814 during IR scans. Default is enabled, but this can be
10815 overridden by @command{verify_jtag}.
10816 This flag is ignored when validating JTAG chain configuration.
10817 @end deffn
10818
10819 @deffn {Command} {verify_jtag} (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
10820 Enables verification of DR and IR scans, to help detect
10821 programming errors. For IR scans, @command{verify_ircapture}
10822 must also be enabled.
10823 Default is enabled.
10824 @end deffn
10825
10826 @section TAP state names
10827 @cindex TAP state names
10828
10829 The @var{tap_state} names used by OpenOCD in the @command{drscan},
10830 @command{irscan}, and @command{pathmove} commands are the same
10831 as those used in SVF boundary scan documents, except that
10832 SVF uses @sc{idle} instead of @sc{run/idle}.
10833
10834 @itemize @bullet
10835 @item @b{RESET} ... @emph{stable} (with TMS high);
10836 acts as if TRST were pulsed
10837 @item @b{RUN/IDLE} ... @emph{stable}; don't assume this always means IDLE
10838 @item @b{DRSELECT}
10839 @item @b{DRCAPTURE}
10840 @item @b{DRSHIFT} ... @emph{stable}; TDI/TDO shifting
10841 through the data register
10842 @item @b{DREXIT1}
10843 @item @b{DRPAUSE} ... @emph{stable}; data register ready
10844 for update or more shifting
10845 @item @b{DREXIT2}
10846 @item @b{DRUPDATE}
10847 @item @b{IRSELECT}
10848 @item @b{IRCAPTURE}
10849 @item @b{IRSHIFT} ... @emph{stable}; TDI/TDO shifting
10850 through the instruction register
10851 @item @b{IREXIT1}
10852 @item @b{IRPAUSE} ... @emph{stable}; instruction register ready
10853 for update or more shifting
10854 @item @b{IREXIT2}
10855 @item @b{IRUPDATE}
10856 @end itemize
10857
10858 Note that only six of those states are fully ``stable'' in the
10859 face of TMS fixed (low except for @sc{reset})
10860 and a free-running JTAG clock. For all the
10861 others, the next TCK transition changes to a new state.
10862
10863 @itemize @bullet
10864 @item From @sc{drshift} and @sc{irshift}, clock transitions will
10865 produce side effects by changing register contents. The values
10866 to be latched in upcoming @sc{drupdate} or @sc{irupdate} states
10867 may not be as expected.
10868 @item @sc{run/idle}, @sc{drpause}, and @sc{irpause} are reasonable
10869 choices after @command{drscan} or @command{irscan} commands,
10870 since they are free of JTAG side effects.
10871 @item @sc{run/idle} may have side effects that appear at non-JTAG
10872 levels, such as advancing the ARM9E-S instruction pipeline.
10873 Consult the documentation for the TAP(s) you are working with.
10874 @end itemize
10875
10876 @node Boundary Scan Commands
10877 @chapter Boundary Scan Commands
10878
10879 One of the original purposes of JTAG was to support
10880 boundary scan based hardware testing.
10881 Although its primary focus is to support On-Chip Debugging,
10882 OpenOCD also includes some boundary scan commands.
10883
10884 @section SVF: Serial Vector Format
10885 @cindex Serial Vector Format
10886 @cindex SVF
10887
10888 The Serial Vector Format, better known as @dfn{SVF}, is a
10889 way to represent JTAG test patterns in text files.
10890 In a debug session using JTAG for its transport protocol,
10891 OpenOCD supports running such test files.
10892
10893 @deffn {Command} {svf} @file{filename} [@option{-tap @var{tapname}}] [@option{[-]quiet}] @
10894 [@option{[-]nil}] [@option{[-]progress}] [@option{[-]ignore_error}]
10895 This issues a JTAG reset (Test-Logic-Reset) and then
10896 runs the SVF script from @file{filename}.
10897
10898 Arguments can be specified in any order; the optional dash doesn't
10899 affect their semantics.
10900
10901 Command options:
10902 @itemize @minus
10903 @item @option{-tap @var{tapname}} ignore IR and DR headers and footers
10904 specified by the SVF file with HIR, TIR, HDR and TDR commands;
10905 instead, calculate them automatically according to the current JTAG
10906 chain configuration, targeting @var{tapname};
10907 @item @option{[-]quiet} do not log every command before execution;
10908 @item @option{[-]nil} ``dry run'', i.e., do not perform any operations
10909 on the real interface;
10910 @item @option{[-]progress} enable progress indication;
10911 @item @option{[-]ignore_error} continue execution despite TDO check
10912 errors.
10913 @end itemize
10914 @end deffn
10915
10916 @section XSVF: Xilinx Serial Vector Format
10917 @cindex Xilinx Serial Vector Format
10918 @cindex XSVF
10919
10920 The Xilinx Serial Vector Format, better known as @dfn{XSVF}, is a
10921 binary representation of SVF which is optimized for use with
10922 Xilinx devices.
10923 In a debug session using JTAG for its transport protocol,
10924 OpenOCD supports running such test files.
10925
10926 @quotation Important
10927 Not all XSVF commands are supported.
10928 @end quotation
10929
10930 @deffn {Command} {xsvf} (tapname|@option{plain}) filename [@option{virt2}] [@option{quiet}]
10931 This issues a JTAG reset (Test-Logic-Reset) and then
10932 runs the XSVF script from @file{filename}.
10933 When a @var{tapname} is specified, the commands are directed at
10934 that TAP.
10935 When @option{virt2} is specified, the @sc{xruntest} command counts
10936 are interpreted as TCK cycles instead of microseconds.
10937 Unless the @option{quiet} option is specified,
10938 messages are logged for comments and some retries.
10939 @end deffn
10940
10941 The OpenOCD sources also include two utility scripts
10942 for working with XSVF; they are not currently installed
10943 after building the software.
10944 You may find them useful:
10945
10946 @itemize
10947 @item @emph{svf2xsvf} ... converts SVF files into the extended XSVF
10948 syntax understood by the @command{xsvf} command; see notes below.
10949 @item @emph{xsvfdump} ... converts XSVF files into a text output format;
10950 understands the OpenOCD extensions.
10951 @end itemize
10952
10953 The input format accepts a handful of non-standard extensions.
10954 These include three opcodes corresponding to SVF extensions
10955 from Lattice Semiconductor (LCOUNT, LDELAY, LDSR), and
10956 two opcodes supporting a more accurate translation of SVF
10957 (XTRST, XWAITSTATE).
10958 If @emph{xsvfdump} shows a file is using those opcodes, it
10959 probably will not be usable with other XSVF tools.
10960
10961
10962 @section IPDBG: JTAG-Host server
10963 @cindex IPDBG JTAG-Host server
10964 @cindex IPDBG
10965
10966 IPDBG is a set of tools to debug IP-Cores. It comprises, among others, a logic analyzer and an arbitrary
10967 waveform generator. These are synthesize-able hardware descriptions of
10968 logic circuits in addition to software for control, visualization and further analysis.
10969 In a session using JTAG for its transport protocol, OpenOCD supports the function
10970 of a JTAG-Host. The JTAG-Host is needed to connect the circuit over JTAG to the
10971 control-software. For more details see @url{http://ipdbg.org}.
10972
10973 @deffn {Command} {ipdbg} [@option{-start|-stop}] @option{-tap @var{tapname}} @option{-hub @var{ir_value} [@var{dr_length}]} [@option{-port @var{number}}] [@option{-tool @var{number}}] [@option{-vir [@var{vir_value} [@var{length} [@var{instr_code}]]]}]
10974 Starts or stops a IPDBG JTAG-Host server. Arguments can be specified in any order.
10975
10976 Command options:
10977 @itemize @bullet
10978 @item @option{-start|-stop} starts or stops a IPDBG JTAG-Host server (default: start).
10979 @item @option{-tap @var{tapname}} targeting the TAP @var{tapname}.
10980 @item @option{-hub @var{ir_value}} states that the JTAG hub is
10981 reachable with dr-scans while the JTAG instruction register has the value @var{ir_value}.
10982 @item @option{-port @var{number}} tcp port number where the JTAG-Host is listening.
10983 @item @option{-tool @var{number}} number of the tool/feature. These corresponds to the ports "data_(up/down)_(0..6)" at the JtagHub.
10984 @item @option{-vir [@var{vir_value} [@var{length} [@var{instr_code}]]]} On some devices, the user data-register is only reachable if there is a
10985 specific value in a second dr. This second dr is called vir (virtual ir). With this parameter given, the IPDBG satisfies this condition prior an
10986 access to the IPDBG-Hub. The value shifted into the vir is given by the first parameter @var{vir_value} (default: 0x11). The second
10987 parameter @var{length} is the length of the vir data register (default: 5). With the @var{instr_code} (default: 0x00e) parameter the ir value to
10988 shift data through vir can be configured.
10989 @end itemize
10990 @end deffn
10991
10992 Examples:
10993 @example
10994 ipdbg -start -tap xc6s.tap -hub 0x02 -port 4242 -tool 4
10995 @end example
10996 Starts a server listening on tcp-port 4242 which connects to tool 4.
10997 The connection is through the TAP of a Xilinx Spartan 6 on USER1 instruction (tested with a papillion pro board).
10998
10999 @example
11000 ipdbg -start -tap 10m50.tap -hub 0x00C -vir -port 60000 -tool 1
11001 @end example
11002 Starts a server listening on tcp-port 60000 which connects to tool 1 (data_up_1/data_down_1).
11003 The connection is through the TAP of a Intel MAX10 virtual jtag component (sld_instance_index is 0; sld_ir_width is smaller than 5).
11004
11005 @node Utility Commands
11006 @chapter Utility Commands
11007 @cindex Utility Commands
11008
11009 @section RAM testing
11010 @cindex RAM testing
11011
11012 There is often a need to stress-test random access memory (RAM) for
11013 errors. OpenOCD comes with a Tcl implementation of well-known memory
11014 testing procedures allowing the detection of all sorts of issues with
11015 electrical wiring, defective chips, PCB layout and other common
11016 hardware problems.
11017
11018 To use them, you usually need to initialise your RAM controller first;
11019 consult your SoC's documentation to get the recommended list of
11020 register operations and translate them to the corresponding
11021 @command{mww}/@command{mwb} commands.
11022
11023 Load the memory testing functions with
11024
11025 @example
11026 source [find tools/memtest.tcl]
11027 @end example
11028
11029 to get access to the following facilities:
11030
11031 @deffn {Command} {memTestDataBus} address
11032 Test the data bus wiring in a memory region by performing a walking
11033 1's test at a fixed address within that region.
11034 @end deffn
11035
11036 @deffn {Command} {memTestAddressBus} baseaddress size
11037 Perform a walking 1's test on the relevant bits of the address and
11038 check for aliasing. This test will find single-bit address failures
11039 such as stuck-high, stuck-low, and shorted pins.
11040 @end deffn
11041
11042 @deffn {Command} {memTestDevice} baseaddress size
11043 Test the integrity of a physical memory device by performing an
11044 increment/decrement test over the entire region. In the process every
11045 storage bit in the device is tested as zero and as one.
11046 @end deffn
11047
11048 @deffn {Command} {runAllMemTests} baseaddress size
11049 Run all of the above tests over a specified memory region.
11050 @end deffn
11051
11052 @section Firmware recovery helpers
11053 @cindex Firmware recovery
11054
11055 OpenOCD includes an easy-to-use script to facilitate mass-market
11056 devices recovery with JTAG.
11057
11058 For quickstart instructions run:
11059 @example
11060 openocd -f tools/firmware-recovery.tcl -c firmware_help
11061 @end example
11062
11063 @node GDB and OpenOCD
11064 @chapter GDB and OpenOCD
11065 @cindex GDB
11066 OpenOCD complies with the remote gdbserver protocol and, as such, can be used
11067 to debug remote targets.
11068 Setting up GDB to work with OpenOCD can involve several components:
11069
11070 @itemize
11071 @item The OpenOCD server support for GDB may need to be configured.
11072 @xref{gdbconfiguration,,GDB Configuration}.
11073 @item GDB's support for OpenOCD may need configuration,
11074 as shown in this chapter.
11075 @item If you have a GUI environment like Eclipse,
11076 that also will probably need to be configured.
11077 @end itemize
11078
11079 Of course, the version of GDB you use will need to be one which has
11080 been built to know about the target CPU you're using. It's probably
11081 part of the tool chain you're using. For example, if you are doing
11082 cross-development for ARM on an x86 PC, instead of using the native
11083 x86 @command{gdb} command you might use @command{arm-none-eabi-gdb}
11084 if that's the tool chain used to compile your code.
11085
11086 @section Connecting to GDB
11087 @cindex Connecting to GDB
11088 Use GDB 6.7 or newer with OpenOCD if you run into trouble. For
11089 instance GDB 6.3 has a known bug that produces bogus memory access
11090 errors, which has since been fixed; see
11091 @url{http://osdir.com/ml/gdb.bugs.discuss/2004-12/msg00018.html}
11092
11093 OpenOCD can communicate with GDB in two ways:
11094
11095 @enumerate
11096 @item
11097 A socket (TCP/IP) connection is typically started as follows:
11098 @example
11099 target extended-remote localhost:3333
11100 @end example
11101 This would cause GDB to connect to the gdbserver on the local pc using port 3333.
11102
11103 The extended remote protocol is a super-set of the remote protocol and should
11104 be the preferred choice. More details are available in GDB documentation
11105 @url{https://sourceware.org/gdb/onlinedocs/gdb/Connecting.html}
11106
11107 To speed-up typing, any GDB command can be abbreviated, including the extended
11108 remote command above that becomes:
11109 @example
11110 tar ext :3333
11111 @end example
11112
11113 @b{Note:} If any backward compatibility issue requires using the old remote
11114 protocol in place of the extended remote one, the former protocol is still
11115 available through the command:
11116 @example
11117 target remote localhost:3333
11118 @end example
11119
11120 @item
11121 A pipe connection is typically started as follows:
11122 @example
11123 target extended-remote | \
11124 openocd -c "gdb_port pipe; log_output openocd.log"
11125 @end example
11126 This would cause GDB to run OpenOCD and communicate using pipes (stdin/stdout).
11127 Using this method has the advantage of GDB starting/stopping OpenOCD for the debug
11128 session. log_output sends the log output to a file to ensure that the pipe is
11129 not saturated when using higher debug level outputs.
11130 @end enumerate
11131
11132 To list the available OpenOCD commands type @command{monitor help} on the
11133 GDB command line.
11134
11135 @section Sample GDB session startup
11136
11137 With the remote protocol, GDB sessions start a little differently
11138 than they do when you're debugging locally.
11139 Here's an example showing how to start a debug session with a
11140 small ARM program.
11141 In this case the program was linked to be loaded into SRAM on a Cortex-M3.
11142 Most programs would be written into flash (address 0) and run from there.
11143
11144 @example
11145 $ arm-none-eabi-gdb example.elf
11146 (gdb) target extended-remote localhost:3333
11147 Remote debugging using localhost:3333
11148 ...
11149 (gdb) monitor reset halt
11150 ...
11151 (gdb) load
11152 Loading section .vectors, size 0x100 lma 0x20000000
11153 Loading section .text, size 0x5a0 lma 0x20000100
11154 Loading section .data, size 0x18 lma 0x200006a0
11155 Start address 0x2000061c, load size 1720
11156 Transfer rate: 22 KB/sec, 573 bytes/write.
11157 (gdb) continue
11158 Continuing.
11159 ...
11160 @end example
11161
11162 You could then interrupt the GDB session to make the program break,
11163 type @command{where} to show the stack, @command{list} to show the
11164 code around the program counter, @command{step} through code,
11165 set breakpoints or watchpoints, and so on.
11166
11167 @section Configuring GDB for OpenOCD
11168
11169 OpenOCD supports the gdb @option{qSupported} packet, this enables information
11170 to be sent by the GDB remote server (i.e. OpenOCD) to GDB. Typical information includes
11171 packet size and the device's memory map.
11172 You do not need to configure the packet size by hand,
11173 and the relevant parts of the memory map should be automatically
11174 set up when you declare (NOR) flash banks.
11175
11176 However, there are other things which GDB can't currently query.
11177 You may need to set those up by hand.
11178 As OpenOCD starts up, you will often see a line reporting
11179 something like:
11180
11181 @example
11182 Info : lm3s.cpu: hardware has 6 breakpoints, 4 watchpoints
11183 @end example
11184
11185 You can pass that information to GDB with these commands:
11186
11187 @example
11188 set remote hardware-breakpoint-limit 6
11189 set remote hardware-watchpoint-limit 4
11190 @end example
11191
11192 With that particular hardware (Cortex-M3) the hardware breakpoints
11193 only work for code running from flash memory. Most other ARM systems
11194 do not have such restrictions.
11195
11196 Rather than typing such commands interactively, you may prefer to
11197 save them in a file and have GDB execute them as it starts, perhaps
11198 using a @file{.gdbinit} in your project directory or starting GDB
11199 using @command{gdb -x filename}.
11200
11201 @section Programming using GDB
11202 @cindex Programming using GDB
11203 @anchor{programmingusinggdb}
11204
11205 By default the target memory map is sent to GDB. This can be disabled by
11206 the following OpenOCD configuration option:
11207 @example
11208 gdb_memory_map disable
11209 @end example
11210 For this to function correctly a valid flash configuration must also be set
11211 in OpenOCD. For faster performance you should also configure a valid
11212 working area.
11213
11214 Informing GDB of the memory map of the target will enable GDB to protect any
11215 flash areas of the target and use hardware breakpoints by default. This means
11216 that the OpenOCD option @command{gdb_breakpoint_override} is not required when
11217 using a memory map. @xref{gdbbreakpointoverride,,gdb_breakpoint_override}.
11218
11219 To view the configured memory map in GDB, use the GDB command @option{info mem}.
11220 All other unassigned addresses within GDB are treated as RAM.
11221
11222 GDB 6.8 and higher set any memory area not in the memory map as inaccessible.
11223 This can be changed to the old behaviour by using the following GDB command
11224 @example
11225 set mem inaccessible-by-default off
11226 @end example
11227
11228 If @command{gdb_flash_program enable} is also used, GDB will be able to
11229 program any flash memory using the vFlash interface.
11230
11231 GDB will look at the target memory map when a load command is given, if any
11232 areas to be programmed lie within the target flash area the vFlash packets
11233 will be used.
11234
11235 If the target needs configuring before GDB programming, set target
11236 event gdb-flash-erase-start:
11237 @example
11238 $_TARGETNAME configure -event gdb-flash-erase-start BODY
11239 @end example
11240 @xref{targetevents,,Target Events}, for other GDB programming related events.
11241
11242 To verify any flash programming the GDB command @option{compare-sections}
11243 can be used.
11244
11245 @section Using GDB as a non-intrusive memory inspector
11246 @cindex Using GDB as a non-intrusive memory inspector
11247 @anchor{gdbmeminspect}
11248
11249 If your project controls more than a blinking LED, let's say a heavy industrial
11250 robot or an experimental nuclear reactor, stopping the controlling process
11251 just because you want to attach GDB is not a good option.
11252
11253 OpenOCD does not support GDB non-stop mode (might be implemented in the future).
11254 Though there is a possible setup where the target does not get stopped
11255 and GDB treats it as it were running.
11256 If the target supports background access to memory while it is running,
11257 you can use GDB in this mode to inspect memory (mainly global variables)
11258 without any intrusion of the target process.
11259
11260 Remove default setting of gdb-attach event. @xref{targetevents,,Target Events}.
11261 Place following command after target configuration:
11262 @example
11263 $_TARGETNAME configure -event gdb-attach @{@}
11264 @end example
11265
11266 If any of installed flash banks does not support probe on running target,
11267 switch off gdb_memory_map:
11268 @example
11269 gdb_memory_map disable
11270 @end example
11271
11272 Ensure GDB is configured without interrupt-on-connect.
11273 Some GDB versions set it by default, some does not.
11274 @example
11275 set remote interrupt-on-connect off
11276 @end example
11277
11278 If you switched gdb_memory_map off, you may want to setup GDB memory map
11279 manually or issue @command{set mem inaccessible-by-default off}
11280
11281 Now you can issue GDB command @command{target extended-remote ...} and inspect memory
11282 of a running target. Do not use GDB commands @command{continue},
11283 @command{step} or @command{next} as they synchronize GDB with your target
11284 and GDB would require stopping the target to get the prompt back.
11285
11286 Do not use this mode under an IDE like Eclipse as it caches values of
11287 previously shown variables.
11288
11289 It's also possible to connect more than one GDB to the same target by the
11290 target's configuration option @code{-gdb-max-connections}. This allows, for
11291 example, one GDB to run a script that continuously polls a set of variables
11292 while other GDB can be used interactively. Be extremely careful in this case,
11293 because the two GDB can easily get out-of-sync.
11294
11295 @section RTOS Support
11296 @cindex RTOS Support
11297 @anchor{gdbrtossupport}
11298
11299 OpenOCD includes RTOS support, this will however need enabling as it defaults to disabled.
11300 It can be enabled by passing @option{-rtos} arg to the target. @xref{rtostype,,RTOS Type}.
11301
11302 @xref{Threads, Debugging Programs with Multiple Threads,
11303 Debugging Programs with Multiple Threads, gdb, GDB manual}, for details about relevant
11304 GDB commands.
11305
11306 @* An example setup is below:
11307
11308 @example
11309 $_TARGETNAME configure -rtos auto
11310 @end example
11311
11312 This will attempt to auto detect the RTOS within your application.
11313
11314 Currently supported rtos's include:
11315 @itemize @bullet
11316 @item @option{eCos}
11317 @item @option{ThreadX}
11318 @item @option{FreeRTOS}
11319 @item @option{linux}
11320 @item @option{ChibiOS}
11321 @item @option{embKernel}
11322 @item @option{mqx}
11323 @item @option{uCOS-III}
11324 @item @option{nuttx}
11325 @item @option{RIOT}
11326 @item @option{hwthread} (This is not an actual RTOS. @xref{usingopenocdsmpwithgdb,,Using OpenOCD SMP with GDB}.)
11327 @item @option{Zephyr}
11328 @end itemize
11329
11330 Before an RTOS can be detected, it must export certain symbols; otherwise, it cannot
11331 be used by OpenOCD. Below is a list of the required symbols for each supported RTOS.
11332
11333 @table @code
11334 @item eCos symbols
11335 Cyg_Thread::thread_list, Cyg_Scheduler_Base::current_thread.
11336 @item ThreadX symbols
11337 _tx_thread_current_ptr, _tx_thread_created_ptr, _tx_thread_created_count.
11338 @item FreeRTOS symbols
11339 @raggedright
11340 pxCurrentTCB, pxReadyTasksLists, xDelayedTaskList1, xDelayedTaskList2,
11341 pxDelayedTaskList, pxOverflowDelayedTaskList, xPendingReadyList,
11342 uxCurrentNumberOfTasks, uxTopUsedPriority.
11343 @end raggedright
11344 @item linux symbols
11345 init_task.
11346 @item ChibiOS symbols
11347 rlist, ch_debug, chSysInit.
11348 @item embKernel symbols
11349 Rtos::sCurrentTask, Rtos::sListReady, Rtos::sListSleep,
11350 Rtos::sListSuspended, Rtos::sMaxPriorities, Rtos::sCurrentTaskCount.
11351 @item mqx symbols
11352 _mqx_kernel_data, MQX_init_struct.
11353 @item uC/OS-III symbols
11354 OSRunning, OSTCBCurPtr, OSTaskDbgListPtr, OSTaskQty.
11355 @item nuttx symbols
11356 g_readytorun, g_tasklisttable.
11357 @item RIOT symbols
11358 @raggedright
11359 sched_threads, sched_num_threads, sched_active_pid, max_threads,
11360 _tcb_name_offset.
11361 @end raggedright
11362 @item Zephyr symbols
11363 _kernel, _kernel_openocd_offsets, _kernel_openocd_size_t_size
11364 @end table
11365
11366 For most RTOS supported the above symbols will be exported by default. However for
11367 some, eg. FreeRTOS, uC/OS-III and Zephyr, extra steps must be taken.
11368
11369 Zephyr must be compiled with the DEBUG_THREAD_INFO option. This will generate some symbols
11370 with information needed in order to build the list of threads.
11371
11372 FreeRTOS and uC/OS-III RTOSes may require additional OpenOCD-specific file to be linked
11373 along with the project:
11374
11375 @table @code
11376 @item FreeRTOS
11377 contrib/rtos-helpers/FreeRTOS-openocd.c
11378 @item uC/OS-III
11379 contrib/rtos-helpers/uCOS-III-openocd.c
11380 @end table
11381
11382 @anchor{usingopenocdsmpwithgdb}
11383 @section Using OpenOCD SMP with GDB
11384 @cindex SMP
11385 @cindex RTOS
11386 @cindex hwthread
11387 OpenOCD includes a pseudo RTOS called @emph{hwthread} that presents CPU cores
11388 ("hardware threads") in an SMP system as threads to GDB. With this extension,
11389 GDB can be used to inspect the state of an SMP system in a natural way.
11390 After halting the system, using the GDB command @command{info threads} will
11391 list the context of each active CPU core in the system. GDB's @command{thread}
11392 command can be used to switch the view to a different CPU core.
11393 The @command{step} and @command{stepi} commands can be used to step a specific core
11394 while other cores are free-running or remain halted, depending on the
11395 scheduler-locking mode configured in GDB.
11396
11397 @section Legacy SMP core switching support
11398 @quotation Note
11399 This method is deprecated in favor of the @emph{hwthread} pseudo RTOS.
11400 @end quotation
11401
11402 For SMP support following GDB serial protocol packet have been defined :
11403 @itemize @bullet
11404 @item j - smp status request
11405 @item J - smp set request
11406 @end itemize
11407
11408 OpenOCD implements :
11409 @itemize @bullet
11410 @item @option{jc} packet for reading core id displayed by
11411 GDB connection. Reply is @option{XXXXXXXX} (8 hex digits giving core id) or
11412 @option{E01} for target not smp.
11413 @item @option{JcXXXXXXXX} (8 hex digits) packet for setting core id displayed at next GDB continue
11414 (core id -1 is reserved for returning to normal resume mode). Reply @option{E01}
11415 for target not smp or @option{OK} on success.
11416 @end itemize
11417
11418 Handling of this packet within GDB can be done :
11419 @itemize @bullet
11420 @item by the creation of an internal variable (i.e @option{_core}) by mean
11421 of function allocate_computed_value allowing following GDB command.
11422 @example
11423 set $_core 1
11424 #Jc01 packet is sent
11425 print $_core
11426 #jc packet is sent and result is affected in $
11427 @end example
11428
11429 @item by the usage of GDB maintenance command as described in following example (2 cpus in SMP with
11430 core id 0 and 1 @pxref{definecputargetsworkinginsmp,,Define CPU targets working in SMP}).
11431
11432 @example
11433 # toggle0 : force display of coreid 0
11434 define toggle0
11435 maint packet Jc0
11436 continue
11437 main packet Jc-1
11438 end
11439 # toggle1 : force display of coreid 1
11440 define toggle1
11441 maint packet Jc1
11442 continue
11443 main packet Jc-1
11444 end
11445 @end example
11446 @end itemize
11447
11448 @node Tcl Scripting API
11449 @chapter Tcl Scripting API
11450 @cindex Tcl Scripting API
11451 @cindex Tcl scripts
11452 @section API rules
11453
11454 Tcl commands are stateless; e.g. the @command{telnet} command has
11455 a concept of currently active target, the Tcl API proc's take this sort
11456 of state information as an argument to each proc.
11457
11458 There are three main types of return values: single value, name value
11459 pair list and lists.
11460
11461 Name value pair. The proc 'foo' below returns a name/value pair
11462 list.
11463
11464 @example
11465 > set foo(me) Duane
11466 > set foo(you) Oyvind
11467 > set foo(mouse) Micky
11468 > set foo(duck) Donald
11469 @end example
11470
11471 If one does this:
11472
11473 @example
11474 > set foo
11475 @end example
11476
11477 The result is:
11478
11479 @example
11480 me Duane you Oyvind mouse Micky duck Donald
11481 @end example
11482
11483 Thus, to get the names of the associative array is easy:
11484
11485 @verbatim
11486 foreach { name value } [set foo] {
11487 puts "Name: $name, Value: $value"
11488 }
11489 @end verbatim
11490
11491 Lists returned should be relatively small. Otherwise, a range
11492 should be passed in to the proc in question.
11493
11494 @section Internal low-level Commands
11495
11496 By "low-level", we mean commands that a human would typically not
11497 invoke directly.
11498
11499 @itemize @bullet
11500 @item @b{mem2array} <@var{varname}> <@var{width}> <@var{addr}> <@var{nelems}>
11501
11502 Read memory and return as a Tcl array for script processing
11503 @item @b{array2mem} <@var{varname}> <@var{width}> <@var{addr}> <@var{nelems}>
11504
11505 Convert a Tcl array to memory locations and write the values
11506 @item @b{flash banks} <@var{driver}> <@var{base}> <@var{size}> <@var{chip_width}> <@var{bus_width}> <@var{target}> [@option{driver options} ...]
11507
11508 Return information about the flash banks
11509
11510 @item @b{capture} <@var{command}>
11511
11512 Run <@var{command}> and return full log output that was produced during
11513 its execution. Example:
11514
11515 @example
11516 > capture "reset init"
11517 @end example
11518
11519 @end itemize
11520
11521 OpenOCD commands can consist of two words, e.g. "flash banks". The
11522 @file{startup.tcl} "unknown" proc will translate this into a Tcl proc
11523 called "flash_banks".
11524
11525 @section Tcl RPC server
11526 @cindex RPC
11527
11528 OpenOCD provides a simple RPC server that allows to run arbitrary Tcl
11529 commands and receive the results.
11530
11531 To access it, your application needs to connect to a configured TCP port
11532 (see @command{tcl_port}). Then it can pass any string to the
11533 interpreter terminating it with @code{0x1a} and wait for the return
11534 value (it will be terminated with @code{0x1a} as well). This can be
11535 repeated as many times as desired without reopening the connection.
11536
11537 It is not needed anymore to prefix the OpenOCD commands with
11538 @code{ocd_} to get the results back. But sometimes you might need the
11539 @command{capture} command.
11540
11541 See @file{contrib/rpc_examples/} for specific client implementations.
11542
11543 @section Tcl RPC server notifications
11544 @cindex RPC Notifications
11545
11546 Notifications are sent asynchronously to other commands being executed over
11547 the RPC server, so the port must be polled continuously.
11548
11549 Target event, state and reset notifications are emitted as Tcl associative arrays
11550 in the following format.
11551
11552 @verbatim
11553 type target_event event [event-name]
11554 type target_state state [state-name]
11555 type target_reset mode [reset-mode]
11556 @end verbatim
11557
11558 @deffn {Command} {tcl_notifications} [on/off]
11559 Toggle output of target notifications to the current Tcl RPC server.
11560 Only available from the Tcl RPC server.
11561 Defaults to off.
11562
11563 @end deffn
11564
11565 @section Tcl RPC server trace output
11566 @cindex RPC trace output
11567
11568 Trace data is sent asynchronously to other commands being executed over
11569 the RPC server, so the port must be polled continuously.
11570
11571 Target trace data is emitted as a Tcl associative array in the following format.
11572
11573 @verbatim
11574 type target_trace data [trace-data-hex-encoded]
11575 @end verbatim
11576
11577 @deffn {Command} {tcl_trace} [on/off]
11578 Toggle output of target trace data to the current Tcl RPC server.
11579 Only available from the Tcl RPC server.
11580 Defaults to off.
11581
11582 See an example application here:
11583 @url{https://github.com/apmorton/OpenOcdTraceUtil} [OpenOcdTraceUtil]
11584
11585 @end deffn
11586
11587 @node FAQ
11588 @chapter FAQ
11589 @cindex faq
11590 @enumerate
11591 @anchor{faqrtck}
11592 @item @b{RTCK, also known as: Adaptive Clocking - What is it?}
11593 @cindex RTCK
11594 @cindex adaptive clocking
11595 @*
11596
11597 In digital circuit design it is often referred to as ``clock
11598 synchronisation'' the JTAG interface uses one clock (TCK or TCLK)
11599 operating at some speed, your CPU target is operating at another.
11600 The two clocks are not synchronised, they are ``asynchronous''
11601
11602 In order for the two to work together they must be synchronised
11603 well enough to work; JTAG can't go ten times faster than the CPU,
11604 for example. There are 2 basic options:
11605 @enumerate
11606 @item
11607 Use a special "adaptive clocking" circuit to change the JTAG
11608 clock rate to match what the CPU currently supports.
11609 @item
11610 The JTAG clock must be fixed at some speed that's enough slower than
11611 the CPU clock that all TMS and TDI transitions can be detected.
11612 @end enumerate
11613
11614 @b{Does this really matter?} For some chips and some situations, this
11615 is a non-issue, like a 500MHz ARM926 with a 5 MHz JTAG link;
11616 the CPU has no difficulty keeping up with JTAG.
11617 Startup sequences are often problematic though, as are other
11618 situations where the CPU clock rate changes (perhaps to save
11619 power).
11620
11621 For example, Atmel AT91SAM chips start operation from reset with
11622 a 32kHz system clock. Boot firmware may activate the main oscillator
11623 and PLL before switching to a faster clock (perhaps that 500 MHz
11624 ARM926 scenario).
11625 If you're using JTAG to debug that startup sequence, you must slow
11626 the JTAG clock to sometimes 1 to 4kHz. After startup completes,
11627 JTAG can use a faster clock.
11628
11629 Consider also debugging a 500MHz ARM926 hand held battery powered
11630 device that enters a low power ``deep sleep'' mode, at 32kHz CPU
11631 clock, between keystrokes unless it has work to do. When would
11632 that 5 MHz JTAG clock be usable?
11633
11634 @b{Solution #1 - A special circuit}
11635
11636 In order to make use of this,
11637 your CPU, board, and JTAG adapter must all support the RTCK
11638 feature. Not all of them support this; keep reading!
11639
11640 The RTCK ("Return TCK") signal in some ARM chips is used to help with
11641 this problem. ARM has a good description of the problem described at
11642 this link: @url{http://www.arm.com/support/faqdev/4170.html} [checked
11643 28/nov/2008]. Link title: ``How does the JTAG synchronisation logic
11644 work? / how does adaptive clocking work?''.
11645
11646 The nice thing about adaptive clocking is that ``battery powered hand
11647 held device example'' - the adaptiveness works perfectly all the
11648 time. One can set a break point or halt the system in the deep power
11649 down code, slow step out until the system speeds up.
11650
11651 Note that adaptive clocking may also need to work at the board level,
11652 when a board-level scan chain has multiple chips.
11653 Parallel clock voting schemes are good way to implement this,
11654 both within and between chips, and can easily be implemented
11655 with a CPLD.
11656 It's not difficult to have logic fan a module's input TCK signal out
11657 to each TAP in the scan chain, and then wait until each TAP's RTCK comes
11658 back with the right polarity before changing the output RTCK signal.
11659 Texas Instruments makes some clock voting logic available
11660 for free (with no support) in VHDL form; see
11661 @url{http://tiexpressdsp.com/index.php/Adaptive_Clocking}
11662
11663 @b{Solution #2 - Always works - but may be slower}
11664
11665 Often this is a perfectly acceptable solution.
11666
11667 In most simple terms: Often the JTAG clock must be 1/10 to 1/12 of
11668 the target clock speed. But what that ``magic division'' is varies
11669 depending on the chips on your board.
11670 @b{ARM rule of thumb} Most ARM based systems require an 6:1 division;
11671 ARM11 cores use an 8:1 division.
11672 @b{Xilinx rule of thumb} is 1/12 the clock speed.
11673
11674 Note: most full speed FT2232 based JTAG adapters are limited to a
11675 maximum of 6MHz. The ones using USB high speed chips (FT2232H)
11676 often support faster clock rates (and adaptive clocking).
11677
11678 You can still debug the 'low power' situations - you just need to
11679 either use a fixed and very slow JTAG clock rate ... or else
11680 manually adjust the clock speed at every step. (Adjusting is painful
11681 and tedious, and is not always practical.)
11682
11683 It is however easy to ``code your way around it'' - i.e.: Cheat a little,
11684 have a special debug mode in your application that does a ``high power
11685 sleep''. If you are careful - 98% of your problems can be debugged
11686 this way.
11687
11688 Note that on ARM you may need to avoid using the @emph{wait for interrupt}
11689 operation in your idle loops even if you don't otherwise change the CPU
11690 clock rate.
11691 That operation gates the CPU clock, and thus the JTAG clock; which
11692 prevents JTAG access. One consequence is not being able to @command{halt}
11693 cores which are executing that @emph{wait for interrupt} operation.
11694
11695 To set the JTAG frequency use the command:
11696
11697 @example
11698 # Example: 1.234MHz
11699 adapter speed 1234
11700 @end example
11701
11702
11703 @item @b{Win32 Pathnames} Why don't backslashes work in Windows paths?
11704
11705 OpenOCD uses Tcl and a backslash is an escape char. Use @{ and @}
11706 around Windows filenames.
11707
11708 @example
11709 > echo \a
11710
11711 > echo @{\a@}
11712 \a
11713 > echo "\a"
11714
11715 >
11716 @end example
11717
11718
11719 @item @b{Missing: cygwin1.dll} OpenOCD complains about a missing cygwin1.dll.
11720
11721 Make sure you have Cygwin installed, or at least a version of OpenOCD that
11722 claims to come with all the necessary DLLs. When using Cygwin, try launching
11723 OpenOCD from the Cygwin shell.
11724
11725 @item @b{Breakpoint Issue} I'm trying to set a breakpoint using GDB (or a front-end like Insight or
11726 Eclipse), but OpenOCD complains that "Info: arm7_9_common.c:213
11727 arm7_9_add_breakpoint(): sw breakpoint requested, but software breakpoints not enabled".
11728
11729 GDB issues software breakpoints when a normal breakpoint is requested, or to implement
11730 source-line single-stepping. On ARMv4T systems, like ARM7TDMI, ARM720T or ARM920T,
11731 software breakpoints consume one of the two available hardware breakpoints.
11732
11733 @item @b{LPC2000 Flash} When erasing or writing LPC2000 on-chip flash, the operation fails at random.
11734
11735 Make sure the core frequency specified in the @option{flash lpc2000} line matches the
11736 clock at the time you're programming the flash. If you've specified the crystal's
11737 frequency, make sure the PLL is disabled. If you've specified the full core speed
11738 (e.g. 60MHz), make sure the PLL is enabled.
11739
11740 @item @b{Amontec Chameleon} When debugging using an Amontec Chameleon in its JTAG Accelerator configuration,
11741 I keep getting "Error: amt_jtagaccel.c:184 amt_wait_scan_busy(): amt_jtagaccel timed
11742 out while waiting for end of scan, rtck was disabled".
11743
11744 Make sure your PC's parallel port operates in EPP mode. You might have to try several
11745 settings in your PC BIOS (ECP, EPP, and different versions of those).
11746
11747 @item @b{Data Aborts} When debugging with OpenOCD and GDB (plain GDB, Insight, or Eclipse),
11748 I get lots of "Error: arm7_9_common.c:1771 arm7_9_read_memory():
11749 memory read caused data abort".
11750
11751 The errors are non-fatal, and are the result of GDB trying to trace stack frames
11752 beyond the last valid frame. It might be possible to prevent this by setting up
11753 a proper "initial" stack frame, if you happen to know what exactly has to
11754 be done, feel free to add this here.
11755
11756 @b{Simple:} In your startup code - push 8 registers of zeros onto the
11757 stack before calling main(). What GDB is doing is ``climbing'' the run
11758 time stack by reading various values on the stack using the standard
11759 call frame for the target. GDB keeps going - until one of 2 things
11760 happen @b{#1} an invalid frame is found, or @b{#2} some huge number of
11761 stackframes have been processed. By pushing zeros on the stack, GDB
11762 gracefully stops.
11763
11764 @b{Debugging Interrupt Service Routines} - In your ISR before you call
11765 your C code, do the same - artificially push some zeros onto the stack,
11766 remember to pop them off when the ISR is done.
11767
11768 @b{Also note:} If you have a multi-threaded operating system, they
11769 often do not @b{in the interest of saving memory} waste these few
11770 bytes. Painful...
11771
11772
11773 @item @b{JTAG Reset Config} I get the following message in the OpenOCD console (or log file):
11774 "Warning: arm7_9_common.c:679 arm7_9_assert_reset(): srst resets test logic, too".
11775
11776 This warning doesn't indicate any serious problem, as long as you don't want to
11777 debug your core right out of reset. Your .cfg file specified @option{reset_config
11778 trst_and_srst srst_pulls_trst} to tell OpenOCD that either your board,
11779 your debugger or your target uC (e.g. LPC2000) can't assert the two reset signals
11780 independently. With this setup, it's not possible to halt the core right out of
11781 reset, everything else should work fine.
11782
11783 @item @b{USB Power} When using OpenOCD in conjunction with Amontec JTAGkey and the Yagarto
11784 toolchain (Eclipse, arm-elf-gcc, arm-elf-gdb), the debugging seems to be
11785 unstable. When single-stepping over large blocks of code, GDB and OpenOCD
11786 quit with an error message. Is there a stability issue with OpenOCD?
11787
11788 No, this is not a stability issue concerning OpenOCD. Most users have solved
11789 this issue by simply using a self-powered USB hub, which they connect their
11790 Amontec JTAGkey to. Apparently, some computers do not provide a USB power
11791 supply stable enough for the Amontec JTAGkey to be operated.
11792
11793 @b{Laptops running on battery have this problem too...}
11794
11795 @item @b{GDB Disconnects} When using the Amontec JTAGkey, sometimes OpenOCD crashes with the following
11796 error message: "Error: gdb_server.c:101 gdb_get_char(): read: 10054".
11797 What does that mean and what might be the reason for this?
11798
11799 Error code 10054 corresponds to WSAECONNRESET, which means that the debugger (GDB)
11800 has closed the connection to OpenOCD. This might be a GDB issue.
11801
11802 @item @b{LPC2000 Flash} In the configuration file in the section where flash device configurations
11803 are described, there is a parameter for specifying the clock frequency
11804 for LPC2000 internal flash devices (e.g. @option{flash bank $_FLASHNAME lpc2000
11805 0x0 0x40000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME lpc2000_v1 14746 calc_checksum}), which must be
11806 specified in kilohertz. However, I do have a quartz crystal of a
11807 frequency that contains fractions of kilohertz (e.g. 14,745,600 Hz,
11808 i.e. 14,745.600 kHz). Is it possible to specify real numbers for the
11809 clock frequency?
11810
11811 No. The clock frequency specified here must be given as an integral number.
11812 However, this clock frequency is used by the In-Application-Programming (IAP)
11813 routines of the LPC2000 family only, which seems to be very tolerant concerning
11814 the given clock frequency, so a slight difference between the specified clock
11815 frequency and the actual clock frequency will not cause any trouble.
11816
11817 @item @b{Command Order} Do I have to keep a specific order for the commands in the configuration file?
11818
11819 Well, yes and no. Commands can be given in arbitrary order, yet the
11820 devices listed for the JTAG scan chain must be given in the right
11821 order (jtag newdevice), with the device closest to the TDO-Pin being
11822 listed first. In general, whenever objects of the same type exist
11823 which require an index number, then these objects must be given in the
11824 right order (jtag newtap, targets and flash banks - a target
11825 references a jtag newtap and a flash bank references a target).
11826
11827 You can use the ``scan_chain'' command to verify and display the tap order.
11828
11829 Also, some commands can't execute until after @command{init} has been
11830 processed. Such commands include @command{nand probe} and everything
11831 else that needs to write to controller registers, perhaps for setting
11832 up DRAM and loading it with code.
11833
11834 @anchor{faqtaporder}
11835 @item @b{JTAG TAP Order} Do I have to declare the TAPS in some
11836 particular order?
11837
11838 Yes; whenever you have more than one, you must declare them in
11839 the same order used by the hardware.
11840
11841 Many newer devices have multiple JTAG TAPs. For example:
11842 STMicroelectronics STM32 chips have two TAPs, a ``boundary scan TAP'' and
11843 ``Cortex-M3'' TAP. Example: The STM32 reference manual, Document ID:
11844 RM0008, Section 26.5, Figure 259, page 651/681, the ``TDI'' pin is
11845 connected to the boundary scan TAP, which then connects to the
11846 Cortex-M3 TAP, which then connects to the TDO pin.
11847
11848 Thus, the proper order for the STM32 chip is: (1) The Cortex-M3, then
11849 (2) The boundary scan TAP. If your board includes an additional JTAG
11850 chip in the scan chain (for example a Xilinx CPLD or FPGA) you could
11851 place it before or after the STM32 chip in the chain. For example:
11852
11853 @itemize @bullet
11854 @item OpenOCD_TDI(output) -> STM32 TDI Pin (BS Input)
11855 @item STM32 BS TDO (output) -> STM32 Cortex-M3 TDI (input)
11856 @item STM32 Cortex-M3 TDO (output) -> SM32 TDO Pin
11857 @item STM32 TDO Pin (output) -> Xilinx TDI Pin (input)
11858 @item Xilinx TDO Pin -> OpenOCD TDO (input)
11859 @end itemize
11860
11861 The ``jtag device'' commands would thus be in the order shown below. Note:
11862
11863 @itemize @bullet
11864 @item jtag newtap Xilinx tap -irlen ...
11865 @item jtag newtap stm32 cpu -irlen ...
11866 @item jtag newtap stm32 bs -irlen ...
11867 @item # Create the debug target and say where it is
11868 @item target create stm32.cpu -chain-position stm32.cpu ...
11869 @end itemize
11870
11871
11872 @item @b{SYSCOMP} Sometimes my debugging session terminates with an error. When I look into the
11873 log file, I can see these error messages: Error: arm7_9_common.c:561
11874 arm7_9_execute_sys_speed(): timeout waiting for SYSCOMP
11875
11876 TODO.
11877
11878 @end enumerate
11879
11880 @node Tcl Crash Course
11881 @chapter Tcl Crash Course
11882 @cindex Tcl
11883
11884 Not everyone knows Tcl - this is not intended to be a replacement for
11885 learning Tcl, the intent of this chapter is to give you some idea of
11886 how the Tcl scripts work.
11887
11888 This chapter is written with two audiences in mind. (1) OpenOCD users
11889 who need to understand a bit more of how Jim-Tcl works so they can do
11890 something useful, and (2) those that want to add a new command to
11891 OpenOCD.
11892
11893 @section Tcl Rule #1
11894 There is a famous joke, it goes like this:
11895 @enumerate
11896 @item Rule #1: The wife is always correct
11897 @item Rule #2: If you think otherwise, See Rule #1
11898 @end enumerate
11899
11900 The Tcl equal is this:
11901
11902 @enumerate
11903 @item Rule #1: Everything is a string
11904 @item Rule #2: If you think otherwise, See Rule #1
11905 @end enumerate
11906
11907 As in the famous joke, the consequences of Rule #1 are profound. Once
11908 you understand Rule #1, you will understand Tcl.
11909
11910 @section Tcl Rule #1b
11911 There is a second pair of rules.
11912 @enumerate
11913 @item Rule #1: Control flow does not exist. Only commands
11914 @* For example: the classic FOR loop or IF statement is not a control
11915 flow item, they are commands, there is no such thing as control flow
11916 in Tcl.
11917 @item Rule #2: If you think otherwise, See Rule #1
11918 @* Actually what happens is this: There are commands that by
11919 convention, act like control flow key words in other languages. One of
11920 those commands is the word ``for'', another command is ``if''.
11921 @end enumerate
11922
11923 @section Per Rule #1 - All Results are strings
11924 Every Tcl command results in a string. The word ``result'' is used
11925 deliberately. No result is just an empty string. Remember: @i{Rule #1 -
11926 Everything is a string}
11927
11928 @section Tcl Quoting Operators
11929 In life of a Tcl script, there are two important periods of time, the
11930 difference is subtle.
11931 @enumerate
11932 @item Parse Time
11933 @item Evaluation Time
11934 @end enumerate
11935
11936 The two key items here are how ``quoted things'' work in Tcl. Tcl has
11937 three primary quoting constructs, the [square-brackets] the
11938 @{curly-braces@} and ``double-quotes''
11939
11940 By now you should know $VARIABLES always start with a $DOLLAR
11941 sign. BTW: To set a variable, you actually use the command ``set'', as
11942 in ``set VARNAME VALUE'' much like the ancient BASIC language ``let x
11943 = 1'' statement, but without the equal sign.
11944
11945 @itemize @bullet
11946 @item @b{[square-brackets]}
11947 @* @b{[square-brackets]} are command substitutions. It operates much
11948 like Unix Shell `back-ticks`. The result of a [square-bracket]
11949 operation is exactly 1 string. @i{Remember Rule #1 - Everything is a
11950 string}. These two statements are roughly identical:
11951 @example
11952 # bash example
11953 X=`date`
11954 echo "The Date is: $X"
11955 # Tcl example
11956 set X [date]
11957 puts "The Date is: $X"
11958 @end example
11959 @item @b{``double-quoted-things''}
11960 @* @b{``double-quoted-things''} are just simply quoted
11961 text. $VARIABLES and [square-brackets] are expanded in place - the
11962 result however is exactly 1 string. @i{Remember Rule #1 - Everything
11963 is a string}
11964 @example
11965 set x "Dinner"
11966 puts "It is now \"[date]\", $x is in 1 hour"
11967 @end example
11968 @item @b{@{Curly-Braces@}}
11969 @*@b{@{Curly-Braces@}} are magic: $VARIABLES and [square-brackets] are
11970 parsed, but are NOT expanded or executed. @{Curly-Braces@} are like
11971 'single-quote' operators in BASH shell scripts, with the added
11972 feature: @{curly-braces@} can be nested, single quotes can not. @{@{@{this is
11973 nested 3 times@}@}@} NOTE: [date] is a bad example;
11974 at this writing, Jim/OpenOCD does not have a date command.
11975 @end itemize
11976
11977 @section Consequences of Rule 1/2/3/4
11978
11979 The consequences of Rule 1 are profound.
11980
11981 @subsection Tokenisation & Execution.
11982
11983 Of course, whitespace, blank lines and #comment lines are handled in
11984 the normal way.
11985
11986 As a script is parsed, each (multi) line in the script file is
11987 tokenised and according to the quoting rules. After tokenisation, that
11988 line is immediately executed.
11989
11990 Multi line statements end with one or more ``still-open''
11991 @{curly-braces@} which - eventually - closes a few lines later.
11992
11993 @subsection Command Execution
11994
11995 Remember earlier: There are no ``control flow''
11996 statements in Tcl. Instead there are COMMANDS that simply act like
11997 control flow operators.
11998
11999 Commands are executed like this:
12000
12001 @enumerate
12002 @item Parse the next line into (argc) and (argv[]).
12003 @item Look up (argv[0]) in a table and call its function.
12004 @item Repeat until End Of File.
12005 @end enumerate
12006
12007 It sort of works like this:
12008 @example
12009 for(;;)@{
12010 ReadAndParse( &argc, &argv );
12011
12012 cmdPtr = LookupCommand( argv[0] );
12013
12014 (*cmdPtr->Execute)( argc, argv );
12015 @}
12016 @end example
12017
12018 When the command ``proc'' is parsed (which creates a procedure
12019 function) it gets 3 parameters on the command line. @b{1} the name of
12020 the proc (function), @b{2} the list of parameters, and @b{3} the body
12021 of the function. Not the choice of words: LIST and BODY. The PROC
12022 command stores these items in a table somewhere so it can be found by
12023 ``LookupCommand()''
12024
12025 @subsection The FOR command
12026
12027 The most interesting command to look at is the FOR command. In Tcl,
12028 the FOR command is normally implemented in C. Remember, FOR is a
12029 command just like any other command.
12030
12031 When the ascii text containing the FOR command is parsed, the parser
12032 produces 5 parameter strings, @i{(If in doubt: Refer to Rule #1)} they
12033 are:
12034
12035 @enumerate 0
12036 @item The ascii text 'for'
12037 @item The start text
12038 @item The test expression
12039 @item The next text
12040 @item The body text
12041 @end enumerate
12042
12043 Sort of reminds you of ``main( int argc, char **argv )'' does it not?
12044 Remember @i{Rule #1 - Everything is a string.} The key point is this:
12045 Often many of those parameters are in @{curly-braces@} - thus the
12046 variables inside are not expanded or replaced until later.
12047
12048 Remember that every Tcl command looks like the classic ``main( argc,
12049 argv )'' function in C. In JimTCL - they actually look like this:
12050
12051 @example
12052 int
12053 MyCommand( Jim_Interp *interp,
12054 int *argc,
12055 Jim_Obj * const *argvs );
12056 @end example
12057
12058 Real Tcl is nearly identical. Although the newer versions have
12059 introduced a byte-code parser and interpreter, but at the core, it
12060 still operates in the same basic way.
12061
12062 @subsection FOR command implementation
12063
12064 To understand Tcl it is perhaps most helpful to see the FOR
12065 command. Remember, it is a COMMAND not a control flow structure.
12066
12067 In Tcl there are two underlying C helper functions.
12068
12069 Remember Rule #1 - You are a string.
12070
12071 The @b{first} helper parses and executes commands found in an ascii
12072 string. Commands can be separated by semicolons, or newlines. While
12073 parsing, variables are expanded via the quoting rules.
12074
12075 The @b{second} helper evaluates an ascii string as a numerical
12076 expression and returns a value.
12077
12078 Here is an example of how the @b{FOR} command could be
12079 implemented. The pseudo code below does not show error handling.
12080 @example
12081 void Execute_AsciiString( void *interp, const char *string );
12082
12083 int Evaluate_AsciiExpression( void *interp, const char *string );
12084
12085 int
12086 MyForCommand( void *interp,
12087 int argc,
12088 char **argv )
12089 @{
12090 if( argc != 5 )@{
12091 SetResult( interp, "WRONG number of parameters");
12092 return ERROR;
12093 @}
12094
12095 // argv[0] = the ascii string just like C
12096
12097 // Execute the start statement.
12098 Execute_AsciiString( interp, argv[1] );
12099
12100 // Top of loop test
12101 for(;;)@{
12102 i = Evaluate_AsciiExpression(interp, argv[2]);
12103 if( i == 0 )
12104 break;
12105
12106 // Execute the body
12107 Execute_AsciiString( interp, argv[3] );
12108
12109 // Execute the LOOP part
12110 Execute_AsciiString( interp, argv[4] );
12111 @}
12112
12113 // Return no error
12114 SetResult( interp, "" );
12115 return SUCCESS;
12116 @}
12117 @end example
12118
12119 Every other command IF, WHILE, FORMAT, PUTS, EXPR, everything works
12120 in the same basic way.
12121
12122 @section OpenOCD Tcl Usage
12123
12124 @subsection source and find commands
12125 @b{Where:} In many configuration files
12126 @* Example: @b{ source [find FILENAME] }
12127 @*Remember the parsing rules
12128 @enumerate
12129 @item The @command{find} command is in square brackets,
12130 and is executed with the parameter FILENAME. It should find and return
12131 the full path to a file with that name; it uses an internal search path.
12132 The RESULT is a string, which is substituted into the command line in
12133 place of the bracketed @command{find} command.
12134 (Don't try to use a FILENAME which includes the "#" character.
12135 That character begins Tcl comments.)
12136 @item The @command{source} command is executed with the resulting filename;
12137 it reads a file and executes as a script.
12138 @end enumerate
12139 @subsection format command
12140 @b{Where:} Generally occurs in numerous places.
12141 @* Tcl has no command like @b{printf()}, instead it has @b{format}, which is really more like
12142 @b{sprintf()}.
12143 @b{Example}
12144 @example
12145 set x 6
12146 set y 7
12147 puts [format "The answer: %d" [expr @{$x * $y@}]]
12148 @end example
12149 @enumerate
12150 @item The SET command creates 2 variables, X and Y.
12151 @item The double [nested] EXPR command performs math
12152 @* The EXPR command produces numerical result as a string.
12153 @* Refer to Rule #1
12154 @item The format command is executed, producing a single string
12155 @* Refer to Rule #1.
12156 @item The PUTS command outputs the text.
12157 @end enumerate
12158 @subsection Body or Inlined Text
12159 @b{Where:} Various TARGET scripts.
12160 @example
12161 #1 Good
12162 proc someproc @{@} @{
12163 ... multiple lines of stuff ...
12164 @}
12165 $_TARGETNAME configure -event FOO someproc
12166 #2 Good - no variables
12167 $_TARGETNAME configure -event foo "this ; that;"
12168 #3 Good Curly Braces
12169 $_TARGETNAME configure -event FOO @{
12170 puts "Time: [date]"
12171 @}
12172 #4 DANGER DANGER DANGER
12173 $_TARGETNAME configure -event foo "puts \"Time: [date]\""
12174 @end example
12175 @enumerate
12176 @item The $_TARGETNAME is an OpenOCD variable convention.
12177 @*@b{$_TARGETNAME} represents the last target created, the value changes
12178 each time a new target is created. Remember the parsing rules. When
12179 the ascii text is parsed, the @b{$_TARGETNAME} becomes a simple string,
12180 the name of the target which happens to be a TARGET (object)
12181 command.
12182 @item The 2nd parameter to the @option{-event} parameter is a TCBODY
12183 @*There are 4 examples:
12184 @enumerate
12185 @item The TCLBODY is a simple string that happens to be a proc name
12186 @item The TCLBODY is several simple commands separated by semicolons
12187 @item The TCLBODY is a multi-line @{curly-brace@} quoted string
12188 @item The TCLBODY is a string with variables that get expanded.
12189 @end enumerate
12190
12191 In the end, when the target event FOO occurs the TCLBODY is
12192 evaluated. Method @b{#1} and @b{#2} are functionally identical. For
12193 Method @b{#3} and @b{#4} it is more interesting. What is the TCLBODY?
12194
12195 Remember the parsing rules. In case #3, @{curly-braces@} mean the
12196 $VARS and [square-brackets] are expanded later, when the EVENT occurs,
12197 and the text is evaluated. In case #4, they are replaced before the
12198 ``Target Object Command'' is executed. This occurs at the same time
12199 $_TARGETNAME is replaced. In case #4 the date will never
12200 change. @{BTW: [date] is a bad example; at this writing,
12201 Jim/OpenOCD does not have a date command@}
12202 @end enumerate
12203 @subsection Global Variables
12204 @b{Where:} You might discover this when writing your own procs @* In
12205 simple terms: Inside a PROC, if you need to access a global variable
12206 you must say so. See also ``upvar''. Example:
12207 @example
12208 proc myproc @{ @} @{
12209 set y 0 #Local variable Y
12210 global x #Global variable X
12211 puts [format "X=%d, Y=%d" $x $y]
12212 @}
12213 @end example
12214 @section Other Tcl Hacks
12215 @b{Dynamic variable creation}
12216 @example
12217 # Dynamically create a bunch of variables.
12218 for @{ set x 0 @} @{ $x < 32 @} @{ set x [expr @{$x + 1@}]@} @{
12219 # Create var name
12220 set vn [format "BIT%d" $x]
12221 # Make it a global
12222 global $vn
12223 # Set it.
12224 set $vn [expr @{1 << $x@}]
12225 @}
12226 @end example
12227 @b{Dynamic proc/command creation}
12228 @example
12229 # One "X" function - 5 uart functions.
12230 foreach who @{A B C D E@}
12231 proc [format "show_uart%c" $who] @{ @} "show_UARTx $who"
12232 @}
12233 @end example
12234
12235 @node License
12236 @appendix The GNU Free Documentation License.
12237 @include fdl.texi
12238
12239 @node OpenOCD Concept Index
12240 @comment DO NOT use the plain word ``Index'', reason: CYGWIN filename
12241 @comment case issue with ``Index.html'' and ``index.html''
12242 @comment Occurs when creating ``--html --no-split'' output
12243 @comment This fix is based on: http://sourceware.org/ml/binutils/2006-05/msg00215.html
12244 @unnumbered OpenOCD Concept Index
12245
12246 @printindex cp
12247
12248 @node Command and Driver Index
12249 @unnumbered Command and Driver Index
12250 @printindex fn
12251
12252 @bye

Linking to existing account procedure

If you already have an account and want to add another login method you MUST first sign in with your existing account and then change URL to read https://review.openocd.org/login/?link to get to this page again but this time it'll work for linking. Thank you.

SSH host keys fingerprints

1024 SHA256:YKx8b7u5ZWdcbp7/4AeXNaqElP49m6QrwfXaqQGJAOk gerrit-code-review@openocd.zylin.com (DSA)
384 SHA256:jHIbSQa4REvwCFG4cq5LBlBLxmxSqelQPem/EXIrxjk gerrit-code-review@openocd.org (ECDSA)
521 SHA256:UAOPYkU9Fjtcao0Ul/Rrlnj/OsQvt+pgdYSZ4jOYdgs gerrit-code-review@openocd.org (ECDSA)
256 SHA256:A13M5QlnozFOvTllybRZH6vm7iSt0XLxbA48yfc2yfY gerrit-code-review@openocd.org (ECDSA)
256 SHA256:spYMBqEYoAOtK7yZBrcwE8ZpYt6b68Cfh9yEVetvbXg gerrit-code-review@openocd.org (ED25519)
+--[ED25519 256]--+
|=..              |
|+o..   .         |
|*.o   . .        |
|+B . . .         |
|Bo. = o S        |
|Oo.+ + =         |
|oB=.* = . o      |
| =+=.+   + E     |
|. .=o   . o      |
+----[SHA256]-----+
2048 SHA256:0Onrb7/PHjpo6iVZ7xQX2riKN83FJ3KGU0TvI0TaFG4 gerrit-code-review@openocd.zylin.com (RSA)